blob: 0d789f8ca3252f3c85d218dfa1784ad1a895aaa8 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaueaded982022-12-01 15:25:34 +01005 version 2.8
Christopher Faulet7d4c2f02024-04-05 20:18:49 +02006 2024/04/05
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
Daniel Eppersonffdf6a32023-05-15 12:45:27 -0700452.6. Size format
462.7. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Lukas Tribus5c11eb82024-01-30 21:17:44 +0000593.11. HTTPClient tuning
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020060
614. Proxies
624.1. Proxy keywords matrix
634.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
64
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100655. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200665.1. Bind options
675.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200685.3. Server DNS resolution
695.3.1. Global overview
705.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100726. Cache
736.1. Limitation
746.2. Setup
756.2.1. Cache section
766.2.2. Proxy section
77
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787. Using ACLs and fetching samples
797.1. ACL basics
807.1.1. Matching booleans
817.1.2. Matching integers
827.1.3. Matching strings
837.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
847.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
857.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
867.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
877.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200887.3.1. Converters
897.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
907.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
917.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
927.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
937.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200947.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200957.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096
978. Logging
988.1. Log levels
998.2. Log formats
1008.2.1. Default log format
1018.2.2. TCP log format
1028.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001038.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001048.2.5. Error log format
1058.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001068.3. Advanced logging options
1078.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1088.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1098.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1108.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1118.4. Timing events
1128.5. Session state at disconnection
1138.6. Non-printable characters
1148.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1158.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1168.9. Examples of logs
117
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001189. Supported filters
1199.1. Trace
1209.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001219.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001229.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001239.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001249.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02001259.7. Bandwidth limitation
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200126
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012710. FastCGI applications
12810.1. Setup
12910.1.1. Fcgi-app section
13010.1.2. Proxy section
13110.1.3. Example
13210.2. Default parameters
13310.3. Limitations
134
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013511. Address formats
13611.1. Address family prefixes
13711.2. Socket type prefixes
13811.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139
1401. Quick reminder about HTTP
141----------------------------
142
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100143When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
145on almost anything found in the contents.
146
147However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
148formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
149correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
150
151
1521.1. The HTTP transaction model
153-------------------------------
154
155The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100156to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100157from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
158connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159will involve a new connection :
160
161 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
162
163In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
164establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
165by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
166length.
167
168Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
169to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
170however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
171response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
172header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
173
174 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
175
176Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
177power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
178but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200179a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
183second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
184page :
185
186 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
187
188This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
189latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
190correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
191the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100192server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200194The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2 and HTTP/3.
195This time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all
196streams are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100197parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
198carry the stream identifier.
199
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200200
201HTTP/3 is implemented over QUIC, itself implemented over UDP. QUIC solves the
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +0200202head of line blocking at transport level by means of independently treated
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200203streams. Indeed, when experiencing loss, an impacted stream does not affect the
Amaury Denoyelle96c45632024-05-24 17:31:26 +0200204other streams. QUIC also provides connection migration support but currently
205haproxy does not support it.
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200206
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100207By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
208connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
209leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100210start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
211processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
212waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200213
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200214HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100215 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
216 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100217 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100218 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200219 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100220
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100221
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200222
2231.2. HTTP request
224-----------------
225
226First, let's consider this HTTP request :
227
228 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100229 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200230 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
231 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
232 3 User-agent: my small browser
233 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
234 5 Accept: image/png
235
236
2371.2.1. The Request line
238-----------------------
239
240Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
241
242 - a METHOD : GET
243 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
244 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
245
246All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
247which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
248followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
249is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
250desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
251the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
252
253The URI itself can have several forms :
254
255 - A "relative URI" :
256
257 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
258
259 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
260 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
261
262 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
263
264 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
265
266 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
267 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
268 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
269 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
270 must accept this form too.
271
272 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
273 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
274 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200276 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
277 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
278 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
279 other protocols too.
280
281In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
282mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
283on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
284It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
285specific to the language, framework or application in use.
286
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100287HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100288assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200290
2911.2.2. The request headers
292--------------------------
293
294The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
295beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
296an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
297Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
298values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
299encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
300the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
301define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
302
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100303Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100305"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200306as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
307normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
308representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
309HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200310
311The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
312that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
313is one valid form of empty line.
314
315Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
316headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
317about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
318application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
319
320Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000321 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200322 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
323 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
324 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
325
326
3271.3. HTTP response
328------------------
329
330An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
331messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
332
333 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100334 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200335 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
336 2 Content-length: 350
337 3 Content-Type: text/html
338
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200339As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
340codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
341response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100342continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
343the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
344following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
345sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
346(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
347correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
348such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
349state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400350over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100351if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
352information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003551.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356------------------------
357
358Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
359
360 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
361 - a status code : 200
362 - a reason : OK
363
364The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100365 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
366 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
367 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
368 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
369 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000371Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100372"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
374messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
375or "Authentication Required".
376
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100377HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
379 Code When / reason
380 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
381 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
382 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
383 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100384 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
385 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 400 for an invalid or too large request
387 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
388 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100390 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200391 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100392 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
393 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400394 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200395 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400396 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100397 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200398 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200399 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200400 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
401 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
402 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
403
404The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
4054.2).
406
407
4081.3.2. The response headers
409---------------------------
410
411Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
412the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
413details.
414
415
4162. Configuring HAProxy
417----------------------
418
4192.1. Configuration file format
420------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200421
422HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
423
424 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100425 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700426 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100427 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200428
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100429The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
430a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100431
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100432 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
433
434 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
435
436 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
437 tab characters
438
439 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
440 keyword sequences listed in this document
441
442 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
443 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
444 parts of the configuration, or expressions
445
446 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
447 are supported
448
449 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
450 section
451
452This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
453generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
454figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
455
456First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
457the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
458a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
459word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
460follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
461the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
462the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
463the parts that need to be addressed.
464
465A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
466requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
467extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
468the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
469section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
470section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
471not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
472
473A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
474each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
475a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
476start a new one.
477
478Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
479that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
480applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
481"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
482processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
483ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
484which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
485In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
486of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
487identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
488such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4892, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
490
491 listen foo
492 bind :80
493
494 listen bar
495 bind :81
496
497Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
498spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
499of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
500following configurations are strictly equivalent:
501
502 global#this is the global section
503 daemon#daemonize
504 frontend foo
505 mode http # or tcp
506
507and:
508
509 global
510 daemon
511
512 # this is the public web frontend
513 frontend foo
514 mode http
515
516The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
517new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
518other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
519section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
520section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
521at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
522
523Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
524are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
525editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
526support automatic indent.
527
528In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
529positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
530modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
531anymore, and is not recommended.
532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200533
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005342.2. Quoting and escaping
535-------------------------
536
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100537In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
538that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
539possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
540in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
541('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200542
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100543This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
544very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
545the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
546also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
547delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
548word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
549remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200550
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100551If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
552(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
553
554Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
555backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200556
557 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
558 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
559 \\ to use a backslash
560 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
561 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
562
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100563In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
564C-language representation:
565
566 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
567 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
568 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
569 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
570
571Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
572or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
573of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200574
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100575 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200576 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
577 # hash as a comment start
578
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100579Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
580evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
581dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
582backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
585character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
586is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200587
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100588As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
589entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
590name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
591represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300592hence its absence there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200593
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100594 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
595 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
596 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300597 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
598 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" |
599 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
600 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" |
601 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100602 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300603 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300605 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100606 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300607 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100608 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300609 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
610 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" |
611 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100612 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300613 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200614
615 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100616 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200617 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
618 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
619 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
620 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
621 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
622
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100623There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
624necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
625by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
626they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
627escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
628characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
629case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
630if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
631own quotes.
632
633The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600634quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500635not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100636quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
637
638Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
639arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
640
641 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
643
644Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
645"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
646cannot write:
647
648 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
649
650because we would like the string to cut like this:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
653 |---------|----|-|
654 arg1 _/ / /
655 arg2 __________/ /
656 arg3 ______________/
657
658but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
659parenthesis then garbage:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
662 |--------|--------|
663 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
664 trailing garbage _________/
665
666The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
667quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
668processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
669this word:
670
671 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
672 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
673 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
674
675So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
676still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
677the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
678the second level:
679
680 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
681 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
682 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
683 |---------||----|-|
684 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
685 arg2=blah ___________/ /
686 arg3=g _______________/
687
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500688Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100689double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
690
691 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
692 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
693 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
694 |---------||----|-|
695 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
696 arg2 ___________/ /
697 arg3 _______________/
698
699When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
700appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
701string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
702thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
703
704 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
705 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
706 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
707 |-------------| |-----||-|
708 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
709 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
710 arg3 ______________________/
711
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400712Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600713that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100714quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
715single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
716level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
717
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600718Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
719if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
720or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
721
722 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
723 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
724 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
725
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100726When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
727double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600728and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100729a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
730a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
731the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
732regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
733around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
734more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200735
736
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007372.3. Environment variables
738--------------------------
739
740HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
741interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
742configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
743optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
744shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200745underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
746list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
747arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100748before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
749use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
750next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
751existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200752
753 Example:
754
755 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
756
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100757 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200758
759 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
760
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200761Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
762file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200763
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200764* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
765 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
766
767* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
768 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
769 directory.
770
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +0100771* HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT: contains the value of the default HTTP log format as
772 defined in section 8.2.3 "HTTP log format". It can be used to override the
773 default log format without having to copy the whole original definition.
774
775 Example:
776 # Add the rule that gave the final verdict to the log
777 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT} lr=last_rule_file:last_rule_line"
778
779* HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for HTTPS log
780 format as defined in section 8.2.4 "HTTPS log format".
781
782* HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for TCP log format
783 as defined in section 8.2.2 "TCP log format".
784
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200785* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
786
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500787* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200788 processes, separated by semicolons.
789
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500790* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200791 CLI, separated by semicolons.
792
William Lallemandd4c0be62023-02-21 14:07:05 +0100793* HAPROXY_STARTUP_VERSION: contains the version used to start, in master-worker
794 mode this is the version which was used to start the master, even after
795 updating the binary and reloading.
796
Sébaastien Gross2a1bcf12023-02-23 12:54:25 -0500797* HAPROXY_BRANCH: contains the HAProxy branch version (such as "2.8"). It does
798 not contain the full version number. It can be useful in case of migration
799 if resources (such as maps or certificates) are in a path containing the
800 branch number.
801
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200802In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
803regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
804only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
805
806* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
807
808* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
809 starting at one.
810
811* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
812 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
813 first section.
814
815These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
816if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
817section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
818"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
819proxies.
820
821This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
822logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
823to name some config objects like servers for example.
824
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200825See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200826
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100827
8282.4. Conditional blocks
829-----------------------
830
831It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
832some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
833ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
834configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
835versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
836preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
837text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
838lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
839switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
840are defined to form conditional blocks:
841
842 - .if <condition>
843 - .elif <condition>
844 - .else
845 - .endif
846
847The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
848as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
849matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
850there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
851only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
852".elif" of a block.
853
854Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
855ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
856as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
857
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200858Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
859See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
860
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200861The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
862expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100863
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100864 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
865 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200866 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200867 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530868 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
869 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200870 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
871 from left to right until one returns false
872 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
873 from right to left until one returns true
874
875Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
876operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200877
878The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
879
880 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
881 exists, regardless of its contents
882
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200883 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
884 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
885 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
886
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200887 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
888 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
Christopher Fauleta1fdad72023-02-20 17:55:58 +0100889 - strstr(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the second string is found in the first one
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200890
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200891 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
892 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
893 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
894 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
895
896 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
897 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
898 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
899 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
900
Christopher Fauletc13f3022023-02-21 11:16:08 +0100901 - enabled(<opt>) : returns true if the option <opt> is enabled at
902 run-time. Only a subset of options are supported:
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +0100903 POLL, EPOLL, KQUEUE, EVPORTS, SPLICE,
904 GETADDRINFO, REUSEPORT, FAST-FORWARD,
905 SERVER-SSL-VERIFY-NONE
Christopher Fauletc13f3022023-02-21 11:16:08 +0100906
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200907Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100908
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200909 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
910 listen mwcli_px
911 bind :1111
912 ...
913 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100914
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200915 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
916 bind :80
917 .endif
918
919 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200920 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200921 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200922 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200923 .endif
924
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200925 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200926 bind :443 ssl crt ...
927 .endif
928
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200929 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
930 profiling.memory on
931 .endif
932
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200933 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
934 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
935 .endif
936
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200937Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100938
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200939 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100940 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
941 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
942 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
943
944Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
945"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
946fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
947provide advice to the user.
948
949Example:
950
951 .if "${A}"
952 .if "${B}"
953 .notice "A=1, B=1"
954 .elif "${C}"
955 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
956 .elif "${D}"
957 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
958 .else
959 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
960 .endif
961 .else
962 .notice "A=0"
963 .endif
964
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200965 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
966 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
967
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100968
9692.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200970----------------
971
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100972Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100973values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
974otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
975numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
976for every keyword. Supported units are :
977
978 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
979 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
980 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
981 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
982 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
983 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
984
985
Daniel Eppersonffdf6a32023-05-15 12:45:27 -07009862.6. Size format
987----------------
988
989Some parameters involve values representing size, such as bandwidth limits.
990These values are generally expressed in bytes (unless explicitly stated
991otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
992numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
993for every keyword. Supported units are case insensitive :
994
995 - k : kilobytes. 1 kilobyte = 1024 bytes
996 - m : megabytes. 1 megabyte = 1048576 bytes
997 - g : gigabytes. 1 gigabyte = 1073741824 bytes
998
999Both time and size formats require integers, decimal notation is not allowed.
1000
1001
10022.7. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02001003-------------
1004
1005 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
1006 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
1007 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
1008 global
1009 daemon
1010 maxconn 256
1011
1012 defaults
1013 mode http
1014 timeout connect 5000ms
1015 timeout client 50000ms
1016 timeout server 50000ms
1017
1018 frontend http-in
1019 bind *:80
1020 default_backend servers
1021
1022 backend servers
1023 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
1024
1025
1026 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
1027 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
1028 global
1029 daemon
1030 maxconn 256
1031
1032 defaults
1033 mode http
1034 timeout connect 5000ms
1035 timeout client 50000ms
1036 timeout server 50000ms
1037
1038 listen http-in
1039 bind *:80
1040 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
1041
1042
1043Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
1044
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +01001045 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02001046
1047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010483. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001049--------------------
1050
1051Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
1052are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
1053of them have command-line equivalents.
1054
1055The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
1056
1057 * Process management and security
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001058 - 51degrees-allow-unmatched
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001059 - 51degrees-cache-size
1060 - 51degrees-data-file
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001061 - 51degrees-difference
1062 - 51degrees-drift
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001063 - 51degrees-property-name-list
1064 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001065 - 51degrees-use-performance-graph
1066 - 51degrees-use-predictive-graph
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001067 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068 - chroot
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +02001069 - cluster-secret
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001070 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001071 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001072 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001073 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001074 - description
1075 - deviceatlas-json-file
1076 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001077 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001078 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001079 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001080 - external-check
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001081 - fd-hard-limit
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001082 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001083 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001084 - group
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001085 - h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1086 - h1-case-adjust
1087 - h1-case-adjust-file
1088 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001089 - hard-stop-after
Amaury Denoyelle1125d052024-05-22 14:21:16 +02001090 - harden.reject-privileged-ports.tcp
1091 - harden.reject-privileged-ports.quic
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001092 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001093 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001094 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001095 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001096 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001097 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001098 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001099 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001100 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001101 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001102 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001103 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001104 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001105 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001106 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001107 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001108 - presetenv
Patrick Hemmer425d7ad2023-05-23 13:02:08 -04001109 - prealloc-fd
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001110 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001111 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001112 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001113 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001114 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001115 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
William Lallemandb6ae2aa2023-05-05 00:05:46 +02001116 - ssl-default-bind-client-sigalgs
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001117 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001118 - ssl-default-bind-options
William Lallemand1d3c8222023-05-04 15:33:55 +02001119 - ssl-default-bind-sigalgs
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001120 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001121 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001122 - ssl-default-server-options
1123 - ssl-dh-param-file
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02001124 - ssl-propquery
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02001125 - ssl-provider
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02001126 - ssl-provider-path
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001127 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001128 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001129 - stats
1130 - strict-limits
1131 - uid
1132 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001133 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001134 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001135 - user
1136 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001137 - wurfl-data-file
1138 - wurfl-information-list
1139 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001140
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001141 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001142 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001143 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001144 - maxcompcpuusage
1145 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001146 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001147 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001148 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001149 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001150 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001151 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001152 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001153 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001154 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001155 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001156 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001157 - nokqueue
1158 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001159 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001160 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001161 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001162 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001163 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001164 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001165 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001166 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001167 - tune.buffers.limit
1168 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001169 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001170 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01001171 - tune.disable-fast-forward
Christopher Faulet760a3842023-02-20 14:33:46 +01001172 - tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001173 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreau92f287b2024-03-11 07:33:44 +01001174 - tune.h2.be.glitches-threshold
Tim Duesterhus3ca274b2023-06-13 15:07:34 +02001175 - tune.h2.be.initial-window-size
1176 - tune.h2.be.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau92f287b2024-03-11 07:33:44 +01001177 - tune.h2.fe.glitches-threshold
Tim Duesterhus3ca274b2023-06-13 15:07:34 +02001178 - tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size
1179 - tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau4869ed52023-10-13 18:11:59 +02001180 - tune.h2.fe.max-total-streams
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001181 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001182 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001183 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Tim Duesterhusbf7493e2023-06-13 15:08:47 +02001184 - tune.h2.max-frame-size
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001185 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001186 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001187 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001188 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001189 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001190 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001191 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001192 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001193 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1194 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Tristan2632d042023-10-23 13:07:39 +01001195 - tune.lua.log.loggers
1196 - tune.lua.log.stderr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001197 - tune.maxaccept
1198 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001199 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01001200 - tune.memory.hot-size
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001201 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02001202 - tune.peers.max-updates-at-once
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001203 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001204 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1205 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02001206 - tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02001207 - tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02001208 - tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01001209 - tune.quic.max-frame-loss
Frederic Lecaillefd9424d2024-02-16 15:28:30 +01001210 - tune.quic.reorder-ratio
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02001211 - tune.quic.retry-threshold
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01001212 - tune.quic.socket-owner
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001213 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1214 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001215 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001216 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001217 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001218 - tune.sndbuf.client
1219 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01001220 - tune.stick-counters
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001221 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001222 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1223 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
1224 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02001225 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1226 - tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001227 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001228 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1229 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001230 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +01001231 - tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay
1232 - tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001233 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001234 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001235 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1236 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1237 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001238 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1239 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001240
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001241 * Debugging
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02001242 - anonkey
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001243 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001244 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001245
Lukas Tribus5c11eb82024-01-30 21:17:44 +00001246 * HTTPClient
1247 - httpclient.resolvers.disabled
1248 - httpclient.resolvers.id
1249 - httpclient.resolvers.prefer
1250 - httpclient.retries
1251 - httpclient.ssl.ca-file
1252 - httpclient.ssl.verify
1253 - httpclient.timeout.connect
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001254
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012553.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001256------------------------------------
1257
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100125851degrees-data-file <file path>
1259 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1260 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1261
1262 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001263 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001264
126551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1266 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1267 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1268 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1269
1270 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001271 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001272
127351degrees-property-separator <char>
1274 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1275 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1276
1277 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001278 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001279
128051degrees-cache-size <number>
1281 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1282 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1283 By default, this cache is disabled.
1284
1285 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001286 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001287
128851degrees-use-performance-graph { on | off }
1289 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the performance graph in
1290 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1291
1292 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001293 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001294
129551degrees-use-predictive-graph { on | off }
1296 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the predictive graph in
1297 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1298
1299 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001300 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001301
130251degrees-drift <number>
1303 Sets the drift value that a detection can allow.
1304
1305 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001306 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001307
130851degrees-difference <number>
1309 Sets the difference value that a detection can allow.
1310
1311 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001312 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001313
131451degrees-allow-unmatched { on | off }
1315 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of unmatched nodes in the
1316 detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1317
1318 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001319 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001320
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001321ca-base <dir>
1322 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001323 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1324 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1325 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001326
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001327chroot <jail dir>
1328 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1329 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1330 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1331 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1332 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001333 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001334
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001335close-spread-time <time>
1336 Define a time window during which idle connections and active connections
1337 closing is spread in case of soft-stop. After a SIGUSR1 is received and the
1338 grace period is over (if any), the idle connections will all be closed at
1339 once if this option is not set, and active HTTP or HTTP2 connections will be
1340 ended after the next request is received, either by appending a "Connection:
1341 close" line to the HTTP response, or by sending a GOAWAY frame in case of
1342 HTTP2. When this option is set, connection closing will be spread over this
1343 set <time>.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001344 If the close-spread-time is set to "infinite", active connection closing
1345 during a soft-stop will be disabled. The "Connection: close" header will not
1346 be added to HTTP responses (or GOAWAY for HTTP2) anymore and idle connections
1347 will only be closed once their timeout is reached (based on the various
1348 timeouts set in the configuration).
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001349
1350 Arguments :
1351 <time> is a time window (by default in milliseconds) during which
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001352 connection closing will be spread during a soft-stop operation, or
1353 "infinite" if active connection closing should be disabled.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001354
1355 It is recommended to set this setting to a value lower than the one used in
1356 the "hard-stop-after" option if this one is used, so that all connections
1357 have a chance to gracefully close before the process stops.
1358
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001359 See also: grace, hard-stop-after, idle-close-on-response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001360
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001361cluster-secret <secret>
1362 Define an ASCII string secret shared between several nodes belonging to the
1363 same cluster. It could be used for different usages. It is at least used to
1364 derive stateless reset tokens for all the QUIC connections instantiated by
1365 this process. This is also the case to derive secrets used to encrypt Retry
Amaury Denoyelle28ea31c2022-11-14 16:18:46 +01001366 tokens.
1367
1368 If this parameter is not set, a random value will be selected on process
1369 startup. This allows to use features which rely on it, albeit with some
1370 limitations.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001371
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001372cpu-map [auto:]<thread-group>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>[,...] [...]
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001373 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a thread group or a thread
1374 to a specific CPU set. This means that the designated threads will never run
1375 on other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for individual
1376 threads or thread groups. The first argument is a thread group range,
1377 optionally followed by a thread set. These ranges have the following format:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001378
1379 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1380
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001381 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001382 word size. Any group IDs above 'thread-groups' and any thread IDs above the
1383 machine's word size are ignored. All thread numbers are relative to the group
1384 they belong to. It is possible to specify a range with two such number
1385 delimited by a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all threads at once
1386 using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just
1387 like with the "thread" bind directive. The second and forthcoming arguments
1388 are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001389 first CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). These
1390 CPU numbers and ranges may be repeated by delimiting them with commas or by
1391 passing more ranges as new arguments on the same line. Outside of Linux and
1392 BSD operating systems, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to
1393 either 31 or 63. Multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified, but each
1394 "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001395
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001396 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1397 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1398 on the machine's word size.
1399
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001400 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the thread set to let HAProxy
1401 automatically bind a set of threads to a CPU by incrementing threads and
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001402 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1403 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001404 highest bound. Having both a group and a thread range with the "auto:"
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001405 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1406 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001407
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001408 Note that group ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a lone
1409 number designates a thread group and must be 1 if thread-groups are not used,
1410 and specifying a thread range or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of
1411 it if thread groups are not used. Finally, "1" is strictly equivalent to
1412 "1/all" and designates all threads in the group.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001413
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001414 Examples:
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001415 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first group on the
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001416 # first 4 CPUs
1417
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001418 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1419 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001420 # word size.
1421
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001422 # all these lines bind thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001423 # and so on.
1424 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1425 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1426 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001427 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3,2,1,0
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001428
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001429 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1430 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1431 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1432 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001433
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001434 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1435 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1436 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001437
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001438 # map 40 threads of those 4 groups to individual CPUs
1439 cpu-map auto:1/1-10 0-9
1440 cpu-map auto:2/1-10 10-19
1441 cpu-map auto:3/1-10 20-29
1442 cpu-map auto:4/1-10 30-39
1443
1444 # Map 80 threads to one physical socket and 80 others to another socket
1445 # without forcing assignment. These are split into 4 groups since no
1446 # group may have more than 64 threads.
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001447 cpu-map 1/1-40 0-39,80-119 # node0, siblings 0 & 1
1448 cpu-map 2/1-40 0-39,80-119
1449 cpu-map 3/1-40 40-79,120-159 # node1, siblings 0 & 1
1450 cpu-map 4/1-40 40-79,120-159
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001451
1452
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001453crt-base <dir>
1454 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001455 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1456 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001457
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001458daemon
1459 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1460 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001461 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1462 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001463
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001464default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001465 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001466 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1467 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1468 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1469 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1470 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1471 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1472 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1473 not start with a slash ('/'):
1474 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1475 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1476
1477 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1478 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1479 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1480 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1481 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1482 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1483 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1484 each of them.
1485
1486 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1487 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1488 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1489 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1490 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1491 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1492 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1493 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1494
1495 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1496 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001497 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001498 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1499 made easily relocatable.
1500
1501 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1502 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1503 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1504 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1505 consistent across all configuration files.
1506
1507 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1508 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1509 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1510 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1511 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1512 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1513 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1514 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1515
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001516description <text>
1517 Add a text that describes the instance.
1518
1519 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1520 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1521 "<" and ">" characters.
1522
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001523deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1524 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001525 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001526
1527deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001528 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001529 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1530
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001531deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001532 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1533 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1534 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001535
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001536deviceatlas-separator <char>
1537 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1538 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1539
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001540expose-experimental-directives
1541 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1542 the config file will be rejected.
1543
Willy Tarreau39dcd1f2023-11-23 16:48:48 +01001544external-check [preserve-env]
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001545 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1546 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001547 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1548 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1549 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
Willy Tarreau39dcd1f2023-11-23 16:48:48 +01001550 By default, the checks start with a clean environment which only contains
1551 variables defined in the "external-check" command in the backend section. It
1552 may sometimes be desirable to preserve the environment though, for example
1553 when complex scripts retrieve their extra paths or information there. This
1554 can be done by appending the "preserve-env" keyword. In this case however it
1555 is strongly advised not to run a setuid nor as a privileged user, as this
1556 exposes the check program to potential attacks. See "option external-check",
1557 and "insecure-fork-wanted", and "insecure-setuid-wanted" for extra details.
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001558
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001559fd-hard-limit <number>
1560 Sets an upper bound to the maximum number of file descriptors that the
1561 process will use, regardless of system limits. While "ulimit-n" and "maxconn"
1562 may be used to enforce a value, when they are not set, the process will be
1563 limited to the hard limit of the RLIMIT_NOFILE setting as reported by
1564 "ulimit -n -H". But some modern operating systems are now allowing extremely
1565 large values here (in the order of 1 billion), which will consume way too
1566 much RAM for regular usage. The fd-hard-limit setting is provided to enforce
1567 a possibly lower bound to this limit. This means that it will always respect
1568 the system-imposed limits when they are below <number> but the specified
1569 value will be used if system-imposed limits are higher. In the example below,
1570 no other setting is specified and the maxconn value will automatically adapt
1571 to the lower of "fd-hard-limit" and the system-imposed limit:
1572
1573 global
1574 # use as many FDs as possible but no more than 50000
1575 fd-hard-limit 50000
1576
1577 See also: ulimit-n, maxconn
1578
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001579gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001580 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001581 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1582 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001583 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001584 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001585 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001586
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001587grace <time>
1588 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1589
1590 Arguments :
1591 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1592 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1593 soft-stop operation.
1594
1595 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1596 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1597 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1598 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1599 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1600 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1601 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1602 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1603 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1604
1605 Example:
1606
1607 global
1608 grace 10s
1609
1610 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1611 frontend ext-check
1612 bind :9999
1613 monitor-uri /ext-check
1614 monitor fail if { stopping }
1615
1616 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1617 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1618 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1619 SIGUSR1 signal.
1620
1621 Example:
1622
1623 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1624 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1625 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1626 frontend ext-check
1627 bind :9999
1628 monitor-uri /ext-check
1629 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1630
1631 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1632
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001633group <group name>
1634 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1635 See also "gid" and "user".
1636
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001637h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1638 Does not reject HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1639
1640 While It is explicitly allowed in HTTP/1.1, HTTP/1.0 is not clear on this
1641 point and some old servers don't expect any payload and never look for body
1642 length (via Content-Length or Transfer-Encoding headers). It means that some
1643 intermediaries may properly handle the payload for HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE
1644 requests, while some others may totally ignore it. That may lead to security
1645 issues because a request smuggling attack is possible. Thus, by default,
1646 HAProxy rejects HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1647
1648 However, it may be an issue with some old clients. In this case, this global
1649 option may be set.
1650
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001651h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1652 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1653 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1654 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1655 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001656 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001657 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1658 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1659 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1660 specified in a proxy.
1661
1662 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1663 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1664 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1665 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1666 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1667 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1668 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1669
1670 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1671 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1672 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1673 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1674 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1675
1676 Example:
1677 global
1678 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1679
1680 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1681 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1682
1683h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1684 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1685 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1686 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1687 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1688 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1689 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1690 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1691 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1692
1693 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1694 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1695 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1696
1697 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1698 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1699
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001700h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1701 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1702 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1703 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1704 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1705 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1706 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1707 the keyword with "no'.
1708
1709hard-stop-after <time>
1710 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1711
1712 Arguments :
1713 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1714 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1715 SIGUSR1 signal.
1716
1717 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1718 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1719 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1720
1721 Example:
1722 global
1723 hard-stop-after 30s
1724
1725 See also: grace
1726
Amaury Denoyelle1125d052024-05-22 14:21:16 +02001727harden.reject-privileged-ports.tcp { on | off }
1728harden.reject-privileged-ports.quic { on | off }
1729 Toggle per protocol protection which forbid communication with clients which
1730 use privileged ports as their source port. This range of ports is defined
1731 according to RFC 6335. Protection is inactive by default on both protocols.
1732
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001733insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001734 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001735 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1736 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1737 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1738 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1739 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1740 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1741 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001742 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001743 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1744 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1745 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1746 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1747 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1748 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1749 disable it.
1750
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001751insecure-setuid-wanted
1752 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1753 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1754 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1755 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001756 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001757 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001758 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001759 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1760 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001761 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001762 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1763 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1764 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1765 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1766
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001767issuers-chain-path <dir>
1768 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1769 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1770 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001771 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001772 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1773 "issuers-chain-path".
1774 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1775 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1776 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1777 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1778 will share the chain in memory.
1779
Frédéric Lécailleffb67d52023-07-21 18:32:32 +02001780limited-quic
1781 This setting must be used to explicitly enable the QUIC listener bindings when
1782 haproxy is compiled against a TLS/SSL stack without QUIC support, typically
1783 OpenSSL. It has no effect when haproxy is compiled against a TLS/SSL stack
1784 with QUIC support, quictls for instance. Note that QUIC 0-RTT is not supported
1785 when this setting is set.
1786
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001787localpeer <name>
1788 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1789 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1790 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1791 the configuration parsing.
1792
1793 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1794 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1795
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001796log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001797 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001798 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001799 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001800 configured with "log global".
1801
1802 <address> can be one of:
1803
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001804 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001805 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1806 port).
1807
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001808 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1809 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1810 port).
1811
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001812 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001813 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1814 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001815 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001816
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001817 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1818 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1819 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1820 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1821 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1822 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1823 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1824 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1825 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1826 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001827 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001828 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1829 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1830 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001831 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1832 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001833
1834 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1835 "fd@2", see above.
1836
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001837 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1838 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1839 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1840 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1841 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1842
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001843 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1844 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001845
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001846 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1847 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1848 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1849 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1850 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1851 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1852 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1853 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1854 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1855 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001856 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1857 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001858
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001859 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1860 one of the following :
1861
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001862 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1863 field is stripped. This is the default.
1864 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1865 rfc3164.
1866
1867 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001868 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1869
1870 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1871 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1872
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001873 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1874 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1875 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1876 designed to be used with a local log server.
1877
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001878 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1879 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1880 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1881 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1882 logger consumes.
1883
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001884 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1885 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1886 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1887 used with a local log server.
1888
1889 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1890 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1891 designed to be used with a local log server.
1892
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001893 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1894 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1895 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1896 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1897
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001898 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1899 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1900 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1901 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1902 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1903
1904 <sample_size>
1905 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1906 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1907 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1908 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1909 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1910
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001911 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001912
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001913 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1914 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1915 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1916
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001917 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1918 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1919 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1920 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001921
1922 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001923 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1924 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1925 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1926 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1927 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1928 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001929
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001930 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001931
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001932log-send-hostname [<string>]
1933 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1934 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1935 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1936 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1937 the logs.
1938
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001939log-tag <string>
1940 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1941 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1942 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001943 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001944
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001945lua-load <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001946 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1947 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1948 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1949 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1950 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1951 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001952 used multiple times.
1953
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001954 args are available in the lua file using the code below in the body of the
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001955 file. Do not forget that Lua arrays start at index 1. A "local" variable
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001956 declared in a file is available in the entire file and not available on
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001957 other files.
1958
1959 local args = table.pack(...)
1960
1961lua-load-per-thread <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001962 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1963 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1964 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1965 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1966 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1967 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1968 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1969 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1970 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1971 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1972 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1973 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1974 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1975 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1976 times.
1977
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001978 See lua-load for usage of args.
1979
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001980lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1981 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1982 variable.
1983 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1984 to "path".
1985
1986 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1987 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1988 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1989 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1990 will be checked earlier.
1991
1992 As an example by specifying the following path:
1993
1994 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1995 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1996
1997 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1998 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1999 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
2000 paths if that does not exist either.
2001
2002 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
2003 documentation.
2004
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01002005master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02002006 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
2007 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
2008 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002009 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02002010 or daemon mode.
2011
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01002012 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
2013 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
2014 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
2015 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
2016 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02002017
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01002018 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02002019
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02002020mworker-max-reloads <number>
2021 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002022 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02002023 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
2024 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
2025 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
2026
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02002027nbthread <number>
2028 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002029 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
2030 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
2031 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
2032 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
2033 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
2034 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
2035 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02002036
Frédéric Lécaille12a03172023-01-12 15:23:54 +01002037no-quic
Frédéric Lécaille12a03172023-01-12 15:23:54 +01002038 Disable QUIC transport protocol. All the QUIC listeners will still be created.
2039 But they will not bind their addresses. Hence, no QUIC traffic will be
2040 processed by haproxy. See also "quic_enabled" sample fetch.
2041
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01002042numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01002043 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
2044 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
2045 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
2046 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
2047 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
2048 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
2049 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
2050 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
2051 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
2052 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01002053
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002054pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09002055 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
2056 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
2057 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
2058 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002059
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02002060pp2-never-send-local
2061 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
2062 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
2063 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
2064 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
2065 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
2066 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
2067 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
2068 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
2069 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
2070 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
2071 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
2072
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002073presetenv <name> <value>
2074 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2075 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
2076 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
2077 and "unsetenv".
2078
Patrick Hemmer425d7ad2023-05-23 13:02:08 -04002079prealloc-fd
2080 Performs a one-time open of the maximum file descriptor which results in a
2081 pre-allocation of the kernel's data structures. This prevents short pauses
2082 when nbthread>1 and HAProxy opens a file descriptor which requires the kernel
2083 to expand its data structures.
2084
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002085resetenv [<name> ...]
2086 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
2087 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
2088 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
2089 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
2090 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
2091 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
2092 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
2093 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
2094
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002095server-state-base <directory>
2096 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002097 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
2098 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02002099
2100server-state-file <file>
2101 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
2102 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
2103 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
2104 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
2105 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
2106 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
2107 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
2108 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002109 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
2110 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002111
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002112set-dumpable
2113 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
2114 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
2115 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
2116 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
2117 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
2118 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
2119 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
2120 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
2121 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
2122 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
2123 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
2124 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
2125 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
2126 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
2127 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
2128 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
2129 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
2130 leaves a core where expected when dying.
2131
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002132set-var <var-name> <expr>
2133 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
2134 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2135 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2136 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
2137 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
2138 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002139 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002140 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
2141 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2142
2143 Example:
2144 global
2145 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
2146 set-var proc.prio int(100)
2147 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
2148
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002149set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
2150 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
2151 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2152 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2153 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
2154 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
2155 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
2156 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
2157 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
2158 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +02002159 Please see section 8.2.6 for details on the custom log-format syntax.
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002160
2161 Example:
2162 global
2163 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
2164 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
2165
Willy Tarreaua547a212023-08-29 10:24:26 +02002166setcap <name>[,<name>...]
2167 Sets a list of capabilities that must be preserved when starting with uid 0
2168 and switching to a non-zero uid. By default all permissions are lost by the
2169 uid switch, but some are often needed when trying connecting to a server from
2170 a foreign address during transparent proxying, or when binding to a port
2171 below 1024, e.g. when using "tune.quic.socket-owner connection", resulting in
2172 setups running entirely under uid 0. Setting capabilities generally is a
2173 safer alternative, as only the required capabilities will be preserved. The
2174 feature is OS-specific and only enabled on Linux when USE_LINUX_CAP=1 is set
2175 at build time. The list of supported capabilities also depends on the OS and
2176 is enumerated by the error message displayed when an invalid capability name
2177 or an empty one is passed. Multiple capabilities may be passed, delimited by
2178 commas. Among those commonly used, "cap_net_raw" allows to transparently bind
2179 to a foreign address, and "cap_net_bind_service" allows to bind to a
2180 privileged port and may be used by QUIC.
2181
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002182setenv <name> <value>
2183 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2184 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
2185 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
2186 and "unsetenv".
2187
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002188ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
2189 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2190 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002191 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002192 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002193 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2194 information and recommendations see e.g.
2195 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2196 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
2197 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
2198 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002199
2200ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2201 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2202 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
William Lallemandee8a65a2024-03-11 15:48:14 +01002203 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
2204 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2205 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
2206 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2207 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2208 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. This setting might accept TLSv1.2
2209 ciphersuites however this is an undocumented behavior and not recommended as
2210 it could be inconsistent or buggy.
2211 The default TLSv1.3 ciphersuites of OpenSSL are:
2212 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
2213
2214 TLSv1.3 only supports 5 ciphersuites:
2215
2216 - TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
2217 - TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
2218 - TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256
2219 - TLS_AES_128_CCM_SHA256
2220 - TLS_AES_128_CCM_8_SHA256
2221
2222 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
2223
2224 Example:
2225 global
2226 ssl-default-bind-ciphers ECDHE-RSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384:ECDHE-RSA-CHACHA20-POLY1305:ECDHE-RSA-AES128-GCM-SHA256
2227 ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002228
William Lallemandb6ae2aa2023-05-05 00:05:46 +02002229ssl-default-bind-client-sigalgs <sigalgs>
2230 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2231 the default string describing the list of signature algorithms related to
2232 client authentication for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2233 theirs. The format of the string is a colon-delimited list of signature
2234 algorithms. Each signature algorithm can use one of two forms: TLS1.3 signature
2235 scheme names ("rsa_pss_rsae_sha256") or the public key algorithm + digest form
2236 ("ECDSA+SHA256"). A list can contain both forms. For more information on the
2237 format, see SSL_CTX_set1_client_sigalgs(3). A list of signature algorithms is
2238 also available in RFC8446 section 4.2.3 and in OpenSSL in the ssl/t1_lib.c
2239 file. This setting is not applicable to TLSv1.1 and earlier versions of the
2240 protocol as the signature algorithms aren't separately negotiated in these
2241 versions. It is not recommended to change this setting unless compatibility
2242 with a middlebox is required.
2243
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02002244ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
2245 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2246 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
2247 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
2248 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
2249 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
2250
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002251ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
2252 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2253 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
2254 keyword to see available options.
2255
2256 Example:
2257 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02002258 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002259
William Lallemand1d3c8222023-05-04 15:33:55 +02002260ssl-default-bind-sigalgs <sigalgs>
2261 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2262 sets the default string describing the list of signature algorithms that
2263 are negotiated during the TLSv1.2 and TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines
2264 which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is a
2265 colon-delimited list of signature algorithms. Each signature algorithm can
2266 use one of two forms: TLS1.3 signature scheme names ("rsa_pss_rsae_sha256")
2267 or the public key algorithm + digest form ("ECDSA+SHA256"). A list
2268 can contain both forms. For more information on the format,
2269 see SSL_CTX_set1_sigalgs(3). A list of signature algorithms is also
2270 available in RFC8446 section 4.2.3 and in OpenSSL in the ssl/t1_lib.c file.
2271 This setting is not applicable to TLSv1.1 and earlier versions of the
2272 protocol as the signature algorithms aren't separately negotiated in these
2273 versions. It is not recommended to change this setting unless compatibility
2274 with a middlebox is required.
2275
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002276ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
2277 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2278 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002279 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002280 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002281 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2282 information and recommendations see e.g.
2283 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2284 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
2285 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
2286 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
2287 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002288
2289ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2290 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
William Lallemandee8a65a2024-03-11 15:48:14 +01002291 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
2292 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
2293 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
2294 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002295 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
William Lallemandee8a65a2024-03-11 15:48:14 +01002296 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2297 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
2298 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002299
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002300ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
2301 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2302 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
2303 keyword to see available options.
2304
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002305ssl-dh-param-file <file>
2306 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2307 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
2308 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002309 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002310 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02002311 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02002312 directly in the certificate file, DHE ciphers will not be used, unless
2313 tune.ssl.default-dh-param is set. In this latter case, pre-defined DH
2314 parameters of the specified size will be used. Custom parameters are known to
2315 be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002316 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
2317 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
2318 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
2319
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02002320ssl-propquery <query>
2321 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2322 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to define a default property
2323 string used when fetching algorithms in providers. It behave the same way as
2324 the openssl propquery option and it follows the same syntax (described in
2325 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man3.0/man7/property.html). For instance, if you
2326 have two providers loaded, the foo one and the default one, the propquery
2327 "?provider=foo" allows to pick the algorithm implementations provided by the
2328 foo provider by default, and to fallback on the default provider's one if it
2329 was not found.
2330
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002331ssl-provider <name>
2332 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2333 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to load a provider during init.
2334 If loading is successful, any capabilities provided by the loaded provider
2335 might be used by HAProxy. Multiple 'ssl-provider' options can be specified in
2336 a configuration file. The providers will be loaded in their order of
2337 appearance.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002338
2339 Please note that loading a provider explicitly prevents OpenSSL from loading
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002340 the 'default' provider automatically. OpenSSL also allows to define the
2341 providers that should be loaded directly in its configuration file
2342 (openssl.cnf for instance) so it is not necessary to use this 'ssl-provider'
2343 option to load providers. The "show ssl providers" CLI command can be used to
2344 show all the providers that were successfully loaded.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002345
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002346 The default search path of OpenSSL provider can be found in the output of the
2347 "openssl version -a" command. If the provider is in another directory, you
2348 can set the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable, which takes the directory
2349 where your provider can be found.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002350
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02002351 See also "ssl-propquery" and "ssl-provider-path".
2352
2353ssl-provider-path <path>
2354 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2355 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to specify the search path that
2356 is to be used by OpenSSL for looking for providers. It behaves the same way
2357 as the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable. It will be used for any
2358 following 'ssl-provider' option or until a new 'ssl-provider-path' is
2359 defined.
2360 See also "ssl-provider".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002361
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002362ssl-load-extra-del-ext
2363 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
2364 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002365 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002366 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002367 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
2368
2369 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002370
2371 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
2372 and won't try to remove them.
2373
2374 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
2375
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002376ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002377 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002378 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
2379 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
2380 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002381
2382 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
2383 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
2384 optimize the startup time.
2385
2386 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
2387 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
2388 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
2389
2390 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002391 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002392
2393 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002394 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
2395 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002396
2397 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
2398 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
2399 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
2400 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
2401 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002402 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002403
2404 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002405 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002406 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
2407 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
2408 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
2409 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2410 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002411 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002412
2413 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2414
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002415 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002416 a cert bundle.
2417
2418 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2419 separately in several "crt".
2420
2421 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2422 since files are loading separately.
2423
2424 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2425 required to commit them.
2426
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002427 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002428 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002429
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002430 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2431 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2432 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002433
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002434 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2435 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2436 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002437
2438 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002439 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2440 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002441
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002442 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2443 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2444
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002445 The default behavior is "all".
2446
2447 Example:
2448 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2449 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2450 ssl-load-extra-files none
2451
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002452 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2453 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002454
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002455ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2456 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2457 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2458 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2459
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002460ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002461 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002462 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2463 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2464 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2465 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2466 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2467 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002468 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002469
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002470stats maxconn <connections>
2471 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2472 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2473
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002474stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2475 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2476 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2477 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002478 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002479 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002480
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002481 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2482 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2483 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002484
2485stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2486 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2487 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002488 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002489
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002490strict-limits
2491 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2492 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2493 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2494 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2495 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002496
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002497thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2498 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2499 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2500 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2501 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2502 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2503 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2504 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2505 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2506 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2507
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002508thread-groups <number>
2509 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2510 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
Willy Tarreau856d56d2022-07-15 21:46:55 +02002511 moment, the default value is 1. Thread groups make it possible to reduce
2512 sharing between threads to limit contention, at the expense of some extra
2513 configuration efforts. It is also the only way to use more than 64 threads
2514 since up to 64 threads per group may be configured. The maximum number of
2515 groups is configured at compile time and defaults to 16. See also "nbthread".
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002516
Willy Tarreau9fd05422022-11-16 17:29:12 +01002517trace <args...>
2518 This command configures one "trace" subsystem statement. Each of them can be
2519 found in the management manual, and follow the exact same syntax. Only one
2520 statement per line is permitted (i.e. if some long trace configurations using
2521 semi-colons are to be imported, they must be placed one per line). Any output
2522 that the "trace" command would produce will be emitted during the parsing
2523 step of the section. Most of the time these will be errors and warnings, but
2524 certain incomplete commands might list permissible choices. This command is
2525 not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by developers
2526 along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally marked as
2527 experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must appear on a
2528 line before any "trace" statement. Note that these directives are parsed on
2529 the fly, so referencing a ring buffer that is only declared further will not
2530 work. For such use cases it is suggested to place another "global" section
2531 with only the "trace" statements after the declaration of that ring. It is
2532 important to keep in mind that depending on the trace level and details,
2533 enabling traces can severely degrade the global performance. Please refer to
2534 the management manual for the statements syntax.
2535
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002536uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002537 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002538 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2539 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2540 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2541
2542ulimit-n <number>
2543 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2544 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002545 option. If the intent is only to limit the number of file descriptors, better
2546 use "fd-hard-limit" instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002547
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002548 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2549 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2550 manually specify this value.
2551
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002552 See also: fd-hard-limit, maxconn
2553
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002554unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2555 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2556
2557 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2558 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2559 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2560 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2561 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002562 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002563 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2564 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2565 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2566 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2567
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002568unsetenv [<name> ...]
2569 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2570 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2571 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2572 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2573 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2574 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2575 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2576
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002577user <user name>
2578 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2579 See also "uid" and "group".
2580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002581node <name>
2582 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2583
2584 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2585 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2586 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2587 traffic.
2588
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002589wurfl-cache-size <size>
2590 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2591 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2592 - "0" : no cache is used.
2593 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002594
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002595 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2596 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002597
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002598wurfl-data-file <file path>
2599 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2600 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2601
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002602 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002603 with USE_WURFL=1.
2604
2605wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2606 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2607 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2608 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2609
2610 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2611
2612 Valid WURFL properties are:
2613 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2614
2615 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2616 device.
2617
2618 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2619 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2620
2621 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2622 particular web request.
2623
2624 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2625 used Libwurfl API version.
2626
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002627 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2628 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2629
2630 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2631 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2632
2633 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2634
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002635 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002636 with USE_WURFL=1.
2637
2638wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2639 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2640 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2641
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002642 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002643 with USE_WURFL=1.
2644
2645wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2646 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2647 thus before the chroot.
2648
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002649 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002650 with USE_WURFL=1.
2651
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026523.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002653-----------------------
2654
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002655busy-polling
2656 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2657 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2658 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2659 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2660 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2661 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2662 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2663 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2664 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2665 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2666 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2667 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2668 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2669 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2670 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2671 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2672 "poll" pollers.
2673
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002674 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2675 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2676 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2677
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002678max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002679 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002680 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2681 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2682 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2683 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2684 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2685 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2686 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2687
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002688maxcompcpuusage <number>
2689 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2690 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2691 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2692 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2693 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2694 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2695 and from introducing high latencies.
2696
2697maxcomprate <number>
2698 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2699 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2700 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2701 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2702 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2703 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2704 default value.
2705
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002706maxconn <number>
2707 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2708 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2709 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002710 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2711 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2712 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2713 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002714 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2715 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2716 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2717 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2718 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002719 also be automatic). In any case, the fd-hard-limit applies if set.
2720
2721 See also: fd-hard-limit, ulimit-n
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002722
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002723maxconnrate <number>
2724 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2725 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2726 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2727 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2728 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2729 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2730 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2731 fairness.
2732
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002733maxpipes <number>
2734 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2735 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2736 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2737 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2738 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2739 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2740
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002741maxsessrate <number>
2742 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2743 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2744 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2745 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2746 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2747 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2748 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2749 fairness.
2750
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002751maxsslconn <number>
2752 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2753 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2754 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2755 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2756 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2757 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2758 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002759 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2760 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2761 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2762 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002763 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002764 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2765 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002766
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002767maxsslrate <number>
2768 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2769 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2770 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2771 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2772 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2773 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2774 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2775 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2776 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2777 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2778
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002779maxzlibmem <number>
2780 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2781 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2782 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002783 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2784 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2785 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2786
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002787no-memory-trimming
2788 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2789 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2790 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2791 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2792 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2793 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2794 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2795 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2796 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2797 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2798 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2799 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2800 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2801 not suffer from such a problem.
2802
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002803noepoll
2804 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2805 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002806 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002807
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002808noevports
2809 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2810 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2811 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2812 also "nopoll".
2813
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002814nogetaddrinfo
2815 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2816 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2817
2818nokqueue
2819 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2820 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2821 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2822
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002823nopoll
2824 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2825 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002826 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002827 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2828 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002829
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002830noreuseport
2831 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2832 command line argument "-dR".
2833
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002834nosplice
2835 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002836 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002837 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002838 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002839 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2840 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2841 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2842 "option splice-response".
2843
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002844profiling.memory { on | off }
2845 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2846 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2847 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2848 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2849 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2850 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2851 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2852 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2853 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2854
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002855profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2856 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2857 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2858 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2859 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002860 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002861 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2862 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2863 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2864 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2865
2866 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2867 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2868 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2869 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2870 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002871 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2872 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2873 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2874 CLI.
2875
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002876spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002877 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2878 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2879 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2880 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2881 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2882 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002883
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002884ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002885 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002886 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002887 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002888 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002889 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2890 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2891 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002892 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2893 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002894 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2895 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2896 openssl configuration file uses:
2897 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2898
Aleksandar Lazic89fb2102022-07-27 15:24:54 +02002899 HAProxy Version 2.6 disabled the support for engines in the default build.
2900 This option is only available when HAProxy has been built with support for
2901 it. In case the ssl-engine is required HAProxy can be rebuild with the
2902 USE_ENGINE=1 flag.
2903
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002904ssl-mode-async
2905 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002906 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002907 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2908 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002909 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002910 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002911 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002912
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002913tune.buffers.limit <number>
2914 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2915 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2916 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2917 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2918 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002919 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002920 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2921 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2922 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2923 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2924 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2925 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2926 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2927 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002928 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002929
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002930tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2931 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2932 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2933 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002934 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002935
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002936tune.bufsize <number>
2937 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2938 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2939 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2940 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2941 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2942 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2943 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002944 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2945 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002946 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002947 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002948 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002949 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2950 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002951
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002952tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2953 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2954 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2955 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2956 this value. The default value is 1.
2957
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01002958tune.disable-fast-forward [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2959 Disables the data fast-forwarding. It is a mechanism to optimize the data
2960 forwarding by passing data directly from a side to the other one without
2961 waking the stream up. Thanks to this directive, it is possible to disable
2962 this optimization. Note it also disable any kernel tcp splicing. This command
2963 is not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by
2964 developers along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally
2965 marked as experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must
2966 appear on a line before this directive.
2967
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002968tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreauf4b79c42022-02-23 15:20:53 +01002969 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC or started with "-dMfail", gives the
2970 percentage of chances an allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no
2971 failure) and 100 (no success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory
Willy Tarreau0c4348c2023-03-21 09:24:53 +01002972 failures are handled gracefully. When not set, the ratio is 0. However the
2973 command-line "-dMfail" option automatically sets it to 1% failure rate so that
2974 it is not necessary to change the configuration for testing.
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002975
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002976tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2977 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2978 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2979 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2980 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2981 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2982
Willy Tarreau92f287b2024-03-11 07:33:44 +01002983tune.h2.be.glitches-threshold <number>
2984 Sets the threshold for the number of glitches on a backend connection, where
2985 that connection will automatically be killed. This allows to automatically
2986 kill misbehaving connections without having to write explicit rules for them.
2987 The default value is zero, indicating that no threshold is set so that no
2988 event will cause a connection to be closed. Beware that some H2 servers may
2989 occasionally cause a few glitches over long lasting connection, so any non-
2990 zero value here should probably be in the hundreds or thousands to be
2991 effective without affecting slightly bogus servers.
2992
2993 See also: tune.h2.fe.glitches-threshold, bc_glitches
2994
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02002995tune.h2.be.initial-window-size <number>
2996 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size for outgoing connections, which is the
2997 number of bytes the server can respond before waiting for an acknowledgment
2998 from HAProxy. This setting only affects payload contents, not headers. When
2999 not set, the common default value set by tune.h2.initial-window-size applies.
3000 It can make sense to slightly increase this value to allow faster downloads
3001 or to reduce CPU usage on the servers, at the expense of creating unfairness
3002 between clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
Tim Duesterhuse3ebe0e2023-06-13 15:15:47 +02003003
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003004 See also: tune.h2.initial-window-size.
3005
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003006tune.h2.be.max-concurrent-streams <number>
3007 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per outgoing connection
3008 (i.e. the number of outstanding requests on a single connection to a server).
3009 When not set, the default set by tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams applies. A
3010 smaller value than the default 100 may improve a site's responsiveness at the
3011 expense of maintaining more established connections to the servers. When the
3012 "http-reuse" setting is set to "always", it is recommended to reduce this
3013 value so as not to mix too many different clients over the same connection,
3014 because if a client is slower than others, a mechanism known as "head of
3015 line blocking" tends to cause cascade effect on download speed for all
3016 clients sharing a connection (keep tune.h2.be.initial-window-size low in this
3017 case). It is highly recommended not to increase this value; some might find
3018 it optimal to run at low values (1..5 typically).
3019
Willy Tarreau92f287b2024-03-11 07:33:44 +01003020tune.h2.fe.glitches-threshold <number>
3021 Sets the threshold for the number of glitches on a frontend connection, where
3022 that connection will automatically be killed. This allows to automatically
3023 kill misbehaving connections without having to write explicit rules for them.
3024 The default value is zero, indicating that no threshold is set so that no
3025 event will cause a connection to be closed. Beware that some H2 clientss may
3026 occasionally cause a few glitches over long lasting connection, so any non-
3027 zero value here should probably be in the hundreds or thousands to be
3028 effective without affecting slightly bogus clients.
3029
3030 See also: tune.h2.be.glitches-threshold, fc_glitches
3031
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003032tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size <number>
3033 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size for incoming connections, which is the
3034 number of bytes the client can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment
3035 from HAProxy. This setting only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of
3036 POST requests), not headers. When not set, the common default value set by
3037 tune.h2.initial-window-size applies. It can make sense to increase this value
3038 to allow faster uploads. The default value of 65536 allows up to 5 Mbps of
3039 bandwidth per client over a 100 ms ping time, and 500 Mbps for 1 ms ping
3040 time. It doesn't affect resource usage. Using too large values may cause
3041 clients to experience a lack of responsiveness if pages are accessed in
Tim Duesterhuse3ebe0e2023-06-13 15:15:47 +02003042 parallel to large uploads.
3043
3044 See also: tune.h2.initial-window-size.
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003045
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003046tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams <number>
3047 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per incoming connection
3048 (i.e. the number of outstanding requests on a single connection from a
3049 client). When not set, the default set by tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
3050 applies. A larger value than the default 100 may sometimes slightly improve
3051 the page load time for complex sites with lots of small objects over high
3052 latency networks but can also result in using more memory by allowing a
3053 client to allocate more resources at once. The default value of 100 is
3054 generally good and it is recommended not to change this value.
3055
Willy Tarreau4869ed52023-10-13 18:11:59 +02003056tune.h2.fe.max-total-streams <number>
3057 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of total streams processed per incoming
3058 connection. Once this limit is reached, HAProxy will send a graceful GOAWAY
3059 frame informing the client that it will close the connection after all
3060 pending streams have been closed. In practice, clients tend to close as fast
3061 as possible when receiving this, and to establish a new connection for next
3062 requests. Doing this is sometimes useful and desired in situations where
3063 clients stay connected for a very long time and cause some imbalance inside a
3064 farm. For example, in some highly dynamic environments, it is possible that
3065 new load balancers are instantiated on the fly to adapt to a load increase,
3066 and that once the load goes down they should be stopped without breaking
3067 established connections. By setting a limit here, the connections will have
3068 a limited lifetime and will be frequently renewed, with some possibly being
3069 established to other nodes, so that existing resources are quickly released.
3070
3071 It's important to understand that there is an implicit relation between this
3072 limit and "tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams" above. Indeed, HAProxy will
3073 always accept to process any possibly pending streams that might be in flight
3074 between the client and the frontend, so the advertised limit will always
3075 automatically be raised by the value configured in max-concurrent-streams,
3076 and this value will serve as a hard limit above which a violation by a non-
3077 compliant client will result in the connection being closed. Thus when
3078 counting the number of requests per connection from the logs, any number
3079 between max-total-streams and (max-total-streams + max-concurrent-streams)
3080 may be observed depending on how fast streams are created by the client.
3081
3082 The default value is zero, which enforces no limit beyond those implied by
3083 the protocol (2^30 ~= 1.07 billion). Values around 1000 may already cause
3084 frequent connection renewal without causing any perceptible latency to most
3085 clients. Setting it too low may result in an increase of CPU usage due to
3086 frequent TLS reconnections, in addition to increased page load time. Please
3087 note that some load testing tools do not support reconnections and may report
3088 errors with this setting; as such it may be needed to disable it when running
3089 performance benchmarks. See also "tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams".
3090
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02003091tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
3092 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
3093 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
3094 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
3095 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
3096 change it.
3097
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02003098tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003099 Sets the default value for the HTTP/2 initial window size, on both incoming
3100 and outgoing connections. This value is used for incoming connections when
3101 tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size is not set, and by outgoing connections when
3102 tune.h2.be.initial-window-size is not set. The default value is 65536, which
3103 for uploads roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of bandwidth per client over a
3104 network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps over a 1-ms local network.
3105 Given that changing the default value will both increase upload speeds and
3106 cause more unfairness between clients on downloads, it is recommended to
3107 instead use the side-specific settings tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size and
3108 tune.h2.be.initial-window-size.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02003109
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02003110tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003111 Sets the default HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection
Willy Tarreau2fefab62023-05-07 07:10:55 +02003112 (i.e. the number of outstanding requests on a single connection). This value
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003113 is used for incoming connections when tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams is
3114 not set, and for outgoing connections when tune.h2.be.max-concurrent-streams
3115 is not set. The default value is 100. The impact varies depending on the side
3116 so please see the two settings above for more details. It is recommended not
3117 to use this setting and to switch to the per-side ones instead. A value of
3118 zero disables the limit so a single client may create as many streams as
3119 allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02003120
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01003121tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003122 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01003123 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003124 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01003125 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
3126 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
3127 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
3128 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
3129
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003130tune.http.cookielen <number>
3131 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
3132 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
3133 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
3134 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
3135 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
3136 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
3137 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
3138 to change this value.
3139
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02003140tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003141 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
3142 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02003143 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003144 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02003145 configuration directives too.
3146 The default value is 1024.
3147
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02003148tune.http.maxhdr <number>
3149 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
3150 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
3151 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
3152 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
3153 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
3154 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02003155 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
3156 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
3157 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02003158
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02003159tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
3160 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
3161 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
3162 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
3163 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
3164 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
3165 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01003166 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
3167 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
3168 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
3169 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
3170 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02003171
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01003172tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003173 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01003174 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
3175 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
3176 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
3177 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003178 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003179 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003180 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01003181 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
3182
Willy Tarreau73101642023-04-22 22:06:23 +02003183tune.listener.default-shards { by-process | by-thread | by-group }
3184 Normally, all "bind" lines will create a single shard, that is, a single
3185 socket that all threads of the process will listen to. With many threads,
3186 this is not very efficient, and may even induce some important overhead in
3187 the kernel for updating the polling state or even distributing events to the
3188 various threads. Modern operating systems support balancing of incoming
3189 connections, a mechanism that will consist in permitting multiple sockets to
3190 be bound to the same address and port, and to evenly distribute all incoming
3191 connections to these sockets so that each thread only sees the connections
3192 that are waiting in the socket it is bound to. This significantly reduces
3193 kernel-side overhead and increases performance in the incoming connection
3194 path. This is usually enabled in HAProxy using the "shards" setting on "bind"
3195 lines, which defaults to 1, meaning that each listener will be unique in the
3196 process. On systems with many processors, it may be more convenient to change
3197 the default setting to "by-thread" in order to always create one listening
3198 socket per thread, or "by-group" in order to always create one listening
3199 socket per thread group. Be careful about the file descriptor usage with
3200 "by-thread" as each listener will need as many sockets as there are threads.
3201 Also some operating systems (e.g. FreeBSD) are limited to no more than 256
3202 sockets on a same address. Note that "by-group" will remain equivalent to
3203 "by-process" for default configurations involving a single thread group, and
3204 will fall back to sharing the same socket on systems that do not support this
Willy Tarreau0e875cf2023-04-23 00:51:59 +02003205 mechanism. The default is "by-group" with a fallback to "by-process" for
3206 systems or socket families that do not support multiple bindings.
Willy Tarreau73101642023-04-22 22:06:23 +02003207
Willy Tarreau84fe1f42023-04-20 15:40:38 +02003208tune.listener.multi-queue { on | fair | off }
3209 Enables ('on' / 'fair') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept
3210 which spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to
3211 run on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01003212 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
3213 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
Willy Tarreau84fe1f42023-04-20 15:40:38 +02003214 with one thread for example). The default mode, "on", optimizes the choice of
3215 a thread by picking in a sample the one with the less connections. It is
3216 often the best choice when connections are long-lived as it manages to keep
3217 all threads busy. A second mode, "fair", instead cycles through all threads
3218 regardless of their instant load level. It can be better suited for short-
3219 lived connections, or on machines with very large numbers of threads where
3220 the probability to find the least loaded thread with the first mode is low.
3221 Finally it is possible to forcefully disable the redistribution mechanism
3222 using "off" for troubleshooting, or for situations where connections are
Willy Tarreau2fefab62023-05-07 07:10:55 +02003223 short-lived and it is estimated that the operating system already provides a
Willy Tarreau84fe1f42023-04-20 15:40:38 +02003224 good enough distribution. The default is "on".
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01003225
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003226tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
3227 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003228 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003229 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
3230 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003231 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003232 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
3233 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
3234
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01003235tune.lua.maxmem
3236 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
3237 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
3238 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
3239 memory.
3240
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003241tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
3242 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003243 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
3244 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003245 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003246
Aurelien DARRAGON58e36e52023-04-06 22:51:56 +02003247tune.lua.burst-timeout <timeout>
3248 The "burst" execution timeout applies to any Lua handler. If the handler
3249 fails to finish or yield before timeout is reached, it will be aborted to
3250 prevent thread contention, to prevent traffic from not being served for too
3251 long, and ultimately to prevent the process from crashing because of the
3252 watchdog kicking in. Unlike other lua timeouts which are yield-cumulative,
3253 burst-timeout will ensure that the time spent in a single lua execution
3254 window does not exceed the configured timeout.
3255
3256 Yielding here means that the lua execution is effectively interrupted
3257 either through an explicit call to lua-yielding function such as
3258 core.(m)sleep() or core.yield(), or following an automatic forced-yield
3259 (see tune.lua.forced-yield) and that it will be resumed later when the
3260 related task is set for rescheduling. Not all lua handlers may yield: we have
3261 to make a distinction between yieldable handlers and unyieldable handlers.
3262
3263 For yieldable handlers (tasks, actions..), reaching the timeout means
3264 "tune.lua.forced-yield" might be too high for the system, reducing it
3265 could improve the situation, but it could also be a good idea to check if
3266 adding manual yields at some key points within the lua function helps or not.
3267 It may also indicate that the handler is spending too much time in a specific
3268 lua library function that cannot be interrupted.
3269
3270 For unyieldable handlers (lua converters, sample fetches), it could simply
3271 indicate that the handler is doing too much computation, which could result
3272 from an improper design given that such handlers, which often block the
3273 request execution flow, are expected to terminate quickly to allow the
3274 request processing to go through. A common resolution approach here would be
3275 to try to better optimize the lua function for speed since decreasing
3276 "tune.lua.forced-yield" won't help.
3277
3278 This timeout only counts the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a core.sleep,
3279 the sleeping time is not taken in account. The default timeout is 1000ms.
3280
3281 Note: if a lua GC cycle is initiated from the handler (either explicitly
3282 requested or automatically triggered by lua after some time), the GC cycle
3283 time will also be accounted for.
3284
3285 Indeed, there is no way to deduce the GC cycle time, so this could lead to
3286 some false positives on saturated systems (where GC is having hard time to
3287 catch up and consumes most of the available execution runtime). If it were
3288 to be the case, here are some resolution leads:
3289
3290 - checking if the script could be optimized to reduce lua memory footprint
3291 - fine-tuning lua GC parameters and / or requesting manual GC cycles
3292 (see: https://www.lua.org/manual/5.4/manual.html#pdf-collectgarbage)
3293 - increasing tune.lua.burst-timeout
3294
3295 Setting value to 0 completely disables this protection.
3296
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003297tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
3298 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
3299 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
3300 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003301 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003302
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003303tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
3304 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
3305 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
3306 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
3307 check servers.
3308
Tristan2632d042023-10-23 13:07:39 +01003309tune.lua.log.loggers { on | off }
3310 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') logging the output of LUA scripts via the
3311 loggers applicable to the current proxy, if any.
3312
3313 Defaults to 'on'.
3314
3315tune.lua.log.stderr { on | auto | off }
3316 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') logging the output of LUA scripts via
3317 stderr.
3318 When set to 'auto', logging via stderr is conditionally 'on' if any of:
3319
3320 - tune.lua.log.loggers is set to 'off'
3321 - the script is executed in a non-proxy context with no global logger
3322 - the script is executed in a proxy context with no logger attached
3323
3324 Please note that, when enabled, this logging is in addition to the logging
3325 configured via tune.lua.log.loggers.
3326
3327 Defaults to 'on'.
3328
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01003329tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01003330 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
3331 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01003332 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
3333 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
3334 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
3335 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
3336 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
3337 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
3338 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
3339 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
3340 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01003341
3342tune.maxpollevents <number>
3343 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
3344 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
3345 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
3346 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
3347 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
3348
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02003349tune.maxrewrite <number>
3350 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
3351 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
3352 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
3353 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
3354 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
3355 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
3356 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
3357 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
3358 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
3359 bufsize.
3360
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01003361tune.memory.hot-size <number>
3362 Sets the per-thread amount of memory that will be kept hot in the local cache
3363 and will never be recoverable by other threads. Access to this memory is very
3364 fast (lockless), and having enough is critical to maintain a good performance
3365 level under extreme thread contention. The value is expressed in bytes, and
3366 the default value is configured at build time via CONFIG_HAP_POOL_CACHE_SIZE
3367 which defaults to 524288 (512 kB). A larger value may increase performance in
3368 some usage scenarios, especially when performance profiles show that memory
3369 allocation is stressed a lot. Experience shows that a good value sits between
3370 once to twice the per CPU core L2 cache size. Too large values will have a
3371 negative impact on performance by making inefficient use of the L3 caches in
3372 the CPUs, and will consume larger amounts of memory. It is recommended not to
3373 change this value, or to proceed in small increments. In order to completely
3374 disable the per-thread CPU caches, using a very small value could work, but
3375 it is better to use "-dMno-cache" on the command-line.
3376
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003377tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
3378 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
3379 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
3380 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
3381 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
3382 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
3383 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
3384 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
3385 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
3386 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02003387 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
3388 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003389 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
3390 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
3391 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
3392 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
3393 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
3394 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
3395 setting this parameter to 0.
3396
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02003397tune.peers.max-updates-at-once <number>
3398 Sets the maximum number of stick-table updates that haproxy will try to
3399 process at once when sending messages. Retrieving the data for these updates
3400 requires some locking operations which can be CPU intensive on highly
3401 threaded machines if unbound, and may also increase the traffic latency
3402 during the initial batched transfer between an older and a newer process.
3403 Conversely low values may also incur higher CPU overhead, and take longer
3404 to complete. The default value is 200 and it is suggested not to change it.
3405
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02003406tune.pipesize <number>
3407 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
3408 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
3409 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
3410 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
3411 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
3412 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
3413
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003414tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
3415 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003416 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003417 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
3418 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
3419 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
3420 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003421 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003422
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003423tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
3424 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003425 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003426 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
3427 default is 20.
3428
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003429tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit <number>
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003430 This settings defines the maximum number of buffers allocated for a QUIC
3431 connection on data emission. By default, it is set to 30. QUIC buffers are
3432 drained on ACK reception. This setting has a direct impact on the throughput
3433 and memory consumption and can be adjusted according to an estimated round
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003434 time-trip. Each buffer is tune.bufsize.
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003435
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02003436tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout <timeout>
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02003437 Sets the QUIC max_idle_timeout transport parameters in milliseconds for
3438 frontends which determines the period of time after which a connection silently
3439 closes if it has remained inactive during an effective period of time deduced
3440 from the two max_idle_timeout values announced by the two endpoints:
3441 - the minimum of the two values if both are not null,
3442 - the maximum if only one of them is not null,
3443 - if both values are null, this feature is disabled.
3444
3445 The default value is 30000.
3446
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02003447tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi <number>
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02003448 Sets the QUIC initial_max_streams_bidi transport parameter for frontends.
3449 This is the initial maximum number of bidirectional streams the remote peer
3450 will be authorized to open. This determines the number of concurrent client
3451 requests.
3452
3453 The default value is 100.
3454
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01003455tune.quic.max-frame-loss <number>
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01003456 Sets the limit for which a single QUIC frame can be marked as lost. If
3457 exceeded, the connection is considered as failing and is closed immediately.
3458
3459 The default value is 10.
3460
Frederic Lecaillef1724f42024-02-13 19:38:46 +01003461tune.quic.reorder-ratio <0..100, in percent>
3462 The ratio applied to the packet reordering threshold calculated. It may
3463 trigger a high packet loss detection when too small.
3464
3465 The default value is 50.
3466
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003467tune.quic.retry-threshold <number>
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003468 Dynamically enables the Retry feature for all the configured QUIC listeners
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02003469 as soon as this number of half open connections is reached. A half open
3470 connection is a connection whose handshake has not already successfully
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003471 completed or failed. To be functional this setting needs a cluster secret to
3472 be set, if not it will be silently ignored (see "cluster-secret" setting).
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02003473 This setting will be also silently ignored if the use of QUIC Retry was
3474 forced (see "quic-force-retry").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003475
3476 The default value is 100.
3477
3478 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
3479 information about QUIC retry.
3480
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003481tune.quic.socket-owner { listener | connection }
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003482 Specifies how QUIC connections will use socket for receive/send operations.
3483 Connections can share listener socket or each connection can allocate its
3484 own socket.
3485
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003486 When default "connection" value is set, a dedicated socket will be allocated
3487 by every QUIC connections. This option is the preferred one to achieve the
Amaury Denoyellefb375572023-02-01 09:28:32 +01003488 best performance with a large QUIC traffic. This is also the only way to
Amaury Denoyellee1a0ee32023-02-28 15:11:09 +01003489 ensure soft-stop is conducted properly without data loss for QUIC connections
3490 and cases of transient errors during sendto() operation are handled
3491 efficiently. However, this relies on some advanced features from the UDP
Amaury Denoyellefb375572023-02-01 09:28:32 +01003492 network stack. If your platform is deemed not compatible, haproxy will
Willy Tarreau2a3d9282023-08-29 10:22:46 +02003493 automatically switch to "listener" mode on startup. Please note that QUIC
3494 listeners running on privileged ports may require to run as uid 0, or some
Willy Tarreaua547a212023-08-29 10:24:26 +02003495 OS-specific tuning to permit the target uid to bind such ports, such as
3496 system capabilities. See also the "setcap" global directive.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003497
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003498 The "listener" value indicates that QUIC transfers will occur on the shared
3499 listener socket. This option can be a good compromise for small traffic as it
3500 allows to reduce FD consumption. However, performance won't be optimal due to
Ilya Shipitsin5fa29b82022-12-07 09:46:19 +05003501 a higher CPU usage if listeners are shared across a lot of threads or a
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003502 large number of QUIC connections can be used simultaneously.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003503
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003504tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
3505tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
3506 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
3507 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3508 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003509 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003510 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003511 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3512 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3513
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003514tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003515 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003516 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
3517 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
3518 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
3519 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
3520
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003521tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003522 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01003523 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
3524 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
3525 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
3526 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
3527 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
3528 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
3529 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003530
3531tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
3532 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003533 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003534 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
3535 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
3536 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
3537 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
3538 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
3539 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
3540 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003541
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003542tune.sndbuf.client <number>
3543tune.sndbuf.server <number>
3544 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
3545 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3546 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003547 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003548 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003549 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3550 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3551 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
3552 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003553 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003554
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003555tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01003556 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01003557 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
3558 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
3559 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
3560 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
3561 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
3562 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
3563 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
3564 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
3565 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02003566 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
3567 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003568
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003569tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
3570tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
3571 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
3572 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
3573 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
3574 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
3575
3576tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
3577 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
3578 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
3579 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
3580 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
3581 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
3582 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
3583 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
3584 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
3585 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
3586 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
3587 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
3588 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
3589
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003590tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02003591 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003592 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
3593 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
3594 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
3595 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
3596 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
3597
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003598tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord <number>
3599 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at any time. Default
3600 value 0 means there is no limit. In contrast to tune.ssl.maxrecord this
3601 settings will not be adjusted dynamically. Smaller records may decrease
3602 throughput, but may be required when dealing with low-footprint clients.
3603
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003604tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
3605 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
3606 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
3607 performances. This is disabled by default.
3608
3609 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
3610 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
3611
3612 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
3613
3614 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
3615
3616 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
3617
3618 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
3619 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
3620 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
3621
3622 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
3623 converted.
3624
3625 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
3626 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
3627 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
3628 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
3629 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
3630 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
3631 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02003632 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
3633 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003634
3635 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
3636
3637 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
3638 only need this line:
3639
3640 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
3641
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003642tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
3643 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003644 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003645 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
3646 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
3647 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
3648 being used for too long.
3649
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003650tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003651 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at the beginning of
3652 the data transfer. Default value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS,
3653 the client can decipher the data only once it has received a full record.
3654 With large records, it means that clients might have to download up to 16kB
3655 of data before starting to process them. Limiting the value can improve page
3656 load times on browsers located over high latency or low bandwidth networks.
3657 It is suggested to find optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments
3658 (generally 1448 bytes over Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when
3659 timestamps are disabled), keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead.
3660 Typical values of 1419 and 2859 gave good results during tests. Use
3661 "strace -e trace=write" to find the best value. HAProxy will automatically
3662 switch to this setting after an idle stream has been detected (see
3663 tune.idletimer above). See also tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord.
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003664
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02003665tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
3666 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3667 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3668 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3669 1000 entries.
3670
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +01003671tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay <number>
3672 Sets the maximum interval between two automatic updates of the same OCSP
3673 response. This time is expressed in seconds and defaults to 3600 (1 hour). It
3674 must be set to a higher value than "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay". See
3675 option "ocsp-update" for more information about the auto update mechanism.
3676
3677tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay <number>
3678 Sets the minimum interval between two automatic updates of the same OCSP
3679 response. This time is expressed in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 minutes).
3680 It is particularly useful for OCSP response that do not have explicit
3681 expiration times. It must be set to a lower value than
3682 "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay". See option "ocsp-update" for more
3683 information about the auto update mechanism.
3684
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01003685tune.stick-counters <number>
3686 Sets the number of stick-counters that may be tracked at the same time by a
3687 connection or a request via "track-sc*" actions in "tcp-request" or
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02003688 "http-request" rules. The default value is set at build time by the macro
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01003689 MAX_SESS_STK_CTR, and defaults to 3. With this setting it is possible to
3690 change the value and ignore the one passed at build time. Increasing this
3691 value may be needed when porting complex configurations to haproxy, but users
3692 are warned against the costs: each entry takes 16 bytes per connection and
3693 16 bytes per request, all of which need to be allocated and zeroed for all
3694 requests even when not used. As such a value of 10 will inflate the memory
3695 consumption per request by 320 bytes and will cause this memory to be erased
3696 for each request, which does have measurable CPU impacts. Conversely, when
3697 no "track-sc" rules are used, the value may be lowered (0 being valid to
3698 entirely disable stick-counters).
3699
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003700tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003701tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003702tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
3703tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
3704tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003705 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
3706 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
3707 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
3708 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
3709 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
3710 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
3711 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
3712 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003713
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003714 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
3715 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
3716 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
3717 all available space is consumed.
3718 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
3719 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
3720 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003721
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003722tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
3723 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003724 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003725 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003726 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003727 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
3728
3729tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
3730 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
3731 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003732 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
3733 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003734
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037353.3. Debugging
3736--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003737
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003738anonkey <key>
3739 This sets the global anonymizing key to <key>, which must be a 32-bit number
3740 between 0 and 4294967295. This is the key that will be used by default by CLI
3741 commands when anonymized mode is enabled. This key may also be set at runtime
Amaury Denoyelledd3a33f2023-03-03 17:11:10 +01003742 from the CLI command "set anon global-key". See also command line argument
3743 "-dC" in the management manual.
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003744
Willy Tarreaue98d3852022-11-15 09:34:07 +01003745quick-exit
3746 This speeds up the old process exit upon reload by skipping the releasing of
3747 memory objects and listeners, since all of these are reclaimed by the
3748 operating system at the process' death. The gains are only marginal (in the
3749 order of a few hundred milliseconds for huge configurations at most). The
3750 main target usage in fact is when a bug is spotted in the deinit() code, as
3751 this allows to bypass it. It is better not to use this unless instructed to
3752 do so by developers.
3753
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003754quiet
3755 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
3756 line argument "-q".
3757
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003758zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003759 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003760 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
3761 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
3762 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
3763 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
3764 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
3765
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003766
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010037673.4. Userlists
3768--------------
3769It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
3770http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
3771it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
3772
3773userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003774 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003775 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
3776
3777group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003778 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003779 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
3780 proceeded by "users" keyword.
3781
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003782user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
3783 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003784 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
3785 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003786 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
3787 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
3788 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
3789 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003790
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003791 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
3792 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
3793 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
3794 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
3795 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
3796 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
3797 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003798 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003799 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003800
3801 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003802 userlist L1
3803 group G1 users tiger,scott
3804 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003805
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003806 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3807 user scott insecure-password elgato
3808 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003809
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003810 userlist L2
3811 group G1
3812 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003813
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003814 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3815 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3816 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003817
3818 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003819
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003820
38213.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003822----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003823It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003824several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003825instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003826values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3827type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3828values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3829active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3830switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3831present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3832watch it.
3833
3834Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3835known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3836the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3837process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3838during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3839tables.
3840
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003841Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3842that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3843each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003844
3845peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003846 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003847 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3848
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003849bind [<address>]:port [param*]
3850bind /<path> [param*]
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003851 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3852 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3853
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003854disabled
3855 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3856 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3857 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3858
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003859default-bind [param*]
3860 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3861
3862default-server [param*]
3863 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3864
3865 Arguments:
3866 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3867 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003868 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3869 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3870 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3871 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003872
3873 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3874
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003875enabled
3876 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3877 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003878
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003879log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003880 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3881 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3882 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3883 more details.
3884
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003885peer <peername> [<address>]:port [param*]
3886peer <peername> /<path> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003887 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3888 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003889 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003890 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on the provided
3891 address. Otherwise, the address defines where to connect to in order to join
3892 the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003893 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003894
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003895 During a soft restart, local peer address is used by the old instance to
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003896 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3897
3898 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003899 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3900 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3901 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003902
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003903 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3904 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003905
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003906 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3907 "server" keyword explanation below).
3908
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003909server <peername> [<address>:<port>] [param*]
3910server <peername> [/<path>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003911 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003912 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003913 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, the address
3914 parameter must not be present; it must be provided on a "bind" line (see
3915 "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003916
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003917 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3918 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3919 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3920 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3921 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003922
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003923 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003924 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003925 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003926 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3927 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3928 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003929
3930 backend mybackend
3931 mode tcp
3932 balance roundrobin
3933 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3934 stick on src
3935
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003936 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3937 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003938
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003939 Example:
3940 peers mypeers
Emeric Brune77984f2022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003941 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3942 default-server ssl verify none
3943 server haproxy1 #local peer
3944 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3945 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003946
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +02003947shards <shards>
3948
3949 In some configurations, one would like to distribute the stick-table contents
3950 to some peers in place of sending all the stick-table contents to each peer
3951 declared in the "peers" section. In such cases, "shards" specifies the
3952 number of peer involved in this stick-table contents distribution.
3953 See also "shard" server parameter.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003954
3955table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3956 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3957
3958 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3959 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003960 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003961 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3962 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3963 "stick-table" keyword).
3964
3965 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3966 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3967 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3968 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3969 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3970 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3971 of the stick-table name as follows:
3972
3973 peers mypeers
3974 peer A ...
3975 peer B ...
3976 table t1 ...
3977
3978 frontend fe1
3979 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3980
3981 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3982 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3983
3984 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3985 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3986 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3987 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3988 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3989 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3990 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3991
3992 peers mypeers
3993 peer A ...
3994 peer B ...
3995 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3996
3997 backend t1
3998 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3999
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004000 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01004001 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
4002 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
4003
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090040043.6. Mailers
4005------------
4006It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
4007If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
4008in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
4009
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02004010mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004011 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
4012 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
4013
4014mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
4015 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
4016
4017 Example:
4018 mailers mymailers
4019 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
4020 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
4021
4022 backend mybackend
4023 mode tcp
4024 balance roundrobin
4025
4026 email-alert mailers mymailers
4027 email-alert from test1@horms.org
4028 email-alert to test2@horms.org
4029
4030 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
4031 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
4032
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01004033timeout mail <time>
4034 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
4035 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
4036 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
4037 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
4038
4039 Example:
4040 mailers mymailers
4041 timeout mail 20s
4042 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004043
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020040443.7. Programs
4045-------------
4046In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
4047master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
4048managed the same way as the workers.
4049
4050During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
4051sequence as a worker:
4052
4053 - the master is re-executed
4054 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
4055 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
4056 instance of the program
4057
4058During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
4059
4060program <name>
4061 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
4062 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
4063 the management guide).
4064
4065command <command> [arguments*]
4066 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
4067 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
4068 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
4069 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
4070
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08004071user <user name>
4072 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
4073 See also "group".
4074
4075group <group name>
4076 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
4077 See also "user".
4078
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02004079option start-on-reload
4080no option start-on-reload
4081 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
4082 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
4083 program section.
4084
4085
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010040863.8. HTTP-errors
4087----------------
4088
4089It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
4090imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
4091several places and can be fully or partially imported.
4092
4093http-errors <name>
4094 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
4095 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
4096
4097errorfile <code> <file>
4098 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
4099
4100 Arguments :
4101 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004102 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004103 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004104
4105 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
4106 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
4107 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
4108 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4109 before any chroot is performed.
4110
4111 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
4112
4113 Example:
4114 http-errors website-1
4115 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
4116 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
4117 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
4118
4119 http-errors website-2
4120 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
4121 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
4122 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
4123
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020041243.9. Rings
4125----------
4126
4127It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
4128servers or traces.
4129
4130ring <ringname>
4131 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
4132
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02004133backing-file <path>
4134 This replaces the regular memory allocation by a RAM-mapped file to store the
4135 ring. This can be useful for collecting traces or logs for post-mortem
4136 analysis, without having to attach a slow client to the CLI. Newer contents
4137 will automatically replace older ones so that the latest contents are always
4138 available. The contents written to the ring will be visible in that file once
4139 the process stops (most often they will even be seen very soon after but
4140 there is no such guarantee since writes are not synchronous).
4141
4142 When this option is used, the total storage area is reduced by the size of
4143 the "struct ring" that starts at the beginning of the area, and that is
4144 required to recover the area's contents. The file will be created with the
4145 starting user's ownership, with mode 0600 and will be of the size configured
Willy Tarreau32872db2022-08-31 18:52:17 +02004146 by the "size" directive. When the directive is parsed (thus even during
4147 config checks), any existing non-empty file will first be renamed with the
4148 extra suffix ".bak", and any previously existing file with suffix ".bak" will
4149 be removed. This ensures that instant reload or restart of the process will
4150 not wipe precious debugging information, and will leave time for an admin to
4151 spot this new ".bak" file and to archive it if needed. As such, after a crash
4152 the file designated by <path> will contain the freshest information, and if
4153 the service is restarted, the "<path>.bak" file will have it instead. This
4154 means that the total storage capacity required will be double of the ring
4155 size. Failures to rotate the file are silently ignored, so placing the file
4156 into a directory without write permissions will be sufficient to avoid the
4157 backup file if not desired.
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02004158
4159 WARNING: there are stability and security implications in using this feature.
4160 First, backing the ring to a slow device (e.g. physical hard drive) may cause
4161 perceptible slowdowns during accesses, and possibly even panics if too many
4162 threads compete for accesses. Second, an external process modifying the area
4163 could cause the haproxy process to crash or to overwrite some of its own
4164 memory with traces. Third, if the file system fills up before the ring,
4165 writes to the ring may cause the process to crash.
4166
4167 The information present in this ring are structured and are NOT directly
4168 readable using a text editor (even though most of it looks barely readable).
4169 The output of this file is only intended for developers.
4170
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004171description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004172 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004173 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
4174
4175format <format>
4176 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
4177
4178 Arguments:
4179 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
4180 one of the following :
4181
4182 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
4183 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
4184 designed to be used with a local log server.
4185
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01004186 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
4187 field is stripped. This is the default.
4188 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
4189 rfc3164.
4190
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004191 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
4192 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
4193 used in containers or during development, where the severity
4194 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
4195 is the default.
4196
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01004197 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004198 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
4199
4200 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
4201 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
4202
4203 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
4204 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
4205 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
4206 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
4207 logger consumes.
4208
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02004209 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
4210 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
4211 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
4212 with a local log server.
4213
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004214 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
4215 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
4216 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
4217 used with a local log server.
4218
4219maxlen <length>
4220 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
4221 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
4222 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
4223
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004224server <name> <address> [param*]
4225 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
4226 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
4227 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
4228 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
4229 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
4230 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
4231 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
4232 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
4233 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02004234 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
4235 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004236
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004237size <size>
4238 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
4239 set to BUFSIZE.
4240
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004241timeout connect <timeout>
4242 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
4243
4244 Arguments :
4245 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4246 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4247 as explained at the top of this document.
4248
4249timeout server <timeout>
4250 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
4251
4252 Arguments :
4253 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4254 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4255 as explained at the top of this document.
4256
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004257 Example:
4258 global
4259 log ring@myring local7
4260
4261 ring myring
4262 description "My local buffer"
4263 format rfc3164
4264 maxlen 1200
4265 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004266 timeout connect 5s
4267 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02004268 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004269
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020042703.10. Log forwarding
4271-------------------
4272
4273It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004274HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004275
4276log-forward <name>
4277 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
4278
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004279backlog <conns>
4280 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4281 on connections accept.
4282
4283bind <addr> [param*]
4284 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02004285 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
4286 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
4287 syslog protocol over TCP.
4288 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004289 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
4290
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02004291dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004292 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
4293 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
4294 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
4295 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02004296 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004297
4298log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01004299log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004300 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
4301 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
4302 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004303 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004304 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
4305 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
4306 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004307 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004308
4309 Example:
4310 global
4311 log stderr format iso local7
4312
4313 ring myring
4314 description "My local buffer"
4315 format rfc5424
4316 maxlen 1200
4317 size 32764
4318 timeout connect 5s
4319 timeout server 10s
4320 # syslog tcp server
4321 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
4322
4323 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004324 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
4325 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004326 # all messages on stderr
4327 log global
4328 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
4329 log ring@myring local0
4330 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
4331 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
4332 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
4333 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
4334 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004335
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004336maxconn <conns>
4337 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
4338 10 is the default.
4339
4340timeout client <timeout>
4341 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
4342
Lukas Tribus5c11eb82024-01-30 21:17:44 +000043433.11. HTTPClient tuning
4344-----------------------
4345
4346HTTPClient is an internal HTTP library, it can be used by various subsystems,
4347for example in LUA scripts. HTTPClient is not used in the data path, in other
4348words it has nothing with HTTP traffic passing through HAProxy.
4349
4350httpclient.resolvers.disabled <on|off>
4351 Disable the DNS resolution of the httpclient. Prevent the creation of the
4352 "default" resolvers section.
4353
4354 Default value is off.
4355
4356httpclient.resolvers.id <resolvers id>
4357 This option defines the resolvers section with which the httpclient will try
4358 to resolve.
4359
4360 Default option is the "default" resolvers ID. By default, if this option is
4361 not used, it will simply disable the resolving if the section is not found.
4362
4363 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
4364 configuration error if it fails to load.
4365
4366httpclient.resolvers.prefer <ipv4|ipv6>
4367 This option allows to chose which family of IP you want when resolving,
4368 which is convenient when IPv6 is not available on your network. Default
4369 option is "ipv6".
4370
4371httpclient.retries <number>
4372 This option allows to configure the number of retries attempt of the
4373 httpclient when a request failed. This does the same as the "retries" keyword
4374 in a backend.
4375
4376 Default value is 3.
4377
4378httpclient.ssl.ca-file <cafile>
4379 This option defines the ca-file which should be used to verify the server
4380 certificate. It takes the same parameters as the "ca-file" option on the
4381 server line.
4382
4383 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
4384 "@system-ca" which tries to load the CA of the system. If it fails the SSL
4385 will be disabled for the httpclient.
4386
4387 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
4388 configuration error if it fails.
4389
4390httpclient.ssl.verify [none|required]
4391 Works the same way as the verify option on server lines. If specified to 'none',
4392 servers certificates are not verified. Default option is "required".
4393
4394 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
4395 "required". If it fails the SSL will be disabled for the httpclient.
4396
4397 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
4398 configuration error if it fails.
4399
4400httpclient.timeout.connect <timeout>
4401 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt by default for the
4402 httpclient.
4403
4404 Arguments :
4405 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4406 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4407 as explained at the top of this document.
4408
4409 The default value is 5000ms.
4410
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044114. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004412----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004413
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004414Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004415 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
4416 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4417 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4418 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004419
4420A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
4421connections.
4422
4423A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
4424to forward incoming connections.
4425
4426A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
4427parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
4428
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004429A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
4430ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
4431sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
4432the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
4433explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
4434from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
4435"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
4436for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
4437to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
4438optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
4439are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
4440any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
4441names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
4442that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
4443duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02004444names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
4445is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
4446implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
4447encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
4448adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004449
4450Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
4451settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
4452of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
4453profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
4454timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
4455
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004456All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
4457'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
4458case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
4459
4460Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
4461logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
4462proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
4463However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
4464name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
4465
4466Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
4467and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004468bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004469protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
4470modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
4471arbitrary criteria.
4472
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004473In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
4474a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01004475the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004476
4477 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
4478 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
4479 between responses and new requests.
4480
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004481 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
4482 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
4483 client-facing connection remains open.
4484
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004485 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
4486 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004487
4488The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
4489frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
4490following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004491weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004492
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004493 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004494
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004495 | KAL | SCL | CLO
4496 ----+-----+-----+----
4497 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
4498 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004499 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
4500 ----+-----+-----+----
4501 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004502
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004503It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004504only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
4505within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004506as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004507content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004508and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
4509possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004510
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004511There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004512first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004513processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004514second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004515protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
4516is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
4517new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004518to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004519process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
4520already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
4521HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
4522evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
4523one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
4524
4525There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
4526performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
4527tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
4528preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
4529analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
4530HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
4531header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
4532mitigate this drawback.
4533
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004534There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004535method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
4536set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
4537in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
4538is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
4539to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
4540above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
4541to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
4542"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
4543frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
4544frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
4545as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
4546upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
4547on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
4548the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
4549upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
4550frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
4551remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004552
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020045534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
4554--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004555
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004556The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
4557limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
4558they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
4559limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004560marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004561option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02004562and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
4563with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004564specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
4565sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
4566anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004567
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004568
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004569 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
4570------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004571acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004572backlog X X X -
4573balance X - X X
4574bind - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004575capture cookie - X X -
4576capture request header - X X -
4577capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004578clitcpka-cnt X X X -
4579clitcpka-idle X X X -
4580clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004581compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004582cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004583declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004584default-server X - X X
4585default_backend X X X -
4586description - X X X
4587disabled X X X X
4588dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004589email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004590email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004591email-alert mailers X X X X
4592email-alert myhostname X X X X
4593email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004594enabled X X X X
4595errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004596errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004597errorloc X X X X
4598errorloc302 X X X X
4599-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4600errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02004601error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004602force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004603filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004604fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004605hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004606http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004607http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004608http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004609http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004610http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02004611http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02004612http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004613http-check set-var X - X X
4614http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004615http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004616http-request X (!) X X X
4617http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004618http-reuse X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGONdf238c32023-01-12 15:59:27 +01004619http-send-name-header X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004620id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004621ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004622load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004623log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004624log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004625log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004626log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004627max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGONb8e4f222023-11-29 10:13:18 +01004628max-session-srv-conns X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004629maxconn X X X -
4630mode X X X X
4631monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004632monitor-uri X X X -
4633option abortonclose (*) X - X X
4634option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
4635option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
4636option allbackups (*) X - X X
4637option checkcache (*) X - X X
4638option clitcpka (*) X X X -
4639option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02004640option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004641option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
4642option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004643-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4644option forwardfor X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01004645option forwarded (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02004646option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
4647option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004648option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02004649option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004650option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004651option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02004652option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02004653option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004654option http-server-close (*) X X X X
4655option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
4656option httpchk X - X X
4657option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01004658option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02004659option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004660option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004661option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004662option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004663option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
4664option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
4665option logasap (*) X X X -
4666option mysql-check X - X X
4667option nolinger (*) X X X X
4668option originalto X X X X
4669option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02004670option pgsql-check X - X X
4671option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004672option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004673option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004674option smtpchk X - X X
4675option socket-stats (*) X X X -
4676option splice-auto (*) X X X X
4677option splice-request (*) X X X X
4678option splice-response (*) X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +01004679option spop-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004680option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
4681option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
4682-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004683option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004684option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
4685option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
4686option tcpka X X X X
4687option tcplog X X X X
4688option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01004689option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004690external-check command X - X X
4691external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004692persist rdp-cookie X - X X
4693rate-limit sessions X X X -
4694redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004695-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004696retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02004697retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004698server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004699server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02004700server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004701source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004702srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
4703srvtcpka-idle X - X X
4704srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02004705stats admin - X X X
4706stats auth X X X X
4707stats enable X X X X
4708stats hide-version X X X X
4709stats http-request - X X X
4710stats realm X X X X
4711stats refresh X X X X
4712stats scope X X X X
4713stats show-desc X X X X
4714stats show-legends X X X X
4715stats show-node X X X X
4716stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004717-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4718stick match - - X X
4719stick on - - X X
4720stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02004721stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01004722stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004723tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004724tcp-check connect X - X X
4725tcp-check expect X - X X
4726tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004727tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004728tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004729tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004730tcp-check set-var X - X X
4731tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004732tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
4733tcp-request content X (!) X X X
4734tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
4735tcp-request session X (!) X X -
4736tcp-response content X (!) - X X
4737tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004738timeout check X - X X
4739timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004740timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004741timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004742timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
4743timeout http-request X X X X
4744timeout queue X - X X
4745timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004746timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004747timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004748timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004749transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01004750unique-id-format X X X -
4751unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004752use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02004753use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02004754use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004755------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
4756 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004757
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
4760---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004761
4762This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
4763
4764
4765acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
4766 Declare or complete an access list.
4767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004768 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
4769
4770 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
4771 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
4772 using it.
4773
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004774 Example:
4775 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
4776 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
4777 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
4778
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004779 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004780
4781
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004782backlog <conns>
4783 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4785 yes | yes | yes | no
4786 Arguments :
4787 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
4788 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004789 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004790
4791 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
4792 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
4793 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
4794 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
4795 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
4796 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
4797 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
4798 backlog parameter.
4799
4800 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
4801 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
4802 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
4803
4804 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
4805
4806
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004807balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004808balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004809 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
4810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4811 yes | no | yes | yes
4812 Arguments :
4813 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
4814 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
4815 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
4816 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
4817
4818 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4819 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
4820 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
4821 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004822 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08004823 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004824 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
4825 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
4826 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
4827 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
4828 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
4829 it, so that you don't worry.
4830
4831 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4832 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
4833 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
4834 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
4835 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
4836 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
4837 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
4838 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004839
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004840 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
4841 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
4842 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
4843 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
4844 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
4845 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
4846 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02004847 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
4848 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
4849 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004850
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004851 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004852 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004853 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
4854 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004855 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004856 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
4857 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
4858 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
4859 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
4860 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004861 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
4862 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
4863 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
4864 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
4865 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
4866 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004867
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004868 hash Takes a regular sample expression in argument. The expression
4869 is evaluated for each request and hashed according to the
4870 configured hash-type. The result of the hash is divided by
4871 the total weight of the running servers to designate which
4872 server will receive the request. This can be used in place of
4873 "source", "uri", "hdr()", "url_param()", "rdp-cookie" to make
4874 use of a converter, refine the evaluation, or be used to
4875 extract data from local variables for example. When the data
4876 is not available, round robin will apply. This algorithm is
4877 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4878 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
4879 changed using "hash-type".
4880
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004881 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
4882 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
4883 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
4884 address will always reach the same server as long as no
4885 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
4886 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
4887 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
4888 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004889 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004890 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004891 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4892 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004893 changed using "hash-type". See also the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004894
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004895 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
4896 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
4897 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
4898 the running servers. The result designates which server will
4899 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
4900 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
4901 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
4902 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
4903 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
4904 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4905 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4906 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004907
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004908 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004909 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
4910 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
4911 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
4912 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
4913 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
4914 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
4915 URIs start with a leading "/".
4916
4917 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
4918 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
4919 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
4920 evaluation stops when either is reached.
4921
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004922 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
4923 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
4924 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004925 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash. See also the
4926 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004927
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004928 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004929 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
4930
4931 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004932 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
4933 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004934 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
4935 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
4936 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
4937 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004938 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004939 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
4940 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004941
4942 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
4943 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
4944 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4945 server will receive the request.
4946
4947 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4948 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4949 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4950 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4951 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004952 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4953 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004954 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also
4955 the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004956
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004957 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4958 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4959 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4960 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4961 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004962
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004963 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004964 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4965 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4966 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4967
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004968 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4969 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004970 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4971 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004972
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004973 random
4974 random(<draws>)
4975 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004976 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4977 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4978 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4979 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004980 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4981 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4982 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4983 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4984 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4985 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4986 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4987 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4988 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4989 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4990 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4991 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4992 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4993 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4994 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4995 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4996 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4997 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4998 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4999 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005000
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02005001 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005002 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02005003 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
5004 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01005005 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02005006 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
5007 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
5008 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005009 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02005010 used instead.
5011
5012 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
5013 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
5014 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01005015 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02005016
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005017 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
5018 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02005019 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
5020 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005021
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005022 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02005023 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
5024 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005025
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01005026 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
5027 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
5028 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005029
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02005030 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05005031 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02005032 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
5033 NTLM relies on.
5034
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005035 Examples :
5036 balance roundrobin
5037 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005038 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01005039 balance hdr(User-Agent)
5040 balance hdr(host)
5041 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02005042 balance hash req.cookie(clientid)
5043 balance hash var(req.client_id)
5044 balance hash req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1),ipmask(24)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005045
5046 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
5047 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
5048
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005049 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005050 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
5051 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
5052 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005053 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005054
5055 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
5056 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
5057 defaults to 16 kB.
5058
5059 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
5060 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
5061
5062 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
5063 Round Robin.
5064
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005065 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005066 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
5067 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
5068 actually appeared in the first chunk).
5069
5070 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
5071
5072 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005073 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005074 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
5075 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
5076 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005077
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02005078 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005079
5080
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005081bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
5082bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005083 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
5084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5085 no | yes | yes | no
5086 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01005087 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
5088 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
5089 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
5090 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005091 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'. Note
Amaury Denoyelleb19d22e2024-02-15 18:43:44 +01005092 that for UDP, specific OS features are required when binding
5093 on multiple addresses to ensure the correct network interface
5094 and source address will be used on response. In other way,
5095 for QUIC listeners only bind on multiple addresses if running
5096 with a modern enough systems.
5097
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005098 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
5099 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
5100 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
5101 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5102 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5103 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02005104 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02005105 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
5106 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02005107 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02005108 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
5109 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02005110 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02005111 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
5112 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005113 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02005114 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01005115 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
5116 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
5117 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02005118 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
5119 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
5120 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
5121 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01005122 - 'quic4@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01005123 is used. Note that to achieve the best performance with a
Artur Pydoe6ca4182023-06-06 11:49:59 +02005124 large traffic you should keep "tune.quic.socket-owner" on
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01005125 connection. Else QUIC connections will be multiplexed
5126 over the listener socket. Another alternative would be to
5127 duplicate QUIC listener instances over several threads,
5128 for example using "shards" keyword to at least reduce
5129 thread contention.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01005130 - 'quic6@' -> address is resolved as IPv6 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyelle7078fb12022-11-22 11:26:16 +01005131 is used. The performance note for QUIC over IPv4 applies
5132 as well.
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005133
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005134 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5135 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
5136 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01005137
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01005138 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
5139 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005140 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
5141 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
5142 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01005143 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
5144 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
5145 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
5146 the range.
5147
5148 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
5149 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
5150 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
5151 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
5152 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
5153 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
5154 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005155 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01005156 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005157
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005158 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005159 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005160 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
5161 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
5162 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
5163 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
5164 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
5165 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
5166
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005167 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
5168 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
5169 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
5170 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02005171
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005172 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
5173 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
5174 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
5175 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
5176 in a frontend.
5177
5178 Example :
5179 listen http_proxy
5180 bind :80,:443
5181 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005182 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005183
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02005184 listen http_https_proxy
5185 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02005186 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02005187
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005188 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
5189 bind ipv6@:80
5190 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
5191 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
5192
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005193 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005194 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005195
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005196 listen h3_quic_proxy
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +02005197 bind quic4@10.0.0.1:8888 ssl crt /etc/mycrt
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005198
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02005199 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
5200 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
5201 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
5202 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
5203 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
5204
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005205 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005206 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005207
5208
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005209capture cookie <name> len <length>
5210 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
5211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5212 no | yes | yes | no
5213 Arguments :
5214 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
5215 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
5216 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
5217 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005218 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005219
5220 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
5221 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
5222 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
5223 right if it exceeds <length>.
5224
5225 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
5226 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
5227 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
5228 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
5229
5230 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
5231 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
5232 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
5233
5234 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
5235 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
5236 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01005237 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
5238 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
5239 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005240
5241 Example:
5242 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
5243
5244 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005245 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005246
5247
5248capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005249 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5251 no | yes | yes | no
5252 Arguments :
5253 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005254 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005255 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
5256 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
5257 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
5258
5259 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
5260 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
5261 it exceeds <length>.
5262
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005263 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005264 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
5265 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005266 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
5267 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
5268 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
5269 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005270 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005271 environments to find where the request came from.
5272
5273 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
5274 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
5275 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
5276 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005277
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01005278 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
5279 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
5280 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
5281 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
5282 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005283
5284 Example:
5285 capture request header Host len 15
5286 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01005287 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005289 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005290 about logging.
5291
5292
5293capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005294 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5296 no | yes | yes | no
5297 Arguments :
5298 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005299 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005300 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
5301 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
5302 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
5303
5304 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
5305 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
5306 it exceeds <length>.
5307
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005308 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005309 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
5310 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
5311 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005312 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
5313 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
5314 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
5315 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005316
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01005317 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
5318 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
5319 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
5320 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
5321 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005322
5323 Example:
5324 capture response header Content-length len 9
5325 capture response header Location len 15
5326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005327 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005328 about logging.
5329
5330
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005331clitcpka-cnt <count>
5332 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
5333 the connection on the client side.
5334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5335 yes | yes | yes | no
5336 Arguments :
5337 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
5338
5339 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
5340 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005341 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5342 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005343
5344 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
5345
5346
5347clitcpka-idle <timeout>
5348 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
5349 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
5350 client side.
5351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5352 yes | yes | yes | no
5353 Arguments :
5354 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
5355 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
5356 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
5357 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
5358
5359 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
5360 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005361 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5362 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005363
5364 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
5365
5366
5367clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
5368 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
5369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5370 yes | yes | yes | no
5371 Arguments :
5372 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
5373 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
5374 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
5375 document.
5376
5377 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
5378 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005379 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5380 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005381
5382 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
5383
5384
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005385compression algo <algorithm> ...
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005386compression algo-req <algorithm>
5387compression algo-res <algorithm>
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005388compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02005389 Enable HTTP compression.
5390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5391 yes | yes | yes | yes
5392 Arguments :
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005393 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms for
5394 responses (legacy keyword)
5395 algo-req is followed by compression algorithm for request (only one is
5396 provided).
5397 algo-res is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms for
5398 responses.
5399 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed for
5400 responses (legacy keyword).
5401 type-req is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed for
5402 requests.
5403 type-res is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed for
5404 responses.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005405
5406 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005407 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
5408 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
5409 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005410
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005411 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005412 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005413
5414 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
5415 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
5416 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
5417 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
5418 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005419 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005420
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005421 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
5422 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
5423 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
5424 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
5425 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
5426 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
5427 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005428 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005429
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04005430 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005431 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005432 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005433 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005434 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005435 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005436 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02005437
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005438 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005439 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
5440 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02005441 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005442 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005443 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
5444 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
5445 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
5446 "multipart"
5447 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
5448 header
5449 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
5450 and later
5451 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
5452 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005453 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005454
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01005455 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005456
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02005457 Examples :
5458 compression algo gzip
5459 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005460
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005461 See also : "compression offload", "compression direction"
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01005462
5463compression offload
5464 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
5465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5466 no | yes | yes | yes
5467
5468 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
5469 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
5470 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
5471 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
5472 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
5473 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
5474 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
5475 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
5476 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
5477 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
5478 then be used for such scenarios.
5479
5480 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
5481 option is ignored.
5482
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005483 See also : "compression type", "compression algo", "compression direction"
5484
5485compression direction <direction>
5486 Makes haproxy able to compress both requests and responses.
5487 Valid values are "request", to compress only requests, "response", to
5488 compress only responses, or "both", when you want to compress both.
5489 The default value is "response".
5490
5491 See also : "compression type", "compression algo", "compression offload"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005492
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005493cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005494 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
5495 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005496 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005497 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
5498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5499 yes | no | yes | yes
5500 Arguments :
5501 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
5502 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
5503 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
5504 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
5505 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
5506 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005507 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005508 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
5509 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
5510
5511 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005512 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005513 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
5514 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
5515 headers is left to the application. The application can then
5516 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005517 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
5518 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005519 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005520 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
5521 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005522
5523 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005524 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005525
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005526 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005527 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005528 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005529 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005530 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
5531 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
5532 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
5533 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
5534 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
5535 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
5536 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005537
5538 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
5539 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
5540 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
5541 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
5542 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
5543 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
5544 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
5545 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
5546 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005547 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005548 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
5549 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
5550 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005551
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005552 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
5553 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
5554 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005555 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
5556 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
5557 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
5558 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005559 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
5560 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
5561 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005562
5563 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
5564 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
5565 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
5566 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
5567 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
5568 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
5569 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
5570 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
5571 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
5572
5573 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
5574 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
5575 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
5576 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
5577 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
5578 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
5579 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
5580 persistence cookie in the cache.
5581 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
5582
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005583 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
5584 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005585 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005586 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
5587 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005588 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005589 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
5590 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
5591 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
5592 they logout.
5593
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005594 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005595 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
5596 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
5597 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
5598
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005599 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005600 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
5601 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
5602 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
5603 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
5604 this attribute.
5605
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005606 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005607 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01005608 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
5609 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
5610 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
5611 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
5612 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
5613 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005614
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005615 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
5616 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
5617 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
5618 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
5619 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
5620 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
5621 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
5622 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005623 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005624 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
5625 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
5626 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
5627 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
5628 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
5629 the site.
5630
5631 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
5632 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
5633 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
5634 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
5635 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
5636 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
5637 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
5638 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
5639 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
5640 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
5641 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
5642 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
5643 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005644 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005645 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
5646 redispatch after some absolute delay.
5647
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005648 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
5649 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
5650 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
5651 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
5652 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
5653 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
5654
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005655 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005656 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
5657 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
5658 repeated.
5659
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005660 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
5661 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
5662 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
5663 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02005664
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005665 Examples :
5666 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
5667 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5668 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005669 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005670
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02005671 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005672
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005673
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005674declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
5675 Declares a capture slot.
5676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5677 no | yes | yes | no
5678 Arguments:
5679 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
5680
5681 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
5682 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
5683 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
5684 for use in the response.
5685
5686 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02005687 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005688 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
5689
5690
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005691default-server [param*]
5692 Change default options for a server in a backend
5693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5694 yes | no | yes | yes
5695 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005696 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
5697 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
5698 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
5699 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005700
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005701 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005702 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
5703
5704 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005705
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005706
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005707default_backend <backend>
5708 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
5709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5710 yes | yes | yes | no
5711 Arguments :
5712 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
5713
5714 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
5715 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
5716 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
5717 will catch all undetermined requests.
5718
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005719 Example :
5720
5721 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
5722 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
5723 default_backend dynamic
5724
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02005725 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005726
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005727
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02005728description <string>
5729 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
5730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5731 no | yes | yes | yes
5732 Arguments : string
5733
5734 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
5735 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
5736 it describes.
5737 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
5738
5739
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005740disabled
5741 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5743 yes | yes | yes | yes
5744 Arguments : none
5745
5746 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
5747 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
5748 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
5749 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
5750 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
5751 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
5752 keyword in a "defaults" section.
5753
5754 See also : "enabled"
5755
5756
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005757dispatch <address>:<port>
5758 Set a default server address
5759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5760 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005761 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005762
5763 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
5764 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5765 during start-up.
5766
5767 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
5768 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
5769 possible with normal servers.
5770
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02005771 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005772 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
5773 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
5774 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
5775 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
5776
5777 See also : "server"
5778
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005779
5780dynamic-cookie-key <string>
5781 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
5782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5783 yes | no | yes | yes
5784 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
5785
5786 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005787 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005788 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
5789 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005790 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005791 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005792
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005793enabled
5794 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5796 yes | yes | yes | yes
5797 Arguments : none
5798
5799 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
5800 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
5801
5802 See also : "disabled"
5803
5804
5805errorfile <code> <file>
5806 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5808 yes | yes | yes | yes
5809 Arguments :
5810 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005811 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005812 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005813
5814 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005815 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005816 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005817 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
5818 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005819
5820 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5821 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5822 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5823
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005824 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5825
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02005826 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
5827 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
5828 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
5829 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
5830 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
5831 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
5832 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
5833 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
5834 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005835
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005836 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5837 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5838 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005839 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005840 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
5841
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005842 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005843
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005844 Example :
5845 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005846 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005847 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
5848 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
5849
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005850
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005851errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
5852 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
5853 section.
5854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5855 yes | yes | yes | yes
5856 Arguments :
5857 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
5858
5859 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005860 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005861 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
5862 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005863
5864 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
5865 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
5866 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
5867 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
5868 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005869 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005870 hand using "errorfile" directives.
5871
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005872 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
5873 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005874
5875 Example :
5876 errorfiles generic
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01005877 errorfiles site-1 403 404
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005878
5879
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005880errorloc <code> <url>
5881errorloc302 <code> <url>
5882 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5884 yes | yes | yes | yes
5885 Arguments :
5886 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005887 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005888 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005889
5890 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5891 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5892 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5893 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005894 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005895
5896 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5897 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5898 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5899
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005900 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5901
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005902 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
5903 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
5904 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
5905 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005906 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005907 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
5908 request.
5909
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005910 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005911
5912
5913errorloc303 <code> <url>
5914 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5916 yes | yes | yes | yes
5917 Arguments :
5918 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005919 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005920 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005921
5922 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5923 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5924 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5925 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005926 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005927
5928 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5929 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5930 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5931
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005932 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5933
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005934 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
5935 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
5936 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
5937 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005938 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005939
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005940 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005941
5942
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005943email-alert from <emailaddr>
5944 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005945 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005946 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5947 yes | yes | yes | yes
5948
5949 Arguments :
5950
5951 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
5952
5953 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5954 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5955
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005956 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02005957 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
5958 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005959
5960
5961email-alert level <level>
5962 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
5963 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
5964 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5965 yes | yes | yes | yes
5966
5967 Arguments :
5968
5969 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5970 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5971 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5972
5973 By default level is alert
5974
5975 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5976 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5977 for the proxy.
5978
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005979 Alerts are sent when :
5980
5981 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5982 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5983 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5984 is notice or lower
5985 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5986 and a health check status update occurs
5987
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005988 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5989 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005990 section 3.6 about mailers.
5991
5992
5993email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5994 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5995 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5996 yes | yes | yes | yes
5997
5998 Arguments :
5999
6000 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
6001
6002 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
6003 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
6004
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09006005 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
6006 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09006007
6008
6009email-alert myhostname <hostname>
6010 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
6011 mailers.
6012 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6013 yes | yes | yes | yes
6014
6015 Arguments :
6016
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01006017 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09006018
6019 By default the systems hostname is used.
6020
6021 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
6022 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
6023 for the proxy.
6024
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09006025 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
6026 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09006027
6028
6029email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006030 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09006031 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
6032 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6033 yes | yes | yes | yes
6034
6035 Arguments :
6036
6037 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
6038
6039 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
6040 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
6041
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09006042 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09006043 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
6044
6045
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02006046error-log-format <string>
6047 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
6048 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6049 yes | yes | yes | no
6050
6051 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
6052 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
6053 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
6054 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01006055 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
6056
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02006057 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +02006058 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.6 which covers the custom log
6059 format string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02006060
6061 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
6062 directives.
6063
6064
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006065force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6066 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
6067 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006068 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006069
6070 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
6071 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
6072 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
6073 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
6074 marked down for maintenance operations.
6075
6076 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6077 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
6078 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
6079 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
6080 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
6081 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
6082 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
6083 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
6084 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
6085
6086 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6087 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
6088 is used.
6089
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006090 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02006091 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006092
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02006093
6094filter <name> [param*]
6095 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
6096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6097 no | yes | yes | yes
6098 Arguments :
6099 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
6100 referenced in section 9.
6101
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006102 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02006103 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006104 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
6105 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02006106
6107 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
6108 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
6109
6110 Example:
6111 listen
6112 bind *:80
6113
6114 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
6115 filter compression
6116 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
6117
6118 compression algo gzip
6119 compression offload
6120
6121 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6122
6123 See also : section 9.
6124
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006125
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006126fullconn <conns>
6127 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
6128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6129 yes | no | yes | yes
6130 Arguments :
6131 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
6132 servers use the maximal number of connections.
6133
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006134 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006135 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006136 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006137 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
6138 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
6139 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
6140 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
6141 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006142 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006143
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006144 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02006145 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01006146 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
6147 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
6148 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02006149
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006150 Example :
6151 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
6152 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
6153 # connections.
6154 backend dynamic
6155 fullconn 10000
6156 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
6157 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
6158
6159 See also : "maxconn", "server"
6160
6161
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006162hash-balance-factor <factor>
6163 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
6164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6165 yes | no | no | yes
6166 Arguments :
6167 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
6168 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006169 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006170
6171 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
6172 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
6173 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
6174 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
6175 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
6176 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
6177 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
6178
6179 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
6180 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
6181 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
6182 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
6183 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
6184
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02006185 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
6186 consistent hashing mechanism.
6187
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006188 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
6189
6190
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006191hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006192 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
6193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6194 yes | no | yes | yes
6195 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006196 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
6197 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006198
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006199 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
6200 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
6201 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
6202 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
6203 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
6204 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
6205 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
6206 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
6207 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
6208 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01006209
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006210 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
6211 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
6212 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
6213 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
6214 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
6215 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
6216 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
6217 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
6218 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
6219 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
6220 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
6221 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
6222 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006223 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
6224 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006225
6226 <function> is the hash function to be used :
6227
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006228 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006229 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
6230 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
6231 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006232 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
6233 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
6234 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006235
6236 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
6237 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006238 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
6239 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
6240 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
6241 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
6242
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006243 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01006244 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
6245 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
6246 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
6247 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
6248 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
6249 parameter.
6250
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01006251 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
6252 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
6253 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
6254 used on strings.
6255
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006256 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
6257
6258 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
6259 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
6260 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
6261 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
6262 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
6263 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
6264 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
6265 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
6266 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
6267 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
6268 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
6269 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006270
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006271 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
6272 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
6273 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006274
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006275 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006276
6277
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006278http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6279 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
6280 ones).
6281
6282 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006283 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006284
6285 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
6286 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
6287 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6288 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6289 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6290 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6291
6292 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
6293 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
6294 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
6295
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006296 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6297 supported:
6298 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6299 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01006300 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006301 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006302 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006303 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006304 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6305 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01006306 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006307 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6308 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6309 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6310 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6311 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006312 - set-header <name> <fmt>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006313 - set-log-level <level>
6314 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006315 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006316 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
6317 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006318 - strict-mode { on | off }
6319 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6320
6321 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006322
6323 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
6324 instance.
6325
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006326 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6327 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6328 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6329 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6330 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6331 a defaults section defining such rules.
6332
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006333 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
6334 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
6335 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
6336
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006337 Example:
6338 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
6339 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
6340 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
6341
6342http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6343
6344 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006345 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
6346 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006347
Christopher Fauletd9d36b82023-01-05 10:25:30 +01006348http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6349
6350 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6351 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
6352
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01006353http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6354
6355 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6356 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
6357 complete description.
6358
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006359http-after-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6360
6361 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
6362 del-acl" for a complete description.
6363
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006364http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006365
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006366 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
6367 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006368
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006369http-after-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6370
6371 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
6372 del-map" for a complete description.
6373
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006374http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6375 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6376
6377 This works like "http-response replace-header".
6378
6379 Example:
6380 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
6381
6382 # applied to:
6383 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
6384
6385 # outputs:
6386 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
6387
6388 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
6389
6390http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6391 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6392
6393 This works like "http-response replace-value".
6394
6395 Example:
6396 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
6397
6398 # applied to:
6399 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
6400
6401 # outputs:
6402 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
6403
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01006404http-after-response sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6405 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6406
6407 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
6408 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
6409 a complete description.
6410
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006411http-after-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6412http-after-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6413http-after-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6414
6415 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
6416 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
6417 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
6418 description.
6419
6420http-after-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6421 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6422http-after-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6423 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6424
6425 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
6426 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +02006427 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006428
6429http-after-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6430
6431 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
6432 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
6433
6434http-after-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6435
6436 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
6437 set-map" for a complete description.
6438
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006439http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6440
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006441 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
6442 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6443 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6444 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006445
6446http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6447 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6448
6449 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05006450 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006451 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006452
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006453http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6454http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006455
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006456 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6457 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
6458 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006459
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006460http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006461
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006462 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
6463 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006464
6465http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6466
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006467 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
6468 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006469
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006470
6471http-check comment <string>
6472 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
6473 it fails.
6474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6475 yes | no | yes | yes
6476
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006477 Arguments :
6478 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
6479 rule fails.
6480
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006481 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
6482 user-friendly error reporting.
6483
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006484 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006485 "http-check expect".
6486
6487
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006488http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
6489 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01006490 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006491 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
6492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6493 yes | no | yes | yes
6494
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006495 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006496 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6497
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006498 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006499 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006500
6501 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
6502 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6503 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
6504 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
6505
6506 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
6507
6508 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6509
6510 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
6511
6512 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6513
6514 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
6515
6516 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
6517 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
6518 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
6519 is used.
6520
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02006521 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
6522 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
6523 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
6524 haproxy -vv.
6525
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006526 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
6527
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006528 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
6529 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
6530 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
6531 different ports or with different servers.
6532
6533 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6534 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
6535 the port with a "http-check connect".
6536
6537 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6538 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6539 do.
6540
6541 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
6542 unset-var or comment rules.
6543
6544 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006545 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6546 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6547 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6548 option httpchk
6549
6550 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006551 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006552 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006553 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006554 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006555 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006556
6557 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
6558
6559 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006560
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006561
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006562http-check disable-on-404
6563 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
6564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006565 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006566 Arguments : none
6567
6568 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
6569 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
6570 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
6571 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
6572 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
6573 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
6574 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
6575 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006576 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
6577 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01006578 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
6579 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
6580 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006581
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006582 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006583
6584
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006585http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006586 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
6587 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
6588 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006589 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02006591 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006592
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006593 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006594 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6595
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006596 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
6597 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
6598 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
6599 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
6600 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
6601 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
6602 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
6603 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
6604 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
6605 result is always conclusive.
6606
6607 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6608 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
6609 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006610 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
6611 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006612 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6613 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006614 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
6615 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
6616 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006617
6618 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6619 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006620 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
6621 supported :
6622 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6623 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006624 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
6625 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
6626 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
6627 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
6628 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006629
6630 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6631 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006632 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
6633 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
6634 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
6635 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006636 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
6637
6638 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6639 informational message reported in logs if the expect
6640 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
6641 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
6642
6643 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6644 informational message reported in logs if an error
6645 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
6646 log-format string.
6647
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006648 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006649 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
6650 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006651 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
6652 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
6653 details on the supported keywords.
6654
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006655 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
6656 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
6657 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
6658 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006659
6660 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
6661 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
6662 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
6663 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
6664 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
6665
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006666 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
6667 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
6668 codes. A health check response will be considered as
6669 valid if the response's status code matches any status
6670 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
6671 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6672 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006673
6674 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006675 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006676 response's status code matches the expression. If the
6677 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6678 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
6679 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
6680
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006681 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6682 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006683 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
6684 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
6685 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
6686 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
6687 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
6688 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
6689 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
6690 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006691 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
6692 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
6693 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
6694 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
6695 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
6696 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
6697 insensitive on the header names.
6698
6699 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6700 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
6701 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
6702 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
6703 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
6704 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006705
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006706 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006707 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006708 response's body contains this exact string. If the
6709 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6710 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
6711 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
6712 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006713 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006714 trace).
6715
6716 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006717 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006718 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
6719 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6720 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
6721 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
6722 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006723 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006724
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02006725 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
6726 A health check response will be considered valid if the
6727 response's body contains the string resulting of the
6728 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
6729 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6730 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
6731
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006732 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01006733 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006734 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
6735 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
6736 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
6737 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
6738 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
6739 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
6740
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006741 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
6742 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
6743 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
6744 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
6745 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01006746
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006747 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
6748 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
6749
6750 Examples :
6751 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006752 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006753
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006754 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
6755 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
6756
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006757 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006758 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006759
6760 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006761 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006762
6763 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006764 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006765
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006766 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006767 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006768
6769
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006770http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006771 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
6772 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006773 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
6774 health checks.
6775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6776 yes | no | yes | yes
6777 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006778 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6779
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006780 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
6781 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
6782 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
6783 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
6784 to invent non-standard ones.
6785
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006786 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6787 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
6788 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
6789 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6790
6791 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6792 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
6793 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6794 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006795
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02006796 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006797 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006798 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006799 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
6800 to add it.
6801
6802 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
6803 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
6804 to the log-format rules.
6805
6806 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
6807 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
6808 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006809
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006810 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
6811 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
6812 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
6813 request.
6814
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006815 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
6816 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
6817 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006818 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
6819 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
6820 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
6821 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006822 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006823
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006824 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006825 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
6826 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006827
6828 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
6829 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
6830 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
6831 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
6832 configured request authority.
6833
6834 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
6835 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006836
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006837 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006838
6839
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006840http-check send-state
6841 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
6842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6843 yes | no | yes | yes
6844 Arguments : none
6845
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006846 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006847 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006848 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
6849 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
6850 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006851
6852 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
6853 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
6854 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
6855 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
6856 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08006857 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
6858 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
6859 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6860
6861 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
6862 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
6863 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6864
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006865 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
6866 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
6867 checked in multiple backends.
6868
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006869 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006870 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
6871
6872 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
6873 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
6874 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
6875 one fails.
6876
6877 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
6878 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
6879 connections on all servers of the same backend.
6880
6881 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
6882 server's queue.
6883
6884 Example of a header received by the application server :
6885 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
6886 scur=13/22; qcur=0
6887
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006888 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
6889 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006890
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006891
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006892http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
6893http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006894 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006895 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6896 yes | no | yes | yes
6897
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006898 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006899 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6900 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6901 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6902 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6903 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6904 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6905 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6906 and '-'.
6907
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006908 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
6909 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05006910 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006911 conditions.
6912
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006913 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
6914
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006915 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +02006916 Log Format in section 8.2.6).
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006917
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006918 Examples :
6919 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006920 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006921
6922
6923http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006924 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006925 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6926 yes | no | yes | yes
6927
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006928 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006929 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6930 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6931 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6932 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6933 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6934 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6935 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6936 and '-'.
6937
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006938 Examples :
6939 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006940
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006941
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006942http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
6943 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6944 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6945 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6946 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
6947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6948 yes | yes | yes | yes
6949 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006950 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006951 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006952 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006953 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006954
6955 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
6956 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
6957 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
6958 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
6959
6960 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
6961 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
6962 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
6963 a frontend, the default error message is used.
6964
6965 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
6966 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
6967 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
6968 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
6969 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
6970 chroot is performed.
6971
6972 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
6973 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
6974 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
6975 considered.
6976
6977 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6978 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6979 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6980 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6981 considered as a raw string.
6982
6983 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
6984 The content-type must always be set as argument to
6985 "content-type".
6986
6987 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6988 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6989 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6990 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6991 evaluated as a log-format string.
6992
6993 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
6994 payload. The content-type must always be set as
6995 argument to "content-type".
6996
6997 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
6998 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
6999 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
7000 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
7001
7002 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
7003 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
7004 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
7005 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
7006 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
7007 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
7008 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
7009 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
7010
7011 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
7012 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
7013 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
7014
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01007015 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
7016 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
7017 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
7018 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
7019 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
7020
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02007021 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
7022 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
7023
7024
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007025http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007026 Access control for Layer 7 requests
7027
7028 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007029 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007030
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007031 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7032 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7033 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7034 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7035 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007036
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007037 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
7038 supported:
7039 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7040 - add-header <name> <fmt>
7041 - allow
7042 - auth [realm <realm>]
7043 - cache-use <name>
7044 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
7045 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7046 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
7047 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7048 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7049 - disable-l7-retry
7050 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
7051 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
7052 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
7053 - redirect <rule>
7054 - reject
7055 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7056 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7057 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7058 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7059 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7060 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01007061 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007062 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
7063 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
7064 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
7065 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7066 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007067 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007068 - set-dst <expr>
7069 - set-dst-port <expr>
7070 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7071 - set-log-level <level>
7072 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7073 - set-mark <mark>
7074 - set-method <fmt>
7075 - set-nice <nice>
7076 - set-path <fmt>
7077 - set-pathq <fmt>
7078 - set-priority-class <expr>
7079 - set-priority-offset <expr>
7080 - set-query <fmt>
7081 - set-src <expr>
7082 - set-src-port <expr>
7083 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
7084 - set-tos <tos>
7085 - set-uri <fmt>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01007086 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
7087 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007088 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007089 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007090 - strict-mode { on | off }
7091 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7092 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7093 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7094 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7095 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7096 - use-service <service-name>
7097 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7098 - wait-for-handshake
7099 - cache-use <name>
7100
7101 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007102
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007103 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007104
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007105 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7106 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7107 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7108 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7109 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7110 a defaults section defining such rules.
7111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007112 Example:
7113 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
7114 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
7115 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007116
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007117 http-request allow if nagios
7118 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
7119 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
7120 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01007121
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007122 Example:
7123 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
7124 acl add path /addacl
7125 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007126
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007127 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007128
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007129 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
7130 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007131
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007132 Example:
7133 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
7134 acl setmap path /setmap
7135 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007136
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007137 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007138
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007139 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
7140 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007141
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007142 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7143 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007144
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007145http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007146
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007147 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7148 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7149 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7150 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7151 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
7152 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7153 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7154 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007155
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007156http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007157
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007158 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
7159 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
7160 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
7161 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
7162 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
7163 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
7164 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
7165 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007166
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007167http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007168
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007169 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01007170 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007171
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007172http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007173
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007174 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
7175 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
7176 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
7177 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
7178 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007179
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02007180 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
7181 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
7182 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
7183 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
7184 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
7185 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
7186 instead.
7187
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007188 Example:
7189 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
7190 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007191
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007192http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007193
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007194 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007195
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007196http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
7197 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007198
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007199 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
7200 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
7201 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
7202 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
7203 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
7204 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
7205 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
7206 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
7207 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007208
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007209 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
7210 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
7211 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007212 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
7213
7214 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7215 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7216 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7217 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007218
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007219http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007220
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007221 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7222 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7223 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7224 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7225 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7226 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007227
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007228http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007229
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007230 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7231 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7232 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7233 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7234 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007235
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007236http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007237
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007238 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7239 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7240 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7241 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7242 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7243 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007244
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007245http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7246http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7247 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7248 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7249 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7250 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04007251
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007252 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
7253 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7254 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007255 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007256 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7257 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7258 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007259 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007260 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04007261
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02007262http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7263 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
7264 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
7265 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
7266
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007267http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
7268 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01007269
7270 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
7271 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
7272 pointed by <resolvers>.
7273 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
7274 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
7275 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
7276 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
7277 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
7278 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
7279 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
7280 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
7281 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
7282 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemand1ef24602022-08-26 16:38:43 +02007283 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
7284 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01007285
7286 Example:
7287 resolvers mydns
7288 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
7289 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
7290 timeout retry 1s
7291 hold valid 10s
7292 hold nx 3s
7293 hold other 3s
7294 hold obsolete 0s
7295 accepted_payload_size 8192
7296
7297 frontend fe
7298 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandb5c2cd42022-08-26 16:48:07 +02007299 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),host_only
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01007300 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
7301
7302 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
7303 # which mean DNS resolution error
7304 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
7305
7306 default_backend be
7307
7308 backend b_503
7309 # dummy backend used to return 503.
7310 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
7311 # 503 error page to end users
7312
7313 backend be
7314 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
7315 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
7316 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
7317 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
7318 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
7319
7320 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
7321 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
7322
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01007323http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7324
7325 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
7326 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
7327 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
7328 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01007329 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
7330 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01007331
7332 See RFC 8297 for more information.
7333
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007334http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02007335http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02007336http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007337http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007338http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007339http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007340http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007341http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7342http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007343
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02007344 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
7345
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02007346 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02007347 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
7348 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
7349 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
7350 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02007351
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02007352 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
7353 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
7354 the supported backend.
7355
7356 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
7357 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
7358 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
7359 number of segments in the path.
7360
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007361 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
7362 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
7363 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
7364 when improperly combined.
7365
7366 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
7367 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
7368 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
7369 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
7370 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
7371
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02007372 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007373
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02007374 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
7375
7376 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
7377 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
7378
7379 Example:
7380 - /#foo -> /%23foo
7381
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02007382 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
7383
7384 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
7385 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
7386
7387 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
7388 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
7389
7390 Example:
7391 - /#foo -> /
7392
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02007393 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
7394 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007395
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007396 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
7397 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
7398
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02007399 Example:
7400 - /. -> /
7401 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
7402 - /a/./a -> /a/a
7403 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007404
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02007405 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
7406 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
7407
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007408 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007409 their preceding segment.
7410
7411 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
7412 normalizer first if this is undesired.
7413
7414 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
7415 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007416
7417 Example:
7418 - /foo/../ -> /
7419 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
7420 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
7421 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02007422 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007423 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007424 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007425
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02007426 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
7427 removed as well:
7428
7429 Example:
7430 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
7431 - /bar/../../ -> /
7432
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007433 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
7434 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007435
7436 Example:
7437 - // -> /
7438 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
7439
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007440 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
7441 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
7442
7443 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
7444 ".", "_", and "~".
7445
7446 Example:
7447 - /%61dmin -> /admin
7448 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
7449 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
7450 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
7451
7452 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7453 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7454
7455 Example:
7456 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
7457 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
7458
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007459 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02007460 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02007461
7462 Example:
7463 - /%6f -> /%6F
7464 - /%zz -> /%zz
7465
7466 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7467 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7468
7469 Example:
7470 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
7471
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007472 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02007473 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
7474 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
7475
7476 Example:
7477 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
7478 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
7479 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
7480
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007481http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007482
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007483 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
7484 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
7485 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
7486 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
7487 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007488
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007489http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007490
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007491 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
7492 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
7493 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
7494 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007496http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7497 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02007498
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007499 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007500 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
7501 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
7502 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
7503 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
7504 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02007505
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007506 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
7507 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
7508 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
7509 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
7510 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007511
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007512 Example:
7513 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
7514
7515 # applied to:
7516 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7517
7518 # outputs:
7519 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7520
7521 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007522
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007523 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
7524
7525 # applied to:
7526 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007527
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007528 # outputs:
7529 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007530
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007531http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7532 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7533
7534 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
7535 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02007536 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
7537 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
7538 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007539
7540 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7541 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7542 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
7543
7544 Example:
7545 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7546 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
7547
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007548 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
7549 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
7550 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
7551 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
7552
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007553http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7554 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7555
7556 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
7557 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
7558 query-string are replaced.
7559
7560 Example:
7561 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
7562 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
7563
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007564http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7565 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7566
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007567 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
7568 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
7569 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
7570 against.
7571
7572 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7573 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7574 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007575
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007576 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
7577 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
7578 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
7579 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
7580 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
7581 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
7582 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
7583 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
7584 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007585 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
7586 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007587
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007588 Example:
7589 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
7590 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007591
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007592 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7593 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007594
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007595http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7596 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007597
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007598 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
7599 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
7600 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
7601 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007602
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007603 Example:
7604 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007605
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007606 # applied to:
7607 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007608
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007609 # outputs:
7610 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007611
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007612http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7613 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7614 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01007615 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007616 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7617
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007618 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007619 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7620 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007621 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007622 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007623 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007624 are followed to create the response :
7625
7626 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7627 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7628 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7629 ignored.
7630
7631 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7632 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007633 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007634 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7635 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007636
7637 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7638 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7639 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007640 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007641 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007642
7643 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7644 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7645 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007646 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007647 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007648 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007649
7650 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7651 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7652 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7653 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7654 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7655 as a raw content.
7656
7657 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7658 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7659 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7660 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7661 considered as a raw string.
7662
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007663 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007664 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7665 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7666 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7667
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007668 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7669 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007670 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007671
7672 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7673
7674 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007675 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007676 if { path /ping }
7677
7678 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
7679 if { path /favicon.ico }
7680
7681 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
7682 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
7683 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
7684
Willy Tarreau5a72d032023-01-02 18:15:20 +01007685http-request sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7686 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7687
7688 This action increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
7689 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> by the value of
7690 either integer <int> or the integer evaluation of expression <expr>. Integers
7691 and expressions are limited to unsigned 32-bit values. If an error occurs,
7692 this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues. <idx> is an
7693 integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer between 0 and 2. It also
7694 silently fails if the there is no GPC stored at this index. The entry in the
7695 table is refreshed even if the value is zero. The 'gpc_rate' is automatically
7696 adjusted to reflect the average growth rate of the gpc value.
7697
7698 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7699 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7700 There is no equivalent function for legacy data types, but if the value is
7701 always 1, please see 'sc-inc-gpc()', 'sc-inc-gpc0()' and 'sc-inc-gpc1()'.
7702 There is no way to decrement the value either, but it is possible to store
7703 exact values in a General Purpose Tag using 'sc-set-gpt()' instead.
7704
7705 The main use of this action is to count scores or total volumes (e.g.
7706 estimated danger per source IP reported by the server or a WAF, total
7707 uploaded bytes, etc).
7708
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007709http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7710
7711 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7712 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7713 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7714 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7715 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7716 at this index.
7717 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7718 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007720http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7721http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007722
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007723 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7724 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7725 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007726
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007727http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7728 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7729 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7730 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7731 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7732 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7733 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7734 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7735 at this index.
7736 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7737 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7738
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007739http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7740 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007741
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007742 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7743 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7744 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7745 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007746
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007747http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7748 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7749
7750 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7751 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7752 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7753 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7754 agent name must be used.
7755
7756 Arguments:
7757 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
7758
7759 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7760 configuration.
7761
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007762http-request set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
7763 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007764
7765 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
7766 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Custom
7767 limit and period may be defined, if and only if <name> references a
7768 per-stream bandwidth limitation filter. When a set-bandwidth-limit rule is
7769 executed, it first resets all settings of the filter to their defaults prior
7770 to enabling it. As a consequence, if several "set-bandwidth-limit" actions
7771 are executed for the same filter, only the last one is considered. Several
7772 bandwidth limitation filters can be enabled on the same stream.
7773
7774 Note that this action cannot be used in a defaults section because bandwidth
7775 limitation filters cannot be defined in defaults sections. In addition, only
7776 the HTTP payload transfer is limited. The HTTP headers are not considered.
7777
7778 Arguments:
7779 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7780 by some converters. The result is converted to an integer. It is
7781 interpreted as a size in bytes for the "limit" parameter and as a
7782 duration in milliseconds for the "period" parameter.
7783
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007784 <size> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
7785 bytes.
7786
7787 <time> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in
7788 milliseconds.
7789
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007790 Example:
7791 http-request set-bandwidth-limit global-limit
7792 http-request set-bandwidth-limit my-limit limit 1m period 10s
7793
7794 See section 9.7 about bandwidth limitation filter setup.
7795
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007796http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007797
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007798 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
7799 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
7800 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
7801 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
7802 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007803
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007804 Arguments:
7805 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7806 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007807
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007808 Example:
7809 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
7810 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007811
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007812 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
7813 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007814
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007815http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007816
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007817 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
7818 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
7819 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007820
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007821 Arguments:
7822 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7823 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007824
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007825 Example:
7826 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
7827 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007828
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007829 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
7830 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
7831 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007832
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007833http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007834
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007835 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
7836 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7837 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7838 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
7839 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007840
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007841 Example:
7842 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
7843 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
7844 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
7845 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
7846 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
7847 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
7848 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
7849 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
7850 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007851
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007852http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007853
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007854 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7855 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7856 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7857 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
7858 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007859
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007860http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7861 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007862
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007863 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7864 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7865 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7866 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7867 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
7868 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
7869 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
7870 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
7871 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007872
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007873http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007874
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007875 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7876 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7877 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7878 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
7879 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7880 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7881 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007882 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7883 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007884
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007885http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007886
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007887 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
7888 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
7889 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007890
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007891http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007892
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007893 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
7894 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
7895 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
7896 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
7897 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
7898 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7899 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7900 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007901
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007902http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007903
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007904 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
7905 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
7906 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
7907 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
7908 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
7909 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007910
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007911 Example :
7912 # prepend the host name before the path
7913 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007914
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007915http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7916
7917 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
7918 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
7919 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
7920
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007921http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02007922
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007923 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
7924 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
7925 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7926 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
7927 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007928
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007929http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007930
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007931 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
7932 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
7933 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7934 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
7935 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
7936 values have higher priority.
7937 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
7938 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
7939 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
7940 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
7941 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007942
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007943http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007944
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007945 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
7946 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
7947 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
7948 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
7949 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
7950 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
7951 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007952
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007953 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007954
7955 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007956 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
7957 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007958
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007959http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7960 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
7961 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
7962 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007963 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
7964 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007965
7966 Arguments :
7967 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7968 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007969
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007970 See also "option forwardfor".
7971
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007972 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007973 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
7974 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
7975
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007976 # After the masking this will track connections
7977 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
7978 http-request track-sc0 src
7979
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007980 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
7981 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
7982
7983http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7984
7985 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
7986 expression.
7987
7988 Arguments:
7989 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7990 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007991
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007992 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007993 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
7994 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
7995
7996 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
7997 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
7998 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
7999
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02008000http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01008001 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8002
8003 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
8004 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
8005 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
8006 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
8007 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
8008
8009 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
8010 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
8011 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
8012 results.
8013
8014 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02008015 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
8016 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01008017
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008018http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8019
8020 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
8021 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
8022 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
8023 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
8024 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
8025 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
8026 information from the request.
8027
8028 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
8029
8030http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8031
8032 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
8033 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulet84cdbe42022-11-22 15:41:48 +01008034 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
8035 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
8036 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
8037 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
8038 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008039 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
8040
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01008041http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8042http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008043
8044 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
8045 inline.
8046
8047 Arguments:
8048 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
8049 scope. The scopes allowed are:
8050 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
8051 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
8052 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
8053 (request and response)
8054 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
8055 processing
8056 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
8057 processing
8058 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8059 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
8060 and '_'.
8061
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01008062 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
8063 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05008064 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01008065 conditions.
8066
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008067 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8068 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01008069
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02008070 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
8071 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
8072
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008073 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008074 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02008075 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
8076
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008077http-request silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008078
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008079 This stops the evaluation of the rules and removes the client-facing
8080 connection in a configurable way: When called without the rst-ttl argument,
8081 we try to prevent sending any FIN or RST packet back to the client by
8082 using TCP_REPAIR. If this fails (mainly because of missing privileges),
8083 we fall back to sending a RST packet with a TTL of 1.
8084
8085 The effect is that the client still sees an established connection while
8086 there is none on HAProxy, saving resources. However, stateful equipment
8087 placed between the HAProxy and the client (firewalls, proxies,
8088 load balancers) will also keep the established connection in their
8089 session tables.
8090
8091 The optional rst-ttl changes this behaviour: TCP_REPAIR is not used,
8092 and a RST packet with a configurable TTL is sent. When set to a
8093 reasonable value, the RST packet travels through your own equipment,
8094 deleting the connection in your middle-boxes, but does not arrive at
8095 the client. Future packets from the client will then be dropped
8096 already by your middle-boxes. These "local RST"s protect your resources,
8097 but not the client's. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008098
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008099http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008100
8101 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
8102 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
8103 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
8104 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
8105 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05008106 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008107 processing.
8108
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01008109 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008110 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
8111 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
8112 rules evaluation.
8113
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008114http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8115http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
8116 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8117 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
8118 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
8119 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008120
8121 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
8122 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
8123 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008124 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
8125 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
8126 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
8127 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
8128 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
8129 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008130 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008131 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
8132 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
8133 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05008134 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008135 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
8136 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
8137 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
8138 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
8139 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008140
8141http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8142http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8143http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8144
8145 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
8146 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01008147 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set by the
8148 global "tune.stick-counters" setting, which defaults to MAX_SESS_STKCTR if
8149 set at build time (it is reported in haproxy -vv) and which defaults to 3,
8150 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (tune.stick-counters-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008151 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
8152 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
8153 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
8154 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
8155 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
8156 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
8157 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
8158
8159 Arguments :
8160 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
8161 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
8162 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
8163 select which table entry to update the counters.
8164
8165 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
8166 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
8167 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
8168 that table until the session ends.
8169
8170 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
8171 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
8172 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
8173 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
8174 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
8175 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
8176 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
8177 useful information.
8178
8179 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
8180 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
8181 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
8182 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
8183 checks that make use of it.
8184
8185http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8186
8187 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008188
8189 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008190 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008191
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01008192http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8193
8194 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
8195 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
8196 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
8197 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
8198 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
8199 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
8200
8201 Arguments :
8202 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
8203
8204 Example:
8205 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
8206
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008207http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8208 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8209
Thayne McCombs77f35912024-01-28 22:07:32 -07008210 This will delay the processing of the request or response until one of the
8211 following conditions occurs:
8212 - The full request body is received, in which case processing proceeds
8213 normally.
8214 - <bytes> bytes have been received, when the "at-least" argument is given and
8215 <bytes> is non-zero, in which case processing proceeds normally.
8216 - The request buffer is full, in which case processing proceeds normally. The
8217 size of this buffer is determined by the "tune.bufsize" option.
8218 - The request has been waiting for more than <time> milliseconds. In this
8219 case HAProxy will respond with a 408 "Request Timeout" error to the client
8220 and stop processing the request. Note that if any of the other conditions
8221 happens first, this timeout will not occur even if the full body has
8222 not yet been recieved.
8223
8224 This action may be used as a replacement for "option http-buffer-request".
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008225
8226 Arguments :
8227
8228 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
8229 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
8230
8231 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05008232 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Thayne McCombs77f35912024-01-28 22:07:32 -07008233 bytes. A value of 0 (the default) means no limit.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008234
8235 Example:
8236 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
8237
8238 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8239
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008240http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008242 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
8243 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
8244 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008245
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01008246
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008247http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008248 Access control for Layer 7 responses
8249
8250 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02008251 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008252
8253 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
8254 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
8255 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
8256 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
8257 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
8258 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
8259
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008260 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
8261 supported:
8262 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
8263 - add-header <name> <fmt>
8264 - allow
8265 - cache-store <name>
8266 - capture <sample> id <id>
8267 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
8268 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
8269 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
8270 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
8271 - redirect <rule>
8272 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8273 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8274 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01008275 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008276 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
8277 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
8278 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
8279 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8280 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8281 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01008282 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008283 - set-header <name> <fmt>
8284 - set-log-level <level>
8285 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
8286 - set-mark <mark>
8287 - set-nice <nice>
8288 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
8289 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01008290 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
8291 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +01008292 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008293 - strict-mode { on | off }
8294 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
8295 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
8296 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
8297 - unset-var(<var-name>)
8298 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8299
8300 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008301
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008302 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008303
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02008304 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
8305 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
8306 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
8307 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
8308 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
8309 a defaults section defining such rules.
8310
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008311 Example:
8312 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02008313
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008314 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008315
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008316 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
8317 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008318
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008319 Example:
8320 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008321
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008322 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008323
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008324 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
8325 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008326
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008327 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8328 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008329
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008330http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008331
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008332 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
8333 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008334
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008335http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008336
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008337 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008338 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
8339 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008340
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008341http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008342
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008343 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
8344 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008345
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02008346http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008347
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008348 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008349
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008350http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008351
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008352 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
8353 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
8354 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
8355 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
8356 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
8357 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
8358 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02008359
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008360 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
8361 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
8362 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
8363 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
8364 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01008365
8366 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
8367 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
8368 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
8369 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02008370
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008371http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02008372
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008373 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
8374 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02008375
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00008376http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02008377
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008378 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
8379 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02008380
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008381http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02008382
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008383 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
8384 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008385
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008386http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8387http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
8388 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8389 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
8390 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
8391 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008392
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008393 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
8394 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
8395 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05008396 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008397 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
8398 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
8399 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01008400 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008401 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008402
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008403http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008404
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008405 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
8406 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
8407 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
8408 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
8409 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
8410 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02008411
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008412http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8413 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02008414
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01008415 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
8416 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01008417
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008418 Example:
8419 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02008420
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008421 # applied to:
8422 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008423
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008424 # outputs:
8425 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008426
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008427 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008428
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008429http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8430 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008431
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01008432 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01008433 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008434
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008435 Example:
8436 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008437
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008438 # applied to:
8439 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008440
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008441 # outputs:
8442 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008443
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008444http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
8445 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8446 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01008447 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008448 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8449
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008450 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
8451 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
8452 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008453
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01008454http-response sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8455 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8456
8457 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
8458 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
8459 a complete description.
8460
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02008461http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008462http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8463http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08008464
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008465 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
8466 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
8467 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
8468 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008469
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02008470http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008471 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01008472http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8473 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008474
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008475 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
8476 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +02008477 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008478
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02008479http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
8480 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008481
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008482 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
8483 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02008484
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01008485http-response set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
8486 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02008487
8488 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
8489 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
8490 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
8491
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008492http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008493
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008494 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
8495 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
8496 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
8497 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008498
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008499http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8500
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008501 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
8502 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008503
8504http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
8505
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008506 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
8507 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008508
8509http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8510
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008511 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
8512 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
8513 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008514
8515http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8516
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008517 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
8518 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008519
8520http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
8521 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8522
8523 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
8524 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
8525 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
8526 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008527
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008528 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008529 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
8530 http-response set-status 431
8531 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
8532 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008533
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008534http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008535
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008536 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008537 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
8538 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008539
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01008540http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8541http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008542
8543 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008544 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
8545 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008546
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008547http-response silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008548
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008549 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
8550 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008551 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
8552 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008553
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008554http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008555
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008556 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
8557 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008558
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008559http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8560http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8561http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008562
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008563 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
8564 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
8565 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008566
8567http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8568
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008569 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008570 about <var-name>.
8571
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008572http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8573 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8574
8575 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008576 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
8577 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008578
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02008579
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008580http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
8581 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
8582
8583 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8584 yes | no | yes | yes
8585
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008586 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008587 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
8588 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
8589 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008590
8591 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
8592
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008593 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
8594 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
8595 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
8596 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
8597 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
8598 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
8599 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008600 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008601 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
8602 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008603
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008604 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
8605 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
8606 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
8607 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
8608 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
8609 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
8610 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02008611 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
8612 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
8613 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
8614 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
8615 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
8616 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008617
8618 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
8619 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
8620 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
8621 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
8622 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
8623 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
8624 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
8625 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02008626 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008627 downsides of rare connection failures.
8628
8629 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
8630 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
8631 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
8632 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
8633 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
8634 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008635 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008636 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
8637 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
8638 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
8639 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
8640 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
8641
8642 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008643 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
8644 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
8645 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
8646 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008647
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008648 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
8649 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008650
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01008651 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008652
8653 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
8654 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
8655 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
8656
Willy Tarreau44fce8b2022-11-25 09:17:18 +01008657 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
8658 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
8659 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
8660 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
8661 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
8662 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
8663 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
8664 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
8665 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
8666 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
8667 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
8668
8669 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
8670 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
8671 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
8672 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
8673 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
8674
8675 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
8676 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008677
8678
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008679http-send-name-header [<header>]
8680 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008681 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8682 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008683 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008684 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
8685
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02008686 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
8687 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
8688 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
8689 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
8690 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
8691 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
8692 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
8693 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
8694 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
8695 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
8696 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
8697 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
8698 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
8699 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
8700 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
8701 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008702
8703 See also : "server"
8704
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008705id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008706 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
8707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8708 no | yes | yes | yes
8709 Arguments : none
8710
8711 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
8712 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
8713 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008714
8715
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008716ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
8717 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
8718 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01008719 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008720
8721 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
8722 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
8723 and running).
8724
8725 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
8726 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
8727 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008728 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008729 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
8730
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008731 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
8732 "unless" condition is met.
8733
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008734 Example:
8735 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8736 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8737 ignore-persist if url_static
8738
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008739 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
8740
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008741load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
8742 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
8743 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8744 yes | no | yes | yes
8745
8746 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
8747 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
8748 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008749 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008750 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008751 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
8752 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
8753 over the stats socket and redirect output.
8754
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008755 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008756 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02008757 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008758
8759 Arguments:
8760 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
8761 named "server-state-file".
8762
8763 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
8764 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
8765 name is used as a file name.
8766
8767 none don't load any stat for this backend
8768
8769 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008770 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
8771 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
8772 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008773 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008774 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008775
8776 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
8777 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
8778
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008779 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008780
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008781 global
8782 stats socket /tmp/socket
8783 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008784
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008785 defaults
8786 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008787
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008788 backend bk
8789 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8790 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008791
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008792
8793 Then one can run :
8794
8795 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
8796
8797 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
8798
8799 1
8800 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8801 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8802 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8803
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008804 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008805
8806 global
8807 stats socket /tmp/socket
8808 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
8809
8810 defaults
8811 load-server-state-from-file local
8812
8813 backend bk
8814 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8815 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
8816
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008817
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008818 Then one can run :
8819
8820 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
8821
8822 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
8823
8824 1
8825 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8826 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8827 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8828
8829 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
8830 "show servers state"
8831
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008832
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008833log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01008834log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008835 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008836no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008837 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
8838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8839 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008840
8841 Prefix :
8842 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
8843 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
8844 prefix does not allow arguments.
8845
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008846 Arguments :
8847 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
8848 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
8849 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
8850 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
8851 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
8852 parameter.
8853
8854 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
8855 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
8856
8857 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
8858 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8859 standard syslog port).
8860
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01008861 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
8862 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8863 standard syslog port).
8864
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008865 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
8866 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
8867 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008868 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008869
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008870 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
8871 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
8872 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
8873 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
8874 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
8875 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
8876 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
8877 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
8878 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
8879 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
8880 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
8881 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008882 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008883 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
8884 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
8885 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008886 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
8887 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008888
8889 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
8890 and "fd@2", see above.
8891
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02008892 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
8893 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
8894 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
8895 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
8896 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
8897 having the logs instantly available.
8898
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008899 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
8900 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
8901 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
8902
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008903 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8904 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008905
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008906 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
8907 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
8908 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
8909 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
8910 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
8911 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
8912 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
8913 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
8914 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
8915 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008916 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008917
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008918 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
8919 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
8920 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
8921 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
8922 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
8923
8924 <sample_size>
8925 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
8926 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
8927 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
8928 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
8929 (see also <ranges> parameter).
8930
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008931 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
8932 one of the following :
8933
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01008934 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
8935 field is stripped. This is the default.
8936 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
8937 rfc3164.
8938
8939 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008940 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
8941
8942 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
8943 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
8944
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008945 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
8946 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
8947 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8948 designed to be used with a local log server.
8949
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008950 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8951 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
8952 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
8953 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
8954 systemd logger consumes.
8955
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008956 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8957 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
8958 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
8959 used with a local log server.
8960
8961 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
8962 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8963 designed to be used with a local log server.
8964
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008965 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
8966 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
8967 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
8968 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
8969
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008970 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
8971
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008972 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
8973 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
8974 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
8975
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008976 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
8977 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
8978 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
8979 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008980
8981 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
8982 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
8983 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008984 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
8985 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
8986 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
8987 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
8988 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008989
8990 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
8991
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008992 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
8993 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
8994 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008995
8996 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
8997 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
8998 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
8999 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
9000
9001 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
9002 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009003
9004 Example :
9005 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01009006 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
9007 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
9008 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02009009 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02009010 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
9011 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009012 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01009013
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009014
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009015log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01009016 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
9017 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9018 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009019
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01009020 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
9021 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
9022 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +02009023 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.6 which covers the custom log
9024 format string in depth.
9025
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02009026 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
9027 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009028
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02009029 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
9030 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009031
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02009032log-format-sd <string>
9033 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
9034 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9035 yes | yes | yes | no
9036
9037 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
9038 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
9039 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +02009040 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.6
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02009041 which covers the log format string in depth.
9042
9043 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
9044 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
9045
9046 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
9047 log format to "rfc5424".
9048
9049 Example :
9050 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
9051
9052
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01009053log-tag <string>
9054 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
9055 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9056 yes | yes | yes | yes
9057
9058 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
9059 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009060 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01009061 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
9062 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
9063 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
9064 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
9065 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
9066 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009067
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009068max-keep-alive-queue <value>
9069 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
9070 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9071 yes | no | yes | yes
9072
9073 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
9074 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
9075 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
9076 servers.
9077
9078 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009079 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009080 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
9081 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
9082 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009083 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009084 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
9085 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
9086 picking a different server.
9087
9088 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
9089 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
9090 even if they have to be queued.
9091
9092 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
9093 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
9094
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01009095max-session-srv-conns <nb>
9096 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
9097 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
9098 defined at build time).
Aurelien DARRAGON04445cf2023-11-20 17:53:36 +01009099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9100 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009101
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009102maxconn <conns>
9103 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
9104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9105 yes | yes | yes | no
9106 Arguments :
9107 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
9108 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
9109 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
9110 closes.
9111
9112 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009113 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009114 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
9115 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01009116 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
9117 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
9118 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
9119 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009120
9121 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
9122 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
9123 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
9124
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01009125 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
9126 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02009127
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009128 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
9129
9130
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02009131mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009132 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
9133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9134 yes | yes | yes | yes
9135 Arguments :
9136 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
9137 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
9138 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
9139 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
9140
9141 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
9142 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
9143 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
9144 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
9145 brings HAProxy most of its value.
9146
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009147 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
9148 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
9149 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009150
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009151 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009152 defaults http_instances
9153 mode http
9154
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009155
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009156monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009157 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9159 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009160 Arguments :
9161 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
9162 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009163 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009164 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
9165 backend and its backup.
9166
9167 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
9168 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
9169 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
9170 servers in a list of backends.
9171
9172 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
9173 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
9174 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009175 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009176 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
9177 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009178 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02009179 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
9180 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009181
9182 Example:
9183 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009184 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009185 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9186 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9187 monitor-uri /site_alive
9188 monitor fail if site_dead
9189
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009190 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009191
9192
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009193monitor-uri <uri>
9194 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
9195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9196 yes | yes | yes | no
9197 Arguments :
9198 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
9199 health status instead of forwarding the request.
9200
9201 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
9202 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
9203 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
9204 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
9205 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
9206 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
9207 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
9208 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
9209
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01009210 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009211 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
9212 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau7fe0c622022-11-25 10:24:44 +01009213 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
9214 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
9215 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009216 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
9217 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
9218 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009219
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01009220 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
9221 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
9222 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
9223 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
9224
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009225 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009226 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009227 frontend www
9228 mode http
9229 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
9230
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009231 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009232
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009233
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009234option abortonclose
9235no option abortonclose
9236 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
9237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9238 yes | no | yes | yes
9239 Arguments : none
9240
9241 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
9242 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
9243 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
9244 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009245 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009246 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
9247 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
9248 encountered while delivering the response.
9249
9250 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
9251 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
9252 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
9253 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
9254 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
9255 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009256 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009257 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009258 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009259 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
9260 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
9261 still not served and not pollute the servers.
9262
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009263 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
9264 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009265 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
9266 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
9267 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
9268 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
9269 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
9270 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009271 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009272
9273 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9274 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9275
9276 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
9277
9278
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009279option accept-invalid-http-request
9280no option accept-invalid-http-request
9281 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
9282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9283 yes | yes | yes | no
9284 Arguments : none
9285
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009286 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009287 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009288 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009289 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
9290 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
9291 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
9292 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
9293 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01009294 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
9295 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
9296 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
9297 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009298 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009299 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02009300 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
Willy Tarreau1ba30162022-05-24 15:34:26 +02009301 to pass through (no version specified), as well as different protocol names
9302 (e.g. RTSP), and multiple digits for both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +02009303 Finally, this option also allows incoming URLs to contain fragment references
9304 ('#' after the path).
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009305
9306 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
9307 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
9308 been confirmed.
9309
9310 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
9311 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01009312 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
9313 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009314 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
9315
9316 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9317 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9318
9319 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
9320 stats socket.
9321
9322
9323option accept-invalid-http-response
9324no option accept-invalid-http-response
9325 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
9326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9327 yes | no | yes | yes
9328 Arguments : none
9329
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009330 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009331 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009332 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009333 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
9334 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
9335 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
9336 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
9337 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009338 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
9339 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
9340 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009341
9342 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
9343 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
9344 been confirmed.
9345
9346 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
9347 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
9348 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
9349 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
9350
9351 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9352 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9353
9354 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
9355 stats socket.
9356
9357
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009358option allbackups
9359no option allbackups
9360 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
9361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9362 yes | no | yes | yes
9363 Arguments : none
9364
9365 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
9366 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
9367 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
9368 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
9369 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
9370 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
9371 order between the backup servers anymore.
9372
9373 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
9374 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
9375
9376 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9377 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9378
9379
9380option checkcache
9381no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08009382 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9384 yes | no | yes | yes
9385 Arguments : none
9386
9387 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
9388 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009389 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009390 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
9391 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009392 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009393
9394 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009395 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009396 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009397 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
9398 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009399 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009400 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01009401 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
9402 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009403 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01009404 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
9405 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009406 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009407 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
9408 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
9409 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
9410 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
9411 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
9412 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
9413 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
9414 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
9415 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
9416
9417 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009418 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
9419 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
9420 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
9421 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009422
9423 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
9424 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009425 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009426 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009427
9428 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9429 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9430
9431
9432option clitcpka
9433no option clitcpka
9434 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
9435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9436 yes | yes | yes | no
9437 Arguments : none
9438
9439 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9440 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009441 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009442 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9443
9444 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9445 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9446 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9447 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9448
9449 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9450 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9451 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9452 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9453 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9454
9455 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9456
9457 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9458 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9459 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
9460
9461 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9462 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9463
9464 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
9465
9466
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009467option contstats
9468 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
9469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9470 yes | yes | yes | no
9471 Arguments : none
9472
9473 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
9474 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
9475 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009476 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01009477 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
9478 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
9479 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
9480 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
9481 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009482
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009483option disable-h2-upgrade
9484no option disable-h2-upgrade
9485 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
9486 connection.
9487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9488 yes | yes | yes | no
9489 Arguments : none
9490
9491 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
9492 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
9493 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
9494 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01009495 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
9496 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
9497 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
9498 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
9499 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
9500 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009501
9502 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9503 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009504
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009505option dontlog-normal
9506no option dontlog-normal
9507 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
9508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9509 yes | yes | yes | no
9510 Arguments : none
9511
9512 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
9513 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
9514 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
9515 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
9516 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
9517 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
9518 logged.
9519
9520 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
9521 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
9522 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
9523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009524 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009525 logging.
9526
9527
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009528option dontlognull
9529no option dontlognull
9530 Enable or disable logging of null connections
9531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9532 yes | yes | yes | no
9533 Arguments : none
9534
9535 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
9536 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
9537 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
9538 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
9539 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
9540 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009541 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
9542 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
9543 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009544
9545 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009546 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009547 would not be logged.
9548
9549 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9550 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9551
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009552 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009553 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009554
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009555option forwarded [ proto ]
9556 [ host | host-expr <host_expr> ]
9557 [ by | by-expr <by_expr> ] [ by_port | by_port-expr <by_port_expr>]
9558 [ for | for-expr <for_expr> ] [ for_port | for_port-expr <for_port_expr>]
9559no option forwarded
9560 Enable insertion of the rfc 7239 forwarded header in requests sent to servers
9561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9562 yes | no | yes | yes
9563 Arguments :
9564 <host_expr> optional argument to specify a custom sample expression
9565 those result will be used as 'host' parameter value
9566
9567 <by_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9568 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodename value
9569
9570 <for_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9571 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodename value
9572
9573 <by_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9574 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodeport value
9575
9576 <for_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9577 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodeport value
9578
9579
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02009580 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, servers are losing some request
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009581 context (request origin: client ip address, protocol used...)
9582
9583 A common way to address this limitation is to use the well known
9584 x-forward-for and x-forward-* friends to expose some of this context to the
9585 underlying servers/applications.
9586 While this use to work and is widely deployed, it is not officially supported
9587 by the IETF and can be the root of some interoperability as well as security
9588 issues.
9589
9590 To solve this, a new HTTP extension has been described by the IETF:
9591 forwarded header (RFC7239).
9592 More information here: https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html
9593
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02009594 The use of this single header allow to convey numerous details
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009595 within the same header, and most importantly, fixes the proxy chaining
9596 issue. (the rfc allows for multiple chained proxies to append their own
9597 values to an already existing header).
9598
9599 This option may be specified in defaults, listen or backend section, but it
9600 will be ignored for frontend sections.
9601
9602 Setting option forwarded without arguments results in using default implicit
9603 behavior.
9604 Default behavior enables proto parameter and injects original client ip.
9605
9606 The equivalent explicit/manual configuration would be:
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01009607 option forwarded proto for
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009608
9609 The keyword 'by' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9610 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9611 'by' value will be set to proxy ip (destination address)
9612 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'by' will be set to
9613 "unknown".
9614
9615 The keyword 'by-expr' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9616 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9617 'by' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9618 <by_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9619
9620 The keyword 'for' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9621 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9622 'for' value will be set to client ip (source address)
9623 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'for' will be set to
9624 "unknown".
9625
9626 The keyword 'for-expr' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9627 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9628 'for' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9629 <for_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9630
9631 The keyword 'by_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9632 'by' parameter. 'by_port' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9633 it will be ignored.
9634 "nodeport" will be set to proxy (destination) port if available,
9635 otherwise it will be ignored.
9636
9637 The keyword 'by_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9638 'by' parameter. 'by_port-expr' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9639 it will be ignored.
9640 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9641 <by_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9642
9643 The keyword 'for_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9644 'for' parameter. 'for_port' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9645 it will be ignored.
9646 "nodeport" will be set to client (source) port if available,
9647 otherwise it will be ignored.
9648
9649 The keyword 'for_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9650 'for' parameter. 'for_port-expr' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9651 it will be ignored.
9652 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9653 <for_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9654
9655 Examples :
9656 # Those servers want the ip address and protocol of the client request
9657 # Resulting header would look like this:
9658 # forwarded: proto=http;for=127.0.0.1
9659 backend www_default
9660 mode http
9661 option forwarded
9662 #equivalent to: option forwarded proto for
9663
9664 # Those servers want the requested host and hashed client ip address
9665 # as well as client source port (you should use seed for xxh32 if ensuring
9666 # ip privacy is a concern)
9667 # Resulting header would look like this:
9668 # forwarded: host="haproxy.org";for="_000000007F2F367E:60138"
9669 backend www_host
9670 mode http
9671 option forwarded host for-expr src,xxh32,hex for_port
9672
9673 # Those servers want custom data in host, for and by parameters
9674 # Resulting header would look like this:
9675 # forwarded: host="host.com";by=_haproxy;for="[::1]:10"
9676 backend www_custom
9677 mode http
9678 option forwarded host-expr str(host.com) by-expr str(_haproxy) for for_port-expr int(10)
9679
9680 # Those servers want random 'for' obfuscated identifiers for request
9681 # tracing purposes while protecting sensitive IP information
9682 # Resulting header would look like this:
9683 # forwarded: for=_000000002B1F4D63
9684 backend www_for_hide
9685 mode http
9686 option forwarded for-expr rand,hex
9687
9688 See also : "option forwardfor", "option originalto"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009689
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009690option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009691 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
9692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9693 yes | yes | yes | yes
9694 Arguments :
9695 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9696 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009697 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009698 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009699
9700 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
9701 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
9702 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
9703 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
9704 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
9705 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
9706 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009707 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
9708 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9709 possible that the client has already brought one.
9710
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009711 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009712 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009713 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009714 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009715 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009716 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009717
9718 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9719 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9720 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
9721 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
9722 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
9723 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01009724 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009725
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009726 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
9727 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009728 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009729 are under the control of the end-user.
9730
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009731 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009732 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9733 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009734 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
9735 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
9736 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009737
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02009738 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009739 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
9740 frontend www
9741 mode http
9742 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
9743
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009744 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
9745 backend www
9746 mode http
9747 option forwardfor header X-Client
9748
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009749 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009750 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009751
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009752
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02009753option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9754no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9755 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
9756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9757 yes | yes | yes | no
9758 Arguments : none
9759
9760 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9761 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9762 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9763 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9764 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9765 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9766 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9767
9768 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
9769 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
9770 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
9771 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9772 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
9773 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9774 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9775 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
9776 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9777 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9778
9779 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
9780
9781 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9782 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9783
9784 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
9785 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9786
9787
9788option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9789no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9790 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
9791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9792 yes | no | yes | yes
9793 Arguments : none
9794
9795 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9796 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9797 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9798 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9799 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9800 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9801 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9802
9803 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
9804 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
9805 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
9806 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9807 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
9808 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9809 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9810 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
9811 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9812 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9813
9814 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
9815
9816 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9817 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9818
9819 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
9820 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9821
9822
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009823option http-buffer-request
9824no option http-buffer-request
9825 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
9826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9827 yes | yes | yes | yes
9828 Arguments : none
9829
9830 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
9831 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
9832 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
9833 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
9834 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
9835 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01009836 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
9837 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
9838 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
9839 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009840
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02009841 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
9842 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009843
9844
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009845option http-ignore-probes
9846no option http-ignore-probes
9847 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
9848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9849 yes | yes | yes | no
9850 Arguments : none
9851
9852 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
9853 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
9854 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
9855 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
9856 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
9857 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
9858 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
9859 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
9860 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009861 was received over a connection before it was closed;
9862 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009863 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
9864
9865 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
9866 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
9867 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
9868 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
9869 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
9870 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
9871 are often the only way to detect them.
9872
9873 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9874 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9875
9876 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
9877
9878
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009879option http-keep-alive
9880no option http-keep-alive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009881 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server for HTTP/1.x
9882 connections
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9884 yes | yes | yes | yes
9885 Arguments : none
9886
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009887 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009888 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9889 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9890 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9891 httpclose". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be
9892 useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009893
9894 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
9895 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009896 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
9897 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
9898 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
9899 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
9900 situations where this option may be useful :
9901
9902 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009903 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009904
9905 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
9906 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
9907
9908 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009909
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009910 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9911 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9912 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9913 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
9914 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9915 not set.
9916
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009917 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009918 http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009919
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009920 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009921 "option prefer-last-server" and "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009922
9923
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009924option http-no-delay
9925no option http-no-delay
9926 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
9927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9928 yes | yes | yes | yes
9929 Arguments : none
9930
9931 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
9932 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
9933 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
9934 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
9935 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
9936 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
9937 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009938 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009939 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
9940 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
9941 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
9942 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
9943 affected.
9944
9945 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
9946 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
9947 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
9948 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
9949 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
9950 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
9951 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
9952 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
9953 latency environments.
9954
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009955 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
9956
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009957
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009958option http-pretend-keepalive
9959no option http-pretend-keepalive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009960 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive for HTTP/1.x connection to the
9961 server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009963 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009964 Arguments : none
9965
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009966 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009967 adds a "Connection: close" header to the HTTP/1.x request forwarded to the
9968 server. Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically
9969 refrain from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length,
9970 while this is totally unrelated. The effect is that a client or a cache could
9971 receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and consider the
9972 response complete.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009973
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009974 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009975 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009976 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009977 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009978 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009979 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
9980
9981 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
9982 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
9983 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
9984 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009985 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
9986 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009987 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
9988
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009989 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
9990 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
9991 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009992 frontend.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009993
9994 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9995 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9996
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009997 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009998 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009999
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +020010000option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
10001 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
10002 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
10003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10004 yes | yes | yes | yes
10005 Arguments :
10006 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
10007 with no FastCGI application configured.
10008
10009 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
10010 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
10011 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
10012
10013 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
10014 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
10015
10016 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
10017 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
10018 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
10019 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
10020 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
10021 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
10022 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
10023 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
10024
10025 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
10026 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010027
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010028option http-server-close
10029no option http-server-close
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010030 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing on the server side
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10032 yes | yes | yes | yes
10033 Arguments : none
10034
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010035 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010036 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
10037 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
10038 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
10039 httpclose". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close
10040 mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive
10041 and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the
10042 client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side
10043 to save server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
10044 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
10045 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
10046 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
10047 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
10048 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010049
10050 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
10051 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
10052 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
10053 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010054 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
10055 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010056
10057 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
10058 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +020010059 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
10060 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
10061 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010062
10063 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10064 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10065
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010066 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive" and
10067 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010068
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010069option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010070no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010071 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
10072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10073 yes | yes | yes | no
10074 Arguments : none
10075
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000010076 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010077 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
10078 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
10079 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
10080 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
10081 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010082 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010083
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010084 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010085 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +010010086 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
10087 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
10088 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010089
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +010010090 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
10091 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
10092 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
10093 front of an existing proxy.
10094
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010095 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
10096
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010097 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010098
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010099option httpchk
10100option httpchk <uri>
10101option httpchk <method> <uri>
10102option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010103 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10105 yes | no | yes | yes
10106 Arguments :
10107 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
10108 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
10109 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
10110 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
10111 ones.
10112
10113 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
10114 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
10115 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
10116
10117 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
10118 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
10119 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +020010120 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010121
10122 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
10123 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
10124 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
10125 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
10126 the lack of any response.
10127
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +020010128 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
10129 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
10130 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
10131 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
10132
10133 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
10134 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
10135 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010136
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +020010137 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
10138 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +020010139 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010140 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +020010141 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010142
10143 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010144 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
10145 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
10146 backend https_relay
10147 mode tcp
10148 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
10149 http-check send hdr Host www
10150 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010151
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010152 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
10153 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
10154 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010155
10156
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010157option httpclose
10158no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010159 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10161 yes | yes | yes | yes
10162 Arguments : none
10163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010164 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010165 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
10166 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
10167 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
10168 httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010169
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010170 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close the client or the server
Christopher Fauletd17dd842023-02-20 17:30:06 +010010171 connection, depending where the option is set. The frontend is considered for
10172 client connections while the backend is considered for server ones. If the
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010173 option is set on a listener, it is applied both on client and server
10174 connections. It will check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in
10175 each direction, and will add one if missing.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010176
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010177 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010178 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" request header, but will
10179 still cause the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010180
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +020010181 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010182 http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010183
10184 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10185 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10186
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010187 See also : "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010188
10189
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010190option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010191 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
10192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010010193 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010194 Arguments :
10195 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
10196 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
10197 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010198 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010199 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010200
10201 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10202 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10203 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
10204 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
10205 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
10206 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
10207 ports.
10208
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +010010209 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
10210 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010211
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020010212 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010214 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010215
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020010216option httpslog
10217 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
10218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10219 yes | yes | yes | no
10220
10221 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10222 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10223 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
10224 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
10225 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
10226 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
10227 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
10228
10229 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10230
10231 See also : section 8 about logging.
10232
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010233
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010234option independent-streams
10235no option independent-streams
10236 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +020010237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10238 yes | yes | yes | yes
10239 Arguments : none
10240
10241 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
10242 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
10243 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
10244 receive data or not.
10245
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010246 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +020010247 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
10248 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
10249 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
10250 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
10251 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
10252 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
10253 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
10254 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
10255 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
10256 socket buffers.
10257
10258 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
10259 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
10260 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
10261 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
10262 slow lines, so use it with caution.
10263
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010264 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +020010265
10266
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +020010267option ldap-check
10268 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
10269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10270 yes | no | yes | yes
10271 Arguments : none
10272
10273 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
10274 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
10275 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
10276 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
10277
10278 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
10279 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
10280
10281 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
10282 configure it.
10283
10284 Example :
10285 option ldap-check
10286
10287 See also : "option httpchk"
10288
10289
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010290option external-check
10291 Use external processes for server health checks
10292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10293 yes | no | yes | yes
10294
10295 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
10296 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
10297 command".
10298
10299 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
10300
10301 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
10302
10303
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +010010304option idle-close-on-response
10305no option idle-close-on-response
10306 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
10307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10308 yes | yes | yes | no
10309 Arguments : none
10310
10311 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
10312 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
10313 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
10314 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
10315 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
10316 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
10317 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
10318 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
10319 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
10320
10321 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
10322 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
10323
10324 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
10325 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
10326 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
10327 needed in case of frequent reloads.
10328
10329 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
10330 "hard-stop-after"
10331
10332
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010333option log-health-checks
10334no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010335 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10337 yes | no | yes | yes
10338 Arguments : none
10339
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010340 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
10341 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
10342 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010343
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010344 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
10345 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
10346 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
10347 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
10348 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
10349
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010350 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010351 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010352
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010353 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
10354 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
10355 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010356
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010357
10358option log-separate-errors
10359no option log-separate-errors
10360 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
10361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10362 yes | yes | yes | no
10363 Arguments : none
10364
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010365 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010366 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
10367 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
10368 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
10369 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
10370 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
10371 provides very important information.
10372
10373 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
10374 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
10375 error logs.
10376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010377 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010378 logging.
10379
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010380
10381option logasap
10382no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +020010383 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10385 yes | yes | yes | no
10386 Arguments : none
10387
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +020010388 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
10389 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
10390 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
10391 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
10392
10393 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
10394 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
10395 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
10396 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
10397 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050010398 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +020010399 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
10400 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
10401 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
10402 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050010403 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010404
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010405 Examples :
10406 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
10407 mode http
10408 option httplog
10409 option logasap
10410 log 192.168.2.200 local3
10411
10412 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
10413 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
10414 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
10415 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10416
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010417 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010418 logging.
10419
10420
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +020010421option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010422 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10424 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010425 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010426 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
10427 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +020010428 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
10429 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010430
10431 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
10432 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010433 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010434 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +100010435 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
10436 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
10437 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010438
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +100010439 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
10440 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
10441 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010442
10443 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010444 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010445 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
10446 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
10447 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
10448 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
10449 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
10450 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
10451 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
10452
10453 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
10454 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010455
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +020010456 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010457
10458 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
10459 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
10460 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10461 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010462 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010463 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010464
10465 See also: "option httpchk"
10466
10467
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010468option nolinger
10469no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010470 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010471 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10472 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010473 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010474
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010475 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010476 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
10477 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
10478 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
10479 connections.
10480
10481 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
10482 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010483 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
10484 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
10485 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
10486 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
10487 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
10488 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
10489 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
10490 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
10491 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
10492 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
10493 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
10494 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
10495 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010496
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010497 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
10498 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
10499 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
10500 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
10501 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010502
10503 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
10504 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010505 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050010506 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010507 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010508
10509 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10510 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10511
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010512 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
10513 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010514
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010515option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
10516 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
10517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10518 yes | yes | yes | yes
10519 Arguments :
10520 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
10521 matching <network>
10522 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
10523 header name.
10524
10525 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
10526 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
10527 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
10528 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
10529 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
10530 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
10531 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
10532 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
10533 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
10534 possible that the client has already brought one.
10535
10536 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
10537 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
10538 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
10539 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
10540 header and requires different one.
10541
10542 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
10543 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
10544 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +010010545 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
10546 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
10547 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
10548 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
10549 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010550
10551 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
10552 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
10553 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
10554 both are defined.
10555
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010556 Examples :
10557 # Original Destination address
10558 frontend www
10559 mode http
10560 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
10561
10562 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
10563 backend www
10564 mode http
10565 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
10566
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010567 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010568
10569
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010570option persist
10571no option persist
10572 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
10573 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10574 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010575 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010576
10577 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
10578 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
10579 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
10580 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
10581 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
10582 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
10583 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
10584 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
10585 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
10586 redirected to another valid server.
10587
10588 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10589 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10590
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +010010591 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010592
10593
Christopher Faulet59307b32022-10-03 15:00:59 +020010594option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +010010595 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
10596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10597 yes | no | yes | yes
10598 Arguments :
10599 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
10600 PostgreSQL server.
10601
10602 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
10603 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
10604 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
10605 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
10606
10607 See also: "option httpchk"
10608
10609
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010610option prefer-last-server
10611no option prefer-last-server
10612 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
10613 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10614 yes | no | yes | yes
10615 Arguments : none
10616
10617 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010618 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010619 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
10620 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010621 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010622 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010623 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010624 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
10625 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010626 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010627 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +020010628 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
10629 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
10630 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010631 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
10632 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
10633 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010634
10635 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10636 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10637
10638 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
10639
10640
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010641option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010642option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010643no option redispatch
10644 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
10645 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10646 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010647 Arguments :
10648 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
10649 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
10650 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010651 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010652 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010653 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010654 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
10655 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
10656 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
10657
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010658
10659 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
10660 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
10661 be able to access the service anymore.
10662
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +010010663 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
10664 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010665
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +020010666 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
10667 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
10668 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
10669 following order:
10670
10671 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
10672
10673 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
10674 list, or
10675
10676 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
10677
10678 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
10679 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
10680
10681 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
10682 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
10683 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
10684 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
10685
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010686 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010687 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
10688 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010689
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010690 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10691 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10692
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010693 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010694
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010695
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010696option redis-check
10697 Use redis health checks for server testing
10698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10699 yes | no | yes | yes
10700 Arguments : none
10701
10702 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
10703 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10704 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
10705 find the "+PONG" response message.
10706
10707 Example :
10708 option redis-check
10709
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010710 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010711
10712
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010713option smtpchk
10714option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
10715 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
10716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10717 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010718 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010719 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +020010720 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010721 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
10722
10723 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
10724 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
10725 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
10726
10727 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
10728 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
10729 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
10730 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
10731 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
10732 dead server.
10733
10734 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
10735 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010736 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010737 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
10738
10739 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
10740 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
10741 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10742 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010743 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010744
10745 Example :
10746 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
10747
10748 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
10749
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010750
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010751option socket-stats
10752no option socket-stats
10753
10754 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
10755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10756 yes | yes | yes | no
10757
10758 Arguments : none
10759
10760
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010761option splice-auto
10762no option splice-auto
10763 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
10764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10765 yes | yes | yes | yes
10766 Arguments : none
10767
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010768 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010769 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010770 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010771 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010772 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010773 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
10774 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
10775 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
10776 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10777
10778 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
10779 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
10780 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
10781 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
10782 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
10783 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
10784 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
10785 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
10786 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
10787 keyword.
10788
10789 Example :
10790 option splice-auto
10791
10792 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10793 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10794
10795 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
10796 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10797
10798
10799option splice-request
10800no option splice-request
10801 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
10802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10803 yes | yes | yes | yes
10804 Arguments : none
10805
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010806 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010807 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010808 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10809 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10810 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10811 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10812
10813 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10814
10815 Example :
10816 option splice-request
10817
10818 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10819 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10820
10821 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
10822 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10823
10824
10825option splice-response
10826no option splice-response
10827 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
10828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10829 yes | yes | yes | yes
10830 Arguments : none
10831
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010832 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010833 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010834 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10835 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10836 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10837 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10838
10839 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10840
10841 Example :
10842 option splice-response
10843
10844 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10845 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10846
10847 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
10848 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10849
10850
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010851option spop-check
10852 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
10853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +010010854 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010855 Arguments : none
10856
10857 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
10858 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10859 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
10860 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
10861
10862 Example :
10863 option spop-check
10864
10865 See also : "option httpchk"
10866
10867
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010868option srvtcpka
10869no option srvtcpka
10870 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
10871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10872 yes | no | yes | yes
10873 Arguments : none
10874
10875 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10876 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010877 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010878 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10879
10880 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10881 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10882 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10883 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10884
10885 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10886 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10887 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10888 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10889 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10890
10891 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10892
10893 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
10894 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
10895 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
10896
10897 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10898 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10899
10900 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
10901
10902
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010903option ssl-hello-chk
10904 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
10905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10906 yes | no | yes | yes
10907 Arguments : none
10908
10909 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
10910 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
10911 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
10912 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
10913 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
10914 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
10915 hello message.
10916
10917 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
10918 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
10919 messages, which is appreciable.
10920
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010921 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010922 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
10923 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010924
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010925 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
10926
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010927
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010928option tcp-check
10929 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
10930 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10931 yes | no | yes | yes
10932
10933 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
10934 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
10935
10936 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
10937 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
10938 attempt, which remains the default mode.
10939
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010940 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010941 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
10942 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
10943 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
10944 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
10945 only.
10946
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010947 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010948 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010949 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
10950 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
10951 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
10952
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010953 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010954 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
10955 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010956 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010957 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
10958 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
10959 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
10960 the respective protocols.
10961 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010962 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010963
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010964 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010965
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010966 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
10967 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
10968 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
10969 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010970
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010971 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
10972 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
10973 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010974
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010975
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010976 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010977 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010978 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010979 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010980
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010981 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010982 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010983 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010984
10985 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
10986 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010987 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010988 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010989 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010990 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010991 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010992 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010993 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10994 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010995 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010996 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10997 tcp-check expect string +OK
10998
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010999 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011000 (send many headers before analyzing)
11001 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020011002 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011003 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
11004 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
11005 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
11006 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020011007 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011008
11009
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011010 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010011011
11012
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020011013option tcp-smart-accept
11014no option tcp-smart-accept
11015 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
11016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11017 yes | yes | yes | no
11018 Arguments : none
11019
11020 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
11021 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
11022 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
11023 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
11024 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
11025 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
11026
11027 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
11028 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
11029 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
11030 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
11031
11032 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
11033 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
11034 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011035 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020011036
11037 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
11038 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
11039 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
11040
11041 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
11042 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
11043 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
11044
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +020011045 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
11046
11047
11048option tcp-smart-connect
11049no option tcp-smart-connect
11050 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
11051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11052 yes | no | yes | yes
11053 Arguments : none
11054
11055 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
11056 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
11057 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
11058 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
11059 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
11060
11061 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
11062 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
11063 complex.
11064
11065 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
11066 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
11067 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
11068
11069 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
11070 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
11071
11072 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
11073
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020011074
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010011075option tcpka
11076 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
11077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11078 yes | yes | yes | yes
11079 Arguments : none
11080
11081 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
11082 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011083 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010011084 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
11085
11086 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
11087 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
11088 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
11089 operating system and its tuning parameters.
11090
11091 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
11092 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
11093 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
11094 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
11095 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
11096
11097 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
11098
11099 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
11100 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
11101 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
11102 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
11103 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
11104 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
11105 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
11106 backends.
11107
11108 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
11109
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011110
11111option tcplog
11112 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
11113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010011114 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011115 Arguments : none
11116
11117 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
11118 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
11119 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
11120 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
11121 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
11122 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
11123 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
11124 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
11125
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020011126 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
11127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011128 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011129
11130
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011131option transparent
11132no option transparent
11133 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011135 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011136 Arguments : none
11137
11138 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
11139 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11140 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11141 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11142 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11143 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11144 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11145 appropriate server.
11146
11147 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11148 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11149
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +010011150 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011151 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011152
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010011153
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011154external-check command <command>
11155 Executable to run when performing an external-check
11156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11157 yes | no | yes | yes
11158
11159 Arguments :
11160 <command> is the external command to run
11161
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011162 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
11163
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010011164 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011165
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010011166 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
11167 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
11168 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
11169 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
11170 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
11171 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011172
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010011173 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
11174
11175 Environment variables :
11176 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
11177 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
11178
11179 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
11180
11181 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
11182
11183 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
11184 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
11185 for a UNIX socket).
11186
11187 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
11188
11189 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
11190
11191 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
11192
11193 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
11194
11195 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
11196
11197 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
11198 socket).
11199
Willy Tarreau973cf902022-05-13 15:58:35 +020011200 HAPROXY_SERVER_SSL "0" when SSL is not used, "1" when it is used
11201
11202 HAPROXY_SERVER_PROTO The protocol used by this server, which can be one
11203 of "cli" (the haproxy CLI), "syslog" (syslog TCP
11204 server), "peers" (peers TCP server), "h1" (HTTP/1.x
11205 server), "h2" (HTTP/2 server), or "tcp" (any other
11206 TCP server).
11207
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010011208 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
11209 the command may be set using "external-check path".
11210
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020011211 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
11212
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011213 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
11214 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
11215 failed.
11216
11217 Example :
11218 external-check command /bin/true
11219
11220 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
11221
11222
11223external-check path <path>
11224 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
11225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11226 yes | no | yes | yes
11227
11228 Arguments :
11229 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
11230
11231 The default path is "".
11232
11233 Example :
11234 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
11235
11236 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
11237 "external-check command"
11238
11239
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011240persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020011241persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011242 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
11243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11244 yes | no | yes | yes
11245 Arguments :
11246 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020011247 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
11248 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011249
11250 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
11251 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011252 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011253 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
11254 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
11255 forwarded to this server.
11256
11257 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
11258 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
11259 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011260 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011261 a single "listen" section.
11262
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020011263 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
11264 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
11265 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
11266
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011267 Example :
11268 listen tse-farm
11269 bind :3389
11270 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11271 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11272 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11273 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11274 persist rdp-cookie
11275 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011276 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011277 balance rdp-cookie
11278 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11279 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
11280
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011281 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011282
11283
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011284rate-limit sessions <rate>
11285 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
11286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11287 yes | yes | yes | no
11288 Arguments :
11289 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
11290 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
11291
11292 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
11293 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
11294 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011295 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011296 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
11297 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
11298
11299 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
11300 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
11301 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
11302 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
11303
11304 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
11305 listen smtp
11306 mode tcp
11307 bind :25
11308 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020011309 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011310
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020011311 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
11312 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
11313 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011314
11315 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
11316
11317
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011318redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11319redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11320redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011321 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
11322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11323 no | yes | yes | yes
11324
11325 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010011326 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011327
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011328 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011329 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011330 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
11331 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +020011332 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.6).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011333
11334 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
11335 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
11336 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
11337 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
11338 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011339 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
11340 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
11341 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +020011342 in section 8.2.6).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011343
11344 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
11345 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
11346 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
11347 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
11348 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
11349 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011350 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011351 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011352 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
11353 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +020011354 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.6).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011355
11356 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010011357 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
11358 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
11359 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020011360 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010011361 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
11362 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
11363 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
11364 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011365
11366 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011367 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011368
11369 - "drop-query"
11370 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
11371 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
11372 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
11373 with a location-type redirect.
11374
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010011375 - "append-slash"
11376 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
11377 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
11378 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
11379 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
11380
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020011381 - "ignore-empty"
11382 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
11383 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
11384 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
11385 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
11386 of known paths using a simple map.
11387
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011388 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
11389 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
11390 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
11391 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
11392 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
11393 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
11394 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
11395
11396 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
11397 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
11398 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
11399 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
11400 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
11401 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
11402 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011403
11404 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
11405 acl clear dst_port 80
11406 acl secure dst_port 8080
11407 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011408 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010011409 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011410 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
11411
11412 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010011413 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
11414 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
11415 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011416 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011417
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010011418 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
11419 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
11420 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
11421
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011422 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010011423 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011424
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011425 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020011426 http-request redirect code 301 location \
11427 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
11428 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011429
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020011430 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
11431 http-request redirect code 301 location \
11432 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
11433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011434 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011435
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010011436
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011437retries <value>
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011438 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011439 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11440 yes | no | yes | yes
11441 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011442 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
11443 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011444
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011445 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
11446 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
11447 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
11448 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
11449 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011450
11451 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070011452 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011453 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011454
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011455 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
11456 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
11457 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011458
11459 See also : "option redispatch"
11460
11461
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011462retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020011463 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
11464 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
11465 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011466 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11467 yes | no | yes | yes
11468 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011469 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
11470 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
11471 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
11472 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
11473 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011474
11475 none never retry
11476
11477 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
11478 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
11479
11480 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
11481 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
11482 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
11483 request timeout on the server side, poor network
11484 condition, or a server crash or restart while
11485 processing the request.
11486
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020011487 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
11488 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
11489 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
11490 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
11491 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
11492 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
11493 overflow attack for example).
11494
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011495 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
11496 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
11497 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
11498 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
11499 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
11500 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
11501 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
11502 amplify denial of service attacks.
11503
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020011504 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
11505 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
11506 considered to be safe to retry.
11507
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010011508 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
11509 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
11510 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
11511 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
11512 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011513
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020011514 all-retryable-errors
11515 retry request for any error that are considered
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +010011516 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
11517 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
11518 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020011519
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011520 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
11521 not cumulative.
11522
11523 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
11524 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
11525 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
11526 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
11527
11528 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
11529 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
11530 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
11531 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
11532 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
11533 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
11534 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
11535 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
11536 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
11537 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
11538 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
11539 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
11540
11541 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
11542 should not use this directive.
11543
11544 The default is "conn-failure".
11545
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011546 Example:
11547 retry-on 503 504
11548
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011549 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
11550
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011551server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011552 Declare a server in a backend
11553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11554 no | no | yes | yes
11555 Arguments :
11556 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011557 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011558 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011559
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011560 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
11561 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
11562 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
11563 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011564 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
11565 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011566 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011567 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
11568 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011569 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
11570 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
11571 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
11572 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
11573 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11574 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11575 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011576 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020011577 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
11578 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
11579 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
11580 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
11581 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
11582 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011583 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11584 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011585 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
11586 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011587
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011588 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011589 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
11590 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
11591 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
11592 adding this value to the client's port.
11593
11594 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
11595 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011596 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011597
11598 Examples :
11599 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
11600 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011601 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011602 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
11603 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
11604 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011605
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020011606 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
11607 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
11608 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
11609 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
11610 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
11611
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011612 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
11613 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011614
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011615server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011616 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011617 this backend.
11618 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11619 no | no | yes | yes
11620
11621 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
11622 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
11623 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
11624 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
11625 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011626
11627 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
11628 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
11629
11630 global
11631 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
11632
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010011633 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011634 load-server-state-from-file
11635
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011636 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011637 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011638
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020011639server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
11640 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
11641 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
11642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11643 no | no | yes | yes
11644
11645 Arguments:
11646 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
11647
11648 <num | range>
11649 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
11650 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
11651 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
11652 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
11653
11654 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
11655
11656 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
11657
11658 <params*>
11659 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
11660 keyword.
11661
11662 Examples:
11663 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
11664 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
11665 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
11666
11667 # or
11668 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
11669
11670 # would be equivalent to:
11671 server srv1 google.com:80 check
11672 server srv2 google.com:80 check
11673 server srv3 google.com:80 check
11674
11675
11676
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011677source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011678source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011679source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011680 Set the source address for outgoing connections
11681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11682 yes | no | yes | yes
11683 Arguments :
11684 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
11685 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011686
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011687 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011688 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
11689 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
11690 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
11691 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
11692 supported prefixes are :
11693 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11694 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11695 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011696 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011697 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11698 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011699
11700 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
11701 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011702 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
11703 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
11704 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011705
11706 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
11707 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
11708 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
11709 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
11710 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
11711 <addr>.
11712
11713 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
11714 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
11715 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
11716 port.
11717
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011718 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
11719 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
11720 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
11721 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010011722 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011723 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
11724 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
11725 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
11726 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
11727 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
11728 HTTP header.
11729
11730 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
11731 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011732 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011733 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
11734 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11735 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
11736 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
11737 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
11738 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
11739 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
11740
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011741 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
11742 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
11743 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
11744 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
11745 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
11746 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
11747
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011748 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
11749 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
11750 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
11751 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
11752
11753 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
11754 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
11755 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
11756 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
11757 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
11758 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
11759
11760 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
11761 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
11762 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
11763 there are two methods :
11764
11765 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
11766 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
11767 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
11768 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
11769 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
11770 of the client ranges may be used.
11771
11772 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
11773 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
11774 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
11775 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
11776 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
11777 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
11778 same session.
11779
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011780 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
11781 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
11782 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011783 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011784
Willy Tarreaua547a212023-08-29 10:24:26 +020011785 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges, or on supported systems,
11786 the "cap_net_raw" capability. See also the "setcap" global directive.
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020011787
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011788 Examples :
11789 backend private
11790 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
11791 source 192.168.1.200
11792
11793 backend transparent_ssl1
11794 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
11795 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11796
11797 backend transparent_ssl2
11798 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
11799 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
11800 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
11801
11802 backend transparent_ssl3
11803 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
11804 # is more conntrack-friendly.
11805 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11806
11807 backend transparent_smtp
11808 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
11809 # with Tproxy version 4.
11810 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
11811
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011812 backend transparent_http
11813 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
11814 # proxy.
11815 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
11816
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011817 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011818 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
11819
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011820
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011821srvtcpka-cnt <count>
11822 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
11823 the connection on the server side.
11824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11825 yes | no | yes | yes
11826 Arguments :
11827 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
11828
11829 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
11830 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011831 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11832 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011833
11834 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11835
11836
11837srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
11838 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
11839 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
11840 server side.
11841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11842 yes | no | yes | yes
11843 Arguments :
11844 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
11845 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
11846 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
11847 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
11848
11849 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
11850 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011851 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11852 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011853
11854 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11855
11856
11857srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
11858 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
11859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11860 yes | no | yes | yes
11861 Arguments :
11862 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
11863 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
11864 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
11865 document.
11866
11867 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
11868 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011869 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11870 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011871
11872 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
11873
11874
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011875stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
11876 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
11877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011878 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011879
11880 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
11881 matched.
11882
11883 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
11884 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
11885
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010011886 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
11887 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
11888 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
11889 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011890
11891 Example :
11892 # statistics admin level only for localhost
11893 backend stats_localhost
11894 stats enable
11895 stats admin if LOCALHOST
11896
11897 Example :
11898 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
11899 backend stats_auth
11900 stats enable
11901 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
11902 stats admin if TRUE
11903
11904 Example :
11905 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
11906 userlist stats-auth
11907 group admin users admin
11908 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
11909 group readonly users haproxy
11910 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
11911
11912 backend stats_auth
11913 stats enable
11914 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
11915 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
11916 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
11917 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
11918
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011919 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
11920 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011921
11922
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011923stats auth <user>:<passwd>
11924 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
11925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011926 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011927 Arguments :
11928 <user> is a user name to grant access to
11929
11930 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
11931
11932 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
11933 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
11934 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
11935 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
11936 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
11937 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
11938
11939 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
11940 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
11941 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011942 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011943
11944 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
11945 report using "stats scope".
11946
11947 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11948 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11949 unobvious parameters.
11950
11951 Example :
11952 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11953 backend public_www
11954 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11955 stats enable
11956 stats hide-version
11957 stats scope .
11958 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011959 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011960 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11961 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11962
11963 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11964 backend private_monitoring
11965 stats enable
11966 stats uri /admin?stats
11967 stats refresh 5s
11968
11969 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
11970
11971
11972stats enable
11973 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
11974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011975 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011976 Arguments : none
11977
11978 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
11979 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
11980 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
11981 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
11982 - stats auth : no authentication
11983 - stats scope : no restriction
11984
11985 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11986 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11987 unobvious parameters.
11988
11989 Example :
11990 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11991 backend public_www
11992 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11993 stats enable
11994 stats hide-version
11995 stats scope .
11996 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011997 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011998 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11999 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12000
12001 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12002 backend private_monitoring
12003 stats enable
12004 stats uri /admin?stats
12005 stats refresh 5s
12006
12007 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
12008
12009
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012010stats hide-version
12011 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020012012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012013 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012014 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020012015
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012016 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
12017 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
12018 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
12019 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
12020 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
12021 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020012022
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020012023 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12024 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12025 unobvious parameters.
12026
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012027 Example :
12028 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12029 backend public_www
12030 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020012031 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012032 stats hide-version
12033 stats scope .
12034 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012035 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012036 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12037 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020012038
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020012039 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12040 backend private_monitoring
12041 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012042 stats uri /admin?stats
12043 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010012044
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012045 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020012046
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012047
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020012048stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
12049 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12050 Access control for statistics
12051
12052 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12053 no | no | yes | yes
12054
12055 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
12056 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
12057 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
12058 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
12059 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
12060 should be asked to enter a username and password.
12061
12062 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
12063 instance.
12064
12065 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
12066 about ACL usage.
12067
12068
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012069stats realm <realm>
12070 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
12071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012072 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012073 Arguments :
12074 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
12075 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
12076 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
12077
12078 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
12079 using a backslash ('\').
12080
12081 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
12082 only related to authentication.
12083
12084 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12085 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12086 unobvious parameters.
12087
12088 Example :
12089 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12090 backend public_www
12091 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12092 stats enable
12093 stats hide-version
12094 stats scope .
12095 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012096 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012097 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12098 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12099
12100 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12101 backend private_monitoring
12102 stats enable
12103 stats uri /admin?stats
12104 stats refresh 5s
12105
12106 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
12107
12108
12109stats refresh <delay>
12110 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
12111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012112 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012113 Arguments :
12114 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
12115 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
12116 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
12117 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
12118 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
12119 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
12120
12121 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
12122 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
12123 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050012124 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012125
12126 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12127 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12128 unobvious parameters.
12129
12130 Example :
12131 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12132 backend public_www
12133 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12134 stats enable
12135 stats hide-version
12136 stats scope .
12137 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012138 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012139 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12140 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12141
12142 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12143 backend private_monitoring
12144 stats enable
12145 stats uri /admin?stats
12146 stats refresh 5s
12147
12148 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
12149
12150
12151stats scope { <name> | "." }
12152 Enable statistics and limit access scope
12153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012154 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012155 Arguments :
12156 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
12157 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
12158 section in which the statement appears.
12159
12160 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
12161 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
12162 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
12163 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
12164 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
12165 exists.
12166
12167 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12168 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12169 unobvious parameters.
12170
12171 Example :
12172 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12173 backend public_www
12174 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12175 stats enable
12176 stats hide-version
12177 stats scope .
12178 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012179 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012180 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12181 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12182
12183 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12184 backend private_monitoring
12185 stats enable
12186 stats uri /admin?stats
12187 stats refresh 5s
12188
12189 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
12190
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012191
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012192stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012193 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
12194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012195 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012196
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012197 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012198 description from global section is automatically used instead.
12199
12200 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
12201 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
12202
12203 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12204 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012205 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012206
12207 Example :
12208 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12209 backend private_monitoring
12210 stats enable
12211 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
12212 stats uri /admin?stats
12213 stats refresh 5s
12214
12215 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
12216 global section.
12217
12218
12219stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012220 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
12221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12222 yes | yes | yes | yes
12223 Arguments : none
12224
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012225 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012226 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
12227 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
12228 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
12229 - IP (socket, server)
12230 - cookie (backend, server)
12231
12232 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12233 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012234 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012235
12236 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
12237
12238
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020012239stats show-modules
12240 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
12241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12242 yes | yes | yes | yes
12243 Arguments : none
12244
12245 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
12246 values as a tooltip.
12247
12248 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12249 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12250 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
12251
12252 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
12253
12254
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012255stats show-node [ <name> ]
12256 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
12257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012258 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012259 Arguments:
12260 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
12261 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
12262
12263 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
12264 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012265 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012266
12267 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12268 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12269 unobvious parameters.
12270
12271 Example:
12272 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12273 backend private_monitoring
12274 stats enable
12275 stats show-node Europe-1
12276 stats uri /admin?stats
12277 stats refresh 5s
12278
12279 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
12280 section.
12281
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012282
12283stats uri <prefix>
12284 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
12285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012286 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012287 Arguments :
12288 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
12289 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
12290 query string.
12291
12292 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
12293 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
12294 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
12295 possible to reach it in the application.
12296
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012297 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012298 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012299 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
12300 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
12301 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
12302 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
12303
12304 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
12305 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
12306 an address or a port to statistics only.
12307
12308 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12309 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12310 unobvious parameters.
12311
12312 Example :
12313 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12314 backend public_www
12315 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12316 stats enable
12317 stats hide-version
12318 stats scope .
12319 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012320 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012321 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12322 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12323
12324 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12325 backend private_monitoring
12326 stats enable
12327 stats uri /admin?stats
12328 stats refresh 5s
12329
12330 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
12331
12332
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012333stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
12334 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012336 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012337
12338 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012339 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012340 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012341 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012342 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
12343
12344 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12345 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12346 the "stick-table" statement.
12347
12348 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
12349 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
12350 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
12351 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
12352 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
12353
12354 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12355 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
12356 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
12357 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
12358 transformation rules.
12359
12360 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12361 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12362 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12363 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12364 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12365 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12366 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12367
12368 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
12369 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
12370 ACL based conditions.
12371
12372 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
12373 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
12374 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
12375 matches can be used as fallbacks.
12376
12377 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
12378 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
12379 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
12380 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
12381
12382 Example :
12383 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
12384 # last 30 minutes
12385 backend pop
12386 mode tcp
12387 balance roundrobin
12388 stick store-request src
12389 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12390 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
12391 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
12392
12393 backend smtp
12394 mode tcp
12395 balance roundrobin
12396 stick match src table pop
12397 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
12398 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
12399
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012400 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
12401 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012402
12403
12404stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
12405 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
12406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12407 no | no | yes | yes
12408
12409 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
12410 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
12411 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
12412 for writing more maintainable configurations.
12413
12414 Examples :
12415 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010012416 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012417
12418 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
12419 stick match src table pop if !localhost
12420 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
12421
12422
12423 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
12424 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
12425 backend http
12426 mode http
12427 balance roundrobin
12428 stick on src table https
12429 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
12430 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
12431 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
12432
12433 backend https
12434 mode tcp
12435 balance roundrobin
12436 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12437 stick on src
12438 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12439 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12440
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012441 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012442
12443
12444stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
12445 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
12446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12447 no | no | yes | yes
12448
12449 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012450 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012451 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012452 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012453 server is selected.
12454
12455 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12456 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12457 the "stick-table" statement.
12458
12459 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12460 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12461 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
12462 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
12463 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
12464 address.
12465
12466 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12467 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
12468 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
12469 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
12470 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
12471 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
12472 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
12473 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
12474 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
12475 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
12476
12477 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12478 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12479 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12480 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12481 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12482 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12483 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12484
12485 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
12486 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12487 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
12488 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12489
12490 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
12491 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12492 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12493 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12494 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12495 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012496 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
12497 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12498 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12499 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12500 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12501 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012502
12503 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
12504 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
12505 the request.
12506
12507 Example :
12508 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
12509 # last 30 minutes
12510 backend pop
12511 mode tcp
12512 balance roundrobin
12513 stick store-request src
12514 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12515 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
12516 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
12517
12518 backend smtp
12519 mode tcp
12520 balance roundrobin
12521 stick match src table pop
12522 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
12523 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
12524
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012525 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012526
12527
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012528stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012529 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012530 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080012531 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012533 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012534
12535 Arguments :
12536 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
12537 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
12538 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12539 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12540
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010012541 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
12542 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
12543 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12544 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12545
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012546 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
12547 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
12548 instance.
12549
12550 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
12551 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
12552 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
12553 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
12554 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
12555 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012556 to 32 characters.
12557
12558 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
12559 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
12560 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012561 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012562 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
12563 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012564
12565 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012566 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
12567 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012568 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
12569 increase.
12570
12571 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012572 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
12573 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
12574 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012575
12576 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012577 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012578 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
12579 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012580 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012581 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
12582 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
12583 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
12584 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
12585 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
12586 parameter (see below).
12587
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012588 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
12589 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
12590 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
12591 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
12592 soft restart.
12593
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012594 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012595 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
12596 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012597 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
12598 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012599 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012600 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012601 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
12602 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012603 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
12604 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012605
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012606 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
12607 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
12608 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
12609 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
12610 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
12611 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
12612 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
12613 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
12614 token.
12615
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012616 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
12617 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
12618 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
12619 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012620 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
12621 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
12622 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
12623 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
12624 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
12625 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
12626 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
12627 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
12628 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
12629 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
12630 types and their arguments.
12631
12632 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
12633 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
12634 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
12635 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
12636
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012637 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
12638 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
12639 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
12640 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
12641 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
12642 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
12643 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
12644 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
12645 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
12646 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012647 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
12648 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
12649 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
12650 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012651
12652 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
12653 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
12654 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
12655 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
12656 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
12657 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012658 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpt(100)
12659 allowing the storage of gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer
12660 update message can fit into the buffer.
12661 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpc(1) if you want to
12662 store only the counter gpc0.
12663 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012664 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
12665 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
12666 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012667 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
12668 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
12669 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
12670 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012671
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012672 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12673 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12674 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012675 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012676
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012677 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12678 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12679 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012680 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012681 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012682 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012683
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012684 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12685 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12686 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12687 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
12688
12689 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
12690 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12691 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
12692 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
12693 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
12694 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
12695
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012696 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
12697 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
12698 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
12699 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
12700 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012701 elements: gpt(100) allowing the storage of gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that
12702 the build of a peer update message can fit into the buffer.
12703 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpt(1) if you want to
12704 to store only the tag gpt0.
12705 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of counters will
12706 increase the data size and the traffic load using peers protocol since
12707 all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020012708 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
12709 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
12710 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012711
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020012712 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12713 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12714 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12715 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
12716
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012717 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12718 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
12719 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
12720 they were received.
12721
12722 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12723 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
12724 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
12725 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
12726 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
12727
12728 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12729 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12730 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12731 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
12732 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12733
12734 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12735 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
12736 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
12737
12738 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12739 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12740 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12741 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
12742 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12743
12744 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12745 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
12746 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
12747 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
12748 the client side.
12749
12750 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12751 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12752 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12753 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
12754 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
12755 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
12756 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
12757
12758 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12759 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
12760 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12761 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
12762 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
12763 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012764 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012765
12766 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12767 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12768 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12769 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12770 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
12771 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12772
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010012773 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12774 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
12775 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12776 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
12777 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
12778
12779 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12780 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12781 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12782 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12783 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
12784 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12785
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012786 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012787 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012788 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
12789 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
12790
12791 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12792 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12793 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12794 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12795 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12796 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
12797 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
12798 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
12799 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
12800 recommended for better fairness.
12801
12802 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012803 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012804 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
12805 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
12806
12807 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12808 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12809 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12810 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12811 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12812 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
12813 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
12814 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
12815 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
12816 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012817
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012818 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
12819 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012820 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
12821 reference it.
12822
12823 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
12824 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010012825 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
12826 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
12827 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012828
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012829 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
12830 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
12831 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
12832 something that can be ignored.
12833
12834 Example:
12835 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
12836 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
12837 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
12838 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
12839
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012840 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010012841 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012842
12843
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012844stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010012845 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12847 no | no | yes | yes
12848
12849 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012850 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012851 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012852 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012853 server is selected.
12854
12855 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12856 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12857 the "stick-table" statement.
12858
12859 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12860 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12861 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
12862 when the response is a SSL server hello.
12863
12864 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12865 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
12866 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
12867 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
12868 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
12869 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012870 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012871 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
12872 rules.
12873
12874 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12875 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12876 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12877 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12878 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12879 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12880 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12881
12882 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
12883 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12884 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
12885 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12886
12887 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
12888 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12889 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12890 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12891 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12892 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012893 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
12894 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12895 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12896 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12897 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12898 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
12899 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
12900 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
12901 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012902
12903 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
12904
12905 Example :
12906 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
12907 backend https
12908 mode tcp
12909 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012910 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012911 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012912
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012913 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
William Lallemand8244cb72023-12-07 15:00:58 +010012914 acl serverhello res.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012915
12916 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
12917 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12918 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
12919
12920 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
12921 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012922
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012923 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
12924 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
12925 # at offset 44.
12926
12927 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012928 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012929
12930 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012931 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012932
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012933 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12934 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12935
12936 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
12937 extraction.
12938
12939
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012940tcp-check comment <string>
12941 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
12942 it fails.
12943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12944 yes | no | yes | yes
12945
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012946 Arguments :
12947 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
12948 rule fails.
12949
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012950 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
12951 user-friendly error reporting.
12952
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012953 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
12954 "tcp-check expect".
12955
12956
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012957tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
12958 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012959 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012960 Opens a new connection
12961 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012962 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012963
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012964 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012965 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12966
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012967 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012968 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012969
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012970 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012971 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
12972 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012973 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012974
12975 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012976
12977 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
12978
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020012979 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
12980
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012981 ssl opens a ciphered connection
12982
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020012983 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
12984
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020012985 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
12986 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
12987 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12988 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12989
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012990 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
12991 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
12992 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
12993 haproxy -vv.
12994
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012995 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012996
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012997 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
12998 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
12999 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
13000
13001 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
13002 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
13003 of the sequence.
13004
13005 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
13006 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
13007 do.
13008
13009 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
13010 unset-var or comment rules.
13011
13012 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013013 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
13014 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
13015 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
13016 option tcp-check
13017 tcp-check connect
13018 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
13019 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
13020 tcp-check send \r\n
13021 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
13022 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
13023 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
13024 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
13025 tcp-check send \r\n
13026 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
13027 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
13028
13029 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
13030 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010013031 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013032 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
13033 tcp-check connect port 143
13034 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
13035 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
13036
13037 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
13038
13039
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013040tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020013041 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020013042 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013043 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013044 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013045 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013046 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013047
13048 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013049 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
13050
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010013051 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
13052 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
13053 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
13054 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
13055 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
13056 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
13057 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
13058 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
13059 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
13060 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
13061
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013062 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010013063 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
13064 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013065 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
13066 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
13067 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
13068
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020013069 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
13070 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
13071 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020013072 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
13073 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010013074 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
13075 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020013076 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
13077 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020013078 By default "L7OK" is used.
13079
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013080 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
13081 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010013082 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
13083 supported :
13084 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
13085 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020013086 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13087 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
13088 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13089 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
13090 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013091
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020013092 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013093 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020013094 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
13095 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13096 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13097 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013098 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
13099
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020013100 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
13101 informational message reported in logs if the expect
13102 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
13103 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
13104
13105 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
13106 informational message reported in logs if an error
13107 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
13108 log-format string.
13109
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020013110 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
13111 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
13112 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
13113 followed by some converters.
13114
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013115 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
13116 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
13117 with the usual backslash ('\').
13118 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013119 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013120 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
13121 used upper or lower case.
13122
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013123 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
13124
13125 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
13126 A health check response will be considered valid if the
13127 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
13128 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
13129 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
13130 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
13131 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
13132 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
13133
13134 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
13135 A health check response will be considered valid if the
13136 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
13137 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
13138 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
13139 expression.
13140
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020013141 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
13142 A health check response will be considered valid if the
13143 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
13144 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
13145 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
13146 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
13147
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013148 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
13149 in the response buffer. A health check response will
13150 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
13151 this exact hexadecimal string.
13152 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
13153
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010013154 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
13155 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
13156 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
13157 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
13158 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
13159 size of the original response. As such, the expected
13160 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
13161 size.
13162
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020013163 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
13164 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
13165 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
13166 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
13167 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
13168 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
13169 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
13170 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
13171 in a binary string before matching the response's
13172 buffer.
13173
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013174 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013175 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013176 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
13177 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
13178 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
13179 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
13180 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
13181 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
13182 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
13183 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
13184 the null character.
13185
13186 Examples :
13187 # perform a POP check
13188 option tcp-check
13189 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
13190
13191 # perform an IMAP check
13192 option tcp-check
13193 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
13194
13195 # look for the redis master server
13196 option tcp-check
13197 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020013198 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013199 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
13200 tcp-check expect string role:master
13201 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
13202 tcp-check expect string +OK
13203
13204
13205 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013206 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013207
13208
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013209tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
13210tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
13211 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
13212 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013213 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013214 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013215
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013216 Arguments :
13217 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
13218
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013219 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
13220 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020013221
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013222 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
13223 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013224
13225 Examples :
13226 # look for the redis master server
13227 option tcp-check
13228 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
13229 tcp-check expect string role:master
13230
13231 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013232 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013233
13234
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013235tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
13236tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
13237 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
13238 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013239 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013240 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013241
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013242 Arguments :
13243 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013244
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013245 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
13246 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020013247
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013248 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
13249 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
13250 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013251
13252 Examples :
13253 # redis check in binary
13254 option tcp-check
13255 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
13256 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
13257
13258
13259 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013260 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013261
13262
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013263tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13264tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013265 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013266 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013267 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013268
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013269 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013270 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13271 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
13272 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
13273 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
13274 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
13275 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
13276 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
13277 and '-'.
13278
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013279 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
13280 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +050013281 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013282 conditions.
13283
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013284 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
13285
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013286 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +020013287 Log Format in section 8.2.6).
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013288
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013289 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013290 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013291 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013292
13293
13294tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013295 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013296 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013297 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013298
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013299 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013300 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13301 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
13302 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
13303 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
13304 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
13305 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
13306 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
13307 and '-'.
13308
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013309 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013310 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
13311
13312
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013313tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013314 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020013315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013316 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013317 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013318 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13319 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020013320
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013321 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013322
13323 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
13324 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013325 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
13326 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
13327 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
13328 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
13329 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
13330 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013331
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013332 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13333 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13334 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013335 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
13336 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
13337 is true.
13338
13339 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13340 supported:
13341 - accept
13342 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
13343 - expect-proxy layer4
13344 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013345 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013346 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13347 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13348 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13349 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13350 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13351 - set-dst <expr>
13352 - set-dst-port <expr>
13353 - set-mark <mark>
13354 - set-src <expr>
13355 - set-src-port <expr>
13356 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013357 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13358 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013359 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013360 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13361 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13362 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013363 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013364
13365 The supported actions are described below.
13366
13367 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
13368 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013369
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013370 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13371 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13372 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13373 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13374 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13375 a defaults section defining such rules.
13376
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013377 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13378 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13379 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013380
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013381 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
13382 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
13383 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013384
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013385 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13386 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
13387 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013388
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013389 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
13390 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
13391 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013392
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013393 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13394 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
13395 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013396
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013397 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013398
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013399 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013400
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013401 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013402
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013403 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013404
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013405tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013406
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013407 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
13408 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013409
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013410tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
13411 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013412
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013413 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
13414 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
13415 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
13416 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
13417 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
13418 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
13419 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013420
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013421tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013422
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013423 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
13424 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
13425 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
13426 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
13427 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
13428 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020013429
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013430tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013431
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013432 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
13433 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
13434 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
13435 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
13436 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
13437 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
13438 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
13439 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
13440 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
13441 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
13442 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013443
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013444tcp-request connection sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13445 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13446
13447 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13448 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13449 a complete description.
13450
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013451tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13452tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13453tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013454
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013455 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13456 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13457 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13458 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013459
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013460tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13461 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13462tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13463 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013464
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013465 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13466 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020013467 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020013468
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013469tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13470tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013471
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013472 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13473 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13474 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013475
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013476tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013477
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013478 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13479 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13480 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013481
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013482tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13483tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013484
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013485 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13486 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13487 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013488
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013489tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013490
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013491 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13492 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13493 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013494
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013495tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13496tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013497
13498 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13499 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
13500 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13501 for a complete description.
13502
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013503tcp-request connection silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013504
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013505 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13506 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13507 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13508 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013509
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013510tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13511tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13512tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013513
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013514 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13515 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13516 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013517
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013518tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13519
13520 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13521 details about variables.
13522
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013523
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013524tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13525 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013527 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013528 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013529 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13530 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013531
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013532 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013533
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013534 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013535 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13536 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013537 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
13538 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013539
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013540 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
13541 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
13542 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
13543 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013544 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013545 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013546 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
13547 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
13548 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
13549 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013550 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013551 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013552
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013553 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13554 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13555 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13556 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013557
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013558 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13559 supported:
13560 - accept
13561 - capture <sample> len <length>
13562 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13563 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013564 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013565 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013566 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013567 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013568 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010013569 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013570 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013571 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020013572 - set-dst <expr>
13573 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013574 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013575 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013576 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013577 - set-priority-class <expr>
13578 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013579 - set-src <expr>
13580 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013581 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013582 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13583 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013584 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013585 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013586 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13587 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13588 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013589 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013590 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013591
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013592 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013593
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013594 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
13595 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
13596 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
13597 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
13598 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
13599 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013600
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013601 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13602 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13603 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13604 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13605 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13606 a defaults section defining such rules.
13607
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013608 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013609 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13610 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013611
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020013612 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
13613 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
13614 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
13615 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
13616 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
13617 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
13618
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013619 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020013620 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
13621 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
13622 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
13623 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
13624 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
13625 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
13626 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
13627 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
13628 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
13629 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013630
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013631 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013632 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
13633 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
13634 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013635
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013636 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONd49b5592022-10-05 18:09:33 +020013637 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013638
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013639 Example:
13640
13641 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013642 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013643 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013644
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013645 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013646 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013647 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013648 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13649 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020013650 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013651 tcp-request content reject
13652
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013653 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
13654 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
13655 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13656 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13657 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
13658 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
13659 ...
13660 http-request reject unless is_host_com
13661
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013662 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013663 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
13664 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013665 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013666 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013667
13668 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
13669 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013670 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013671 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013672 tcp-request content reject
13673
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013674 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013675 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013676 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013677 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013678 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
13679 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013680
13681 Example:
13682 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13683 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013684 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013685
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013686 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013687 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013688
13689 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013690 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013691 # protecting all our sites
13692 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013693 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
13694 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013695 ...
13696 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
13697
13698 backend http_dynamic
13699 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013700 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013701 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013702 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013703 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013704 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013705 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013706
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013707 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013708
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030013709 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
13710 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013711
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013712tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13713
13714 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010013715 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013716
13717tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
13718 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13719
13720 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
13721 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
13722 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
13723 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
13724 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
13725 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
13726 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
13727 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
13728 information.
13729
13730tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13731
13732 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
13733 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
13734 complete description.
13735
13736tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13737
13738 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
13739 are evaluated.
13740
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013741tcp-request content sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13742 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13743
13744 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13745 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13746 a complete description.
13747
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013748tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13749tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13750tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13751
13752 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13753 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13754 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13755 description.
13756
13757tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13758 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13759tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13760 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13761
13762 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13763 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020013764 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013765
13766tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13767 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13768
Willy Tarreau707742f2023-11-30 09:27:51 +010013769 This action is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013770 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
13771
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013772tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
13773 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013774
13775 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13776 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13777 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13778
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013779tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13780tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13781
13782 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13783 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13784 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13785
13786tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13787
13788 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13789 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
13790
13791tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13792
13793 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13794 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13795 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13796
13797tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13798
13799 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13800 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
13801
13802tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13803
13804 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
13805 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
13806
13807tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13808
13809 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
13810 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
13811 description.
13812
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013813tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13814tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13815
13816 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13817 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13818 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13819
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013820tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13821
13822 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13823 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13824 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13825
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013826tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13827tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013828
13829 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13830 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13831 for a complete description.
13832
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013833tcp-request content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013834
13835 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13836 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13837 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13838 complete description.
13839
13840tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
13841 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13842
13843 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
13844 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
13845 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
13846 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
13847 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
13848 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
13849 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
13850 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
13851 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
13852 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
13853
13854 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
13855
13856tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13857tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13858tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13859
13860 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13861 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13862 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13863
13864tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13865
13866 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13867 details about variables.
13868
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +020013869tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013870
13871 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
13872 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
13873 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
13874 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
13875 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
13876
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013877
13878tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
13879 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
13880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013881 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013882 Arguments :
13883 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13884 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13885 as explained at the top of this document.
13886
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013887 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013888 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
13889 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
13890 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
13891 data for at most the specified amount of time.
13892
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020013893 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
13894 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
13895 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
13896 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
13897
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013898 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013899 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013900 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013901 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013902 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010013903 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
13904 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
13905 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013906
Christopher Faulet43525ab2023-05-16 08:15:12 +020013907 Note the inspection delay is shortened if an connection error or shutdown is
13908 experienced or if the request buffer appears as full.
13909
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013910 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
13911 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
13912 it pass through unaffected.
13913
13914 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
13915 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
13916 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013917 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013918 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
13919 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020013920 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
13921 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
13922 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013923
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013924 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13925 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13926
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013927 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013928 "timeout client".
13929
13930
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013931tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13932 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
13933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013934 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013935 Arguments :
13936 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13937 below.
13938
13939 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13940
13941 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
13942 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
13943 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
13944 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053013945 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013946 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
13947 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
13948 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
13949 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
13950 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
13951 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
13952 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
13953 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
13954 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
13955 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
13956 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
13957 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
13958 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
13959 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
13960 instead.
13961
13962 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13963 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13964 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
13965 rules which may be inserted.
13966
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013967 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13968 supported:
13969 - accept
13970 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013971 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013972 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13973 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13974 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13975 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13976 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013977 - set-dst <expr>
13978 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013979 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013980 - set-src <expr>
13981 - set-src-port <expr>
13982 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013983 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13984 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013985 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013986 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13987 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13988 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
13989 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013990
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013991 The supported actions are described below.
13992
13993 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13994 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13995 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13996 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13997 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13998 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013999
14000 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
14001 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
14002 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
14003
14004 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
14005 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
14006 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
14007 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
14008 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
14009
14010 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
14011 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
14012
14013 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
14014 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
14015 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
14016
14017 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
14018 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
14019 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
14020
14021 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
14022 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
14023 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
14024
14025 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
14026 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
14027 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
14028
14029 See section 7 about ACL usage.
14030
14031 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
14032
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014033tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14034
14035 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
14036 rules are evaluated.
14037
14038tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14039
14040 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
14041 are evaluated.
14042
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010014043tcp-request session sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14044 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14045
14046 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
14047 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
14048 a complete description.
14049
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014050tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14051tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14052tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14053
14054 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
14055 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
14056 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
14057 description.
14058
14059tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14060 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14061tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14062 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14063
14064 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
14065 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020014066 sc-set-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014067 description.
14068
14069tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14070tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14071
14072 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
14073 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
14074 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
14075
14076tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14077
14078 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
14079 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
14080 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
14081
14082tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14083tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14084
14085 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
14086 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
14087 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
14088
14089tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14090
14091 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
14092 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
14093 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
14094
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010014095tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14096tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014097
14098 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
14099 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
14100 for a complete description.
14101
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010014102tcp-request session silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014103
14104 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
14105 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
14106 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
14107 complete description.
14108
14109tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14110tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14111tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14112
14113 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
14114 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
14115 track-sc2" for a complete description.
14116
14117tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14118
14119 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
14120 details about variables.
14121
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020014122
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014123tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
14124 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
14125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014126 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014127 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020014128 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
14129 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014130
14131 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
14132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014133 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014134 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
14135 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020014136 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
14137 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014138
14139 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
14140
14141 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
14142 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
14143 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
14144 inserted.
14145
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014146 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
14147 supported:
14148 - accept
14149 - close
14150 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010014151 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014152 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
14153 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
14154 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
14155 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14156 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14157 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010014158 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014159 - set-log-level <level>
14160 - set-mark <mark>
14161 - set-nice <nice>
14162 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010014163 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
14164 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010014165 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014166 - unset-var(<var-name>)
14167
14168 The supported actions are described below.
14169
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014170 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
14171 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
14172 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
14173 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
14174 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
14175 a defaults section defining such rules.
14176
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014177 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
14178 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
14179 for changing the default action to a reject.
14180
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014181 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014182
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014183 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
14184 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
14185 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
14186 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
14187 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020014188
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014189 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014190
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014191 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020014192
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014193tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020014194
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014195 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
14196 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020014197
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014198tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020014199
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014200 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
14201 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
14202 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
14203 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
14204 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
14205 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014206
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014207tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020014208
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014209 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
14210 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014211
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010014212tcp-response content sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14213 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14214
14215 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
14216 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
14217 a complete description.
14218
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014219tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14220tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14221tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020014222
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014223 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
14224 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
14225 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
14226 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020014227
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014228tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14229 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14230tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14231 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014232
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014233 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
14234 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020014235 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020014236
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014237tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
14238 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014239
Willy Tarreau707742f2023-11-30 09:27:51 +010014240 This action is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014241 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020014242
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020014243
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010014244tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
14245 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020014246
14247 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
14248 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
14249 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
14250
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014251tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014252
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014253 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
14254 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014255
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014256tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014257
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014258 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
14259 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
14260 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014261
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014262tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014263
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014264 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
14265 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014266
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014267tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020014268
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014269 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
14270 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
14271 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014272
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010014273tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14274tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014275
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014276 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
14277 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
14278 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014279
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010014280tcp-response content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014281
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014282 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
14283 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
14284 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
14285 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014286
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014287tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014288
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014289 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
14290 details about variables.
14291
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014292
14293tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
14294 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
14295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014296 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014297 Arguments :
14298 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14299 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14300 as explained at the top of this document.
14301
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014302 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
14303 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014304
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014305 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
14306
14307
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014308timeout check <timeout>
14309 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
14310 established.
14311
14312 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14313 yes | no | yes | yes
14314 Arguments:
14315 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14316 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14317 as explained at the top of this document.
14318
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014319 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014320 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014321 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014322 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010014323 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
14324 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
14325 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014326
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014327 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014328 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
14329
14330 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
14331 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010014332 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014333
14334 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14335 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14336 forget about it.
14337
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010014338 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
14339 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014340
14341
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014342timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014343 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
14344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14345 yes | yes | yes | no
14346 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014347 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014348 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14349 as explained at the top of this document.
14350
14351 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
14352 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
14353 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010014354 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
14355 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
14356 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
14357 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014358 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
14359 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
14360 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014361 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014362 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014363 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
14364 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014365 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
14366 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014367
14368 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
14369 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14370 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14371 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014372 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014373 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14374
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014375 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014376
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014377
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014378timeout client-fin <timeout>
14379 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
14380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14381 yes | yes | yes | no
14382 Arguments :
14383 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14384 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14385 as explained at the top of this document.
14386
14387 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
14388 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
14389 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
14390 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
14391 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
14392 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
14393 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010014394 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
14395 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
14396 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014397
14398 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
14399 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
14400 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
14401
14402 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
14403
14404
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014405timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014406 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
14407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14408 yes | no | yes | yes
14409 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014410 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014411 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14412 as explained at the top of this document.
14413
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014414 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014415 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014416 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014417 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014418 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
14419 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014420
14421 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14422 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14423 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14424 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014425 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014426 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14427
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014428 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014429
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014430
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014431timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
14432 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
14433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14434 yes | yes | yes | yes
14435 Arguments :
14436 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14437 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14438 as explained at the top of this document.
14439
14440 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
14441 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
14442 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
14443 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
14444 once the request has started to present itself.
14445
14446 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
14447 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
14448 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
14449 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
14450 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
14451
14452 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
14453 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
14454 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
14455 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
14456
14457 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
14458 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014459 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014460 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
14461 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014462 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014463
14464 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
14465 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
14466 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
14467 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
14468
14469 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
14470
14471
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014472timeout http-request <timeout>
14473 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
14474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020014475 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014476 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014477 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014478 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14479 as explained at the top of this document.
14480
14481 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
14482 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
14483 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
14484 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
14485 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
14486 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
14487 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020014488 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
14489 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
14490 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
14491 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014492 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014493 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
14494 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014495
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014496 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
14497 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
14498 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
14499 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
14500 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014501 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014502
14503 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
14504 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014505 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014506 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
14507 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
14508
14509 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020014510 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
14511 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
14512 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014513
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014514 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014515 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014516
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014517
14518timeout queue <timeout>
14519 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
14520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14521 yes | no | yes | yes
14522 Arguments :
14523 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14524 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14525 as explained at the top of this document.
14526
14527 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
14528 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
14529 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
14530 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
14531 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
14532
14533 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
14534 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
14535 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
14536 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
14537
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014538 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014539
14540
14541timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014542 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
14543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14544 yes | no | yes | yes
14545 Arguments :
14546 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14547 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14548 as explained at the top of this document.
14549
14550 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14551 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
14552 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
14553 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
14554 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
14555 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
14556 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
14557
14558 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14559 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14560 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
14561 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
14562 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014563 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014564 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014565 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
14566 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014567 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
14568 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014569
14570 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14571 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14572 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14573 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014574 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014575 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14576
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014577 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014578
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014579
14580timeout server-fin <timeout>
14581 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
14582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14583 yes | no | yes | yes
14584 Arguments :
14585 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14586 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14587 as explained at the top of this document.
14588
14589 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14590 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
14591 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
14592 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
14593 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
14594 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
14595 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
14596 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
14597 situations, it should not be needed.
14598
14599 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14600 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
14601 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
14602
14603 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
14604
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014605
14606timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014607 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14609 yes | yes | yes | yes
14610 Arguments :
14611 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
14612 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14613 as explained at the top of this document.
14614
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014615 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
14616 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
14617 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014618
14619 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14620 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14621 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
14622 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014623 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014624
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014625 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014626
14627
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014628timeout tunnel <timeout>
14629 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
14630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14631 yes | no | yes | yes
14632 Arguments :
14633 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14634 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14635 as explained at the top of this document.
14636
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014637 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014638 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
14639 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
14640 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014641 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
14642 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014643 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
14644 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
14645 specified.
14646
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014647 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
14648 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
14649 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
14650 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
14651 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
14652 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
14653 state.
14654
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014655 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14656 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14657 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
14658 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014659 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014660
14661 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14662 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14663 forget about it.
14664
14665 Example :
14666 defaults http
14667 option http-server-close
14668 timeout connect 5s
14669 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014670 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014671 timeout server 30s
14672 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
14673
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014674 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014675
14676
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014677transparent (deprecated)
14678 Enable client-side transparent proxying
14679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010014680 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014681 Arguments : none
14682
14683 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
14684 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
14685 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
14686 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
14687 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
14688 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
14689 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
14690 appropriate server.
14691
14692 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
14693
14694 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
14695 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
14696
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014697 See also: "option transparent"
14698
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014699unique-id-format <string>
14700 Generate a unique ID for each request.
14701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14702 yes | yes | yes | no
14703 Arguments :
14704 <string> is a log-format string.
14705
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014706 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
14707 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
14708 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
14709 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014710
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014711 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014712 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014713 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
14714 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
14715 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
14716 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
14717 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
14718 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014719
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014720 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
14721 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014722
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014723 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014724
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014725 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014726
14727 will generate:
14728
14729 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14730
14731 See also: "unique-id-header"
14732
14733unique-id-header <name>
14734 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
14735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14736 yes | yes | yes | no
14737 Arguments :
14738 <name> is the name of the header.
14739
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014740 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
14741 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014742
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014743 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014744
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014745 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014746 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
14747
14748 will generate:
14749
14750 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14751
14752 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014753
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014754use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014755 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14757 no | yes | yes | no
14758 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014759 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
14760 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014761
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014762 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
14763 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014764
14765 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
14766 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
14767 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014768 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014769 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014770 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
14771 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014772
14773 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
14774 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
14775 assign the backend.
14776
14777 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
14778 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14779 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
14780 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
14781 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
14782 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
14783
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014784 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014785 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014786 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
14787 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
14788 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
14789
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014790 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
14791 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
14792 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
14793 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
14794 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
14795 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
14796 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
14797 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
14798 cannot be forced from the request.
14799
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014800 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014801 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
14802 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
14803
14804 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
14805 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014806
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020014807use-fcgi-app <name>
14808 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
14809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14810 no | no | yes | yes
14811 Arguments :
14812 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
14813
14814 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014815
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014816use-server <server> if <condition>
14817use-server <server> unless <condition>
14818 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
14819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14820 no | no | yes | yes
14821 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014822 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
14823 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014824
14825 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
14826
14827 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
14828 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
14829 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
14830
14831 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
14832 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
14833 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
14834 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
14835 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
14836 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
14837 matches will assign the server.
14838
14839 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
14840 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
14841 with the next rules until one matches.
14842
14843 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
14844 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14845 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
14846 according to other persistence mechanisms.
14847
14848 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
14849 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
14850 stripped.
14851
14852 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
14853 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014854 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014855 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014856 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014857
14858 Example :
14859 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014860 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014861 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014862 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014863 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014864 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000014865 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014866 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
14867 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
14868
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014869 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
14870 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
14871 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
14872 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050014873 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014874 and we fall back to load balancing.
14875
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014876 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014877
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014878
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100148795. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014880--------------------------
14881
14882The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
14883depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
14884settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
14885written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
14886described in this section.
14887
14888
148895.1. Bind options
14890-----------------
14891
14892The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
14893as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
14894no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
14895parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
14896while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
14897provided immediately after the setting name.
14898
14899The currently supported settings are the following ones.
14900
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014901accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
14902 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
14903 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
14904 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
14905 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
14906 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
14907 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
14908 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
14909 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
14910 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010014911 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
14912 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
14913 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014914
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014915accept-proxy
14916 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020014917 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
14918 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014919 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
14920 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
14921 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
14922 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014923 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014924 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
14925 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020014926 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
14927 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014928
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014929allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010014930 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014931 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014932 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014933 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
14934 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014935
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014936alpn <protocols>
14937 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14938 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14939 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014940 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014941 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020014942 initial NPN extension. At the protocol layer, ALPN is required to enable
14943 HTTP/2 on an HTTPS frontend and HTTP/3 on a QUIC frontend. However, when such
14944 frontends have none of "npn", "alpn" and "no-alpn" set, a default value of
14945 "h2,http/1.1" will be used for a regular HTTPS frontend, and "h3" for a QUIC
14946 frontend. Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only
14947 supposed the now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most
14948 browsers still support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may
14949 still work for a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. Protocols
14950 not advertised are not negotiated. For example it is possible to only accept
14951 HTTP/2 connections with this:
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014952
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020014953 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2 # explicitly disable HTTP/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014954
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020014955 QUIC supports only h3 and hq-interop as ALPN. h3 is for HTTP/3 and hq-interop
14956 is used for http/0.9 and QUIC interop runner (see https://interop.seemann.io).
Willy Tarreau74d7cc02023-04-19 09:10:47 +020014957 Each "alpn" statement will replace a previous one. In order to remove them,
14958 use "no-alpn".
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020014959
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020014960 Note that some old browsers such as Firefox 88 used to experience issues with
14961 WebSocket over H2, and in case such a setup is encountered, it may be needed
14962 to either explicitly disable HTTP/2 in the "alpn" string by forcing it to
14963 "http/1.1" or "no-alpn", or to enable "h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients"
14964 globally.
14965
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014966backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010014967 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014968 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
14969
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010014970curves <curves>
14971 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14972 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
14973 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
14974 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
14975 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
14976 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
14977
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014978ecdhe <named curve>
14979 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010014980 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
14981 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014982
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014983ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014984 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14985 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014986 client's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
14987 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020014988 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014989
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014990 Warning: The "@system-ca" parameter could be used in place of the cafile
14991 in order to use the trusted CAs of your system, like its done with the server
14992 directive. But you mustn't use it unless you know what you are doing.
14993 Configuring it this way basically mean that the bind will accept any client
14994 certificate generated from one of the CA present on your system, which is
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050014995 extremely insecure.
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014996
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014997ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
14998 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14999 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010015000 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
15001 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
15002 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
15003 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
15004 in new version of OpenSSL.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020015005 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
15006 error is ignored.
15007
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020015008ca-sign-file <cafile>
15009 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15010 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
15011 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
15012 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
15013 'generate-certificates' for details.
15014
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000015015ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020015016 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
15017 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
15018 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
15019 'generate-certificates' for details.
15020
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010015021ca-verify-file <cafile>
15022 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
15023 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
15024 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
15025 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
15026 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
15027
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015028ciphers <ciphers>
15029 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
15030 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000015031 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000015032 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015033 information and recommendations see e.g.
15034 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
15035 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
15036 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
15037
15038ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
15039 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
15040 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
William Lallemandee8a65a2024-03-11 15:48:14 +010015041 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
15042 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
15043 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
15044 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
15045 This setting might accept TLSv1.2 ciphersuites however this is an
15046 undocumented behavior and not recommended as it could be inconsistent or buggy.
15047 The default TLSv1.3 ciphersuites of OpenSSL are:
15048 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
15049
15050 TLSv1.3 only supports 5 ciphersuites:
15051
15052 - TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
15053 - TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
15054 - TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256
15055 - TLS_AES_128_CCM_SHA256
15056 - TLS_AES_128_CCM_8_SHA256
15057
15058 Example:
15059 ciphers ECDHE-RSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384:ECDHE-RSA-CHACHA20-POLY1305:ECDHE-RSA-AES128-GCM-SHA256
15060 ciphersuites TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015061
William Lallemandb6ae2aa2023-05-05 00:05:46 +020015062client-sigalgs <sigalgs>
15063 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
15064 the string describing the list of signature algorithms related to client
15065 authentication that are negotiated . The format of the string is defined in
15066 "man 3 SSL_CTX_set1_client_sigalgs" from the OpenSSL man pages. It is not
15067 recommended to use this setting if no specific usecase was identified.
15068
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020015069crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015070 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15071 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020015072 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
15073 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015074
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015075crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015076 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15077 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
15078 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
15079 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
15080 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010015081 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
15082 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015083
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010015084 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
15085 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
15086
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015087 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
15088 are loaded.
15089
15090 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010015091 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
William Lallemand589570d2022-05-09 10:30:51 +020015092 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). Files
15093 starting with a dot are also ignored. This directive may be specified multiple
15094 times in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
15095 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
15096 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
15097 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
15098 hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
William Lallemand5c099352023-04-04 16:28:58 +020015099 www.sub.example.org). If an empty directory is used, HAProxy will not start
15100 unless the "strict-sni" keyword is used.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015101
15102 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
15103 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
15104 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
15105 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010015106 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
15107 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015108
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020015109 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015110
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015111 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015112 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015113 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
15114 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015115 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
15116 clients).
15117
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015118 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020015119 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
15120 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
15121 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
15122 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
15123 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
15124 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
15125 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
15126 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
15127 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
15128 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
15129 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
15130 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
15131
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015132 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010015133 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
15134 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
15135 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
15136 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
15137
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050015138 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
15139 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
15140 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
15141 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050015142
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020015143 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
15144 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
15145 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050015146
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020015147crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015148 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010015149 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
15150 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
15151 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
15152 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
15153 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
15154 in new version of OpenSSL.
15155 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
15156 error is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020015157
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015158crt-list <file>
15159 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015160 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
15161 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015162
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015163 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
15164
William Lallemandb5a3d582024-05-21 17:49:58 +020015165 sslbindconf supports the following keywords from the bind line
15166 (see Section 5.1. Bind options):
15167
15168 - allow-0rtt
15169 - alpn
15170 - ca-file
15171 - ca-verify-file
15172 - ciphers
15173 - ciphersuites
15174 - client-sigalgs
15175 - crl-file
15176 - curves
15177 - ecdhe
15178 - no-alpn
15179 - no-ca-names
15180 - npn
15181 - sigalgs
15182 - ssl-min-ver
15183 - ssl-max-ver
15184 - verify
15185
15186 It overrides the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015187
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020015188 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030015189 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
15190 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
15191 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
15192 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
15193 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020015194 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
15195 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
15196 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015197
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020015198 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
15199 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
15200 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050015201
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020015202 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
15203
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030015204 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015205 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030015206 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
15207 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
15208 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
15209 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
15210 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
15211 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030015212
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020015213 When no ALPN is set, the "bind" line's default one is used. If a "bind" line
15214 has no "no-alpn", "alpn" nor "npn" set, a default value will be used
15215 depending on the protocol (see "alpn" above). However if the "bind" line has
15216 a different default, or explicitly disables ALPN using "no-alpn", it is
15217 possible to force a specific value for a certificate.
15218
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015219 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030015220 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020015221 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010015222 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015223 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010015224 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015225
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015226defer-accept
15227 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
15228 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
15229 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015230 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015231 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
15232 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
15233 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
15234 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
15235 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
15236 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
15237 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
15238
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020015239expose-fd listeners
15240 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
15241 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010015242 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
15243 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015244 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020015245
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015246force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015247 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015248 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015249 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015250 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015251
15252force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015253 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015254 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015255 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015256
15257force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015258 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015259 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015260 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015261
15262force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015263 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015264 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015265 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015266
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015267force-tlsv13
15268 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
15269 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015270 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015271
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020015272generate-certificates
15273 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15274 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
15275 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
15276 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
15277 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
15278 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
15279 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
15280 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
15281 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
15282 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
15283 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
15284
15285 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
15286 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015287 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020015288 certificate is used many times.
15289
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015290gid <gid>
15291 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
15292 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15293 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
15294 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
15295 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15296
15297group <group>
15298 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
15299 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
15300 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
15301 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
15302 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15303
15304id <id>
15305 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
15306 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
15307 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
15308 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
15309
15310interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010015311 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
15312 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
15313 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
15314 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
15315 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
15316 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010015317 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
15318 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
15319 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
15320 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
15321 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
15322 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015323
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015324level <level>
15325 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
15326 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
15327 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015328 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015329 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
15330 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
15331 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015332 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015333 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015334 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015335 all counters).
15336
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020015337severity-output <format>
15338 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
15339 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
15340 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
15341 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
15342 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
15343 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
15344 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
15345 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
15346 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
15347 rfc5424 convention.
15348
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015349maxconn <maxconn>
15350 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
15351 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
15352 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
15353 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
15354 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
15355 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
15356 eat all memory.
15357
15358mode <mode>
15359 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
15360 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
15361 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
15362 UNIX sockets.
15363
15364mss <maxseg>
15365 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
15366 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
15367 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
15368 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
15369 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
15370 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
15371 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
15372 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
15373 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
15374 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
15375 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
15376
15377name <name>
15378 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
15379 page.
15380
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020015381namespace <name>
15382 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
15383 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
15384 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
15385 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
15386
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015387nice <nice>
15388 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
15389 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
15390 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
15391 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
15392 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
15393 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
15394 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
15395 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
15396 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
15397 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
15398 one for an RDP socket.
15399
Willy Tarreau74d7cc02023-04-19 09:10:47 +020015400no-alpn
15401 Disables ALPN processing (technically speaking this sets the ALPN string to
15402 an empty string that will not be advertised). It permits to cancel a previous
15403 occurrence of an "alpn" setting and to disable application protocol
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020015404 negotiation. It may also be used to prevent a listener from negotiating ALPN
15405 with a client on an HTTPS or QUIC listener; by default, HTTPS listeners will
15406 advertise "h2,http/1.1" and QUIC listeners will advertise "h3". See also
15407 "alpn" bove. Note that when using "crt-list", a certificate may override the
15408 "alpn" setting and re-enable its processing.
Willy Tarreau74d7cc02023-04-19 09:10:47 +020015409
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020015410no-ca-names
15411 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15412 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010015413 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020015414
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015415no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015416 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015417 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015418 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015419 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015420 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
15421 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015422
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020015423no-tls-tickets
15424 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15425 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
15426 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015427 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
15428 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015429 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15430 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15431 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020015432
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015433no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015434 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015435 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015436 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015437 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015438 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15439 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015440
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015441no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015442 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015443 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015444 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015445 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015446 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15447 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015448
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015449no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015450 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015451 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015452 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015453 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015454 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15455 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015456
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015457no-tlsv13
15458 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15459 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
15460 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
15461 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015462 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15463 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015464
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020015465npn <protocols>
15466 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
15467 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
15468 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015469 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015470 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010015471 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
15472 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
15473 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
15474 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
15475 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020015476
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015477ocsp-update [ off | on ] (crt-list only)
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015478 Enable automatic OCSP response update when set to 'on', disable it otherwise.
15479 Its value defaults to 'off'.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015480 Please note that for now, this option can only be used in a crt-list line, it
15481 cannot be used directly on a bind line. It lies in this "Bind options"
15482 section because it is still a frontend option. This limitation was set so
15483 that the option applies to only one certificate at a time.
15484 If a given certificate is used in multiple crt-lists with different values of
15485 the 'ocsp-update' set, an error will be raised. Here is an example
15486 configuration enabling it:
15487
15488 haproxy.cfg:
15489 frontend fe
15490 bind :443 ssl crt-list haproxy.list
15491
15492 haproxy.list:
15493 server_cert.pem [ocsp-update on] foo.bar
15494
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015495 When the option is set to 'on', we will try to get an ocsp response whenever
15496 an ocsp uri is found in the frontend's certificate. The only limitation of
15497 this mode is that the certificate's issuer will have to be known in order for
15498 the OCSP certid to be built.
15499 Each OCSP response will be updated at least once an hour, and even more
15500 frequently if a given OCSP response has an expire date earlier than this one
15501 hour limit. A minimum update interval of 5 minutes will still exist in order
15502 to avoid updating too often responses that have a really short expire time or
15503 even no 'Next Update' at all. Because of this hard limit, please note that
15504 when auto update is set to 'on' or 'auto', any OCSP response loaded during
15505 init will not be updated until at least 5 minutes, even if its expire time
15506 ends before now+5m. This should not be too much of a hassle since an OCSP
15507 response must be valid when it gets loaded during init (its expire time must
15508 be in the future) so it is unlikely that this response expires in such a
15509 short time after init.
15510 On the other hand, if a certificate has an OCSP uri specified and no OCSP
15511 response, setting this option to 'on' for the given certificate will ensure
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015512 that the OCSP response gets fetched automatically right after init.
15513 The default minimum and maximum delays (5 minutes and 1 hour respectively)
15514 can be configured by the "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay" and
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +010015515 "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay" global options.
15516
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015517 Whenever an OCSP response is updated by the auto update task or following a
15518 call to the "update ssl ocsp-response" CLI command, a dedicated log line is
15519 emitted. It follows a dedicated log-format that contains the following header
15520 "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft" and is followed by specific OCSP-related information:
15521 - the path of the corresponding frontend certificate
15522 - a numerical update status
15523 - a textual update status
15524 - the number of update failures for the given response
15525 - the number of update successes for the givan response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb33fe2f2023-02-28 17:46:25 +010015526 See "show ssl ocsp-updates" CLI command for a full list of error codes and
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015527 error messages. This line is emitted regardless of the success or failure of
15528 the concerned OCSP response update.
15529 The OCSP request/response is sent and received through an http_client
15530 instance that has the dontlog-normal option set and that uses the regular
15531 HTTP log format in case of error (unreachable OCSP responder for instance).
15532 If such an error occurs, another log line that contains HTTP-related
15533 information will then be emitted alongside the "regular" OCSP one (which will
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5c24f902023-06-23 17:01:08 +020015534 likely have "HTTP error" as text status). But if a purely HTTP error happens
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015535 (unreachable OCSP responder for instance), an extra log line that follows the
15536 regular HTTP log-format will be emitted.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5c24f902023-06-23 17:01:08 +020015537 Here are two examples of such log lines, with a successful OCSP update log
15538 line first and then an example of an HTTP error with the two different lines
15539 (lines were spit and the URL was shortened for readability):
15540 <134>Mar 6 11:16:53 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:16:52.808] \
15541 <OCSP-UPDATE> /path_to_cert/foo.pem 1 "Update successful" 0 1
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015542
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5c24f902023-06-23 17:01:08 +020015543 <134>Mar 6 11:18:55 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:18:54.207] \
15544 <OCSP-UPDATE> /path_to_cert/bar.pem 2 "HTTP error" 1 0
15545 <134>Mar 6 11:18:55 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:18:52.200] \
15546 <OCSP-UPDATE> -/- 2/0/-1/-1/3009 503 217 - - SC-- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0 {} \
15547 "GET http://127.0.0.1:12345/MEMwQT HTTP/1.1"
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015548
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015549 Troubleshooting:
15550 A common error that can happen with let's encrypt certificates is if the DNS
15551 resolution provides an IPv6 address and your system does not have a valid
15552 outgoing IPv6 route. In such a case, you can either create the appropriate
15553 route or set the "httpclient.resolvers.prefer ipv4" option in the global
15554 section.
15555 In case of "OCSP response check failure" error, you might want to check that
15556 the issuer certificate that you provided is valid.
15557
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000015558prefer-client-ciphers
15559 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
15560 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
15561 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020015562 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
15563 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
15564 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000015565
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015566proto <name>
15567 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
15568 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
15569 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015570 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
15571 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15572
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015573 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15574 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15575 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015576
15577 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
15578 a bind line :
15579
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015580 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015581 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15582 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15583
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015584 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015585 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080015586 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015587 h2" on the bind line.
15588
Frédéric Lécaille7e491d62023-11-13 18:11:11 +010015589quic-cc-algo { cubic | newreno }
Frédéric Lécaille43910a92022-07-11 10:24:21 +020015590 This is a QUIC specific setting to select the congestion control algorithm
15591 for any connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. They are similar
15592 to those used by TCP.
15593
15594 Default value: cubic
15595
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015596quic-force-retry
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015597 This is a QUIC specific setting which forces the use of the QUIC Retry feature
15598 for all the connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. It consists
15599 in veryfying the peers are able to receive packets at the transport address
15600 they used to initiate a new connection, sending them a Retry packet which
15601 contains a token. This token must be sent back to the Retry packet sender,
15602 this latter being the only one to be able to validate the token. Note that QUIC
15603 Retry will always be used even if a Retry threshold was set (see
Amaury Denoyelle996ca7d2022-11-14 16:17:13 +010015604 "tune.quic.retry-threshold" setting).
15605
15606 This setting requires the cluster secret to be set or else an error will be
15607 reported on startup (see "cluster-secret").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015608
15609 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
15610 information about QUIC retry.
15611
Willy Tarreaua07635e2023-04-13 17:25:43 +020015612shards <number> | by-thread | by-group
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020015613 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
15614 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
15615 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
15616 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
15617 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
15618 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
15619 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
15620 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
15621 little bit.
15622
15623 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
15624 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
15625 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
15626 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
15627 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
Willy Tarreaua07635e2023-04-13 17:25:43 +020015628 is an integral divisor of the number of threads. Alternately, the other
15629 special value "by-group" will create one shard per thread group. This can
15630 be useful when dealing with many threads and not wanting to create too many
15631 sockets. The load distribution will be a bit less optimal but the contention
15632 (especially in the system) will still be lower than with a single socket.
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020015633
Willy Tarreauc1fbdd62023-04-22 11:38:55 +020015634 On operating systems that do not support multiple sockets bound to the same
15635 address, "by-thread" and "by-group" will automatically fall back to a single
15636 shard. For "by-group" this is done without any warning since it doesn't
15637 change anything for a single group, and will result in sockets being
15638 duplicated for each group anyway. However, for "by-thread", a diagnostic
15639 warning will be emitted if this happens since the resulting number of
15640 listeners will not be the expected one.
15641
William Lallemand1d3c8222023-05-04 15:33:55 +020015642sigalgs <sigalgs>
15643 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
15644 the string describing the list of signature algorithms that are negotiated
15645 during the TLSv1.2 and TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined
15646 in "man 3 SSL_CTX_set1_sigalgs" from the OpenSSL man pages. It is not
15647 recommended to use this setting unless compatibility with a middlebox is
15648 required.
15649
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015650ssl
15651 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015652 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015653 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
15654 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020015655 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
15656 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015657
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015658ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15659 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015660 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
15661 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
15662 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015663 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15664
15665ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015666 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
15667 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
15668 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
15669 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015670
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010015671strict-sni
15672 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
15673 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
William Lallemand5c099352023-04-04 16:28:58 +020015674 a certificate. The default certificate is not used. This option also allows
15675 to start without any certificate on a bind line, so an empty directory could
15676 be used and filled later from the stats socket.
15677 See the "crt" option for more information. See "add ssl crt-list" command in
15678 the management guide.
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010015679
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015680tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015681 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015682 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015683 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015684 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015685 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
15686 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
15687 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
15688 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
15689 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
15690 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
15691 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15692
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015693tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010015694 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015695 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
15696 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
15697 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
15698 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
15699 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
15700 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
15701 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020015702 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
15703 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
15704 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015705
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015706thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>[,...]
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015707 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
15708 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
15709 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015710
15711 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
15712 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015713 It is also possible to designate a thread number using its relative number
15714 inside its thread group, by specifying the thread group number first, then a
15715 slash ('/') and the relative thread number(s). In this case thread numbers
15716 also start at 1 and end at 32 or 64 depending on the platform. When absolute
15717 thread numbers are specified, they will be automatically translated to
15718 relative numbers once thread groups are known. Usually, absolute numbers are
15719 preferred for simple configurations, and relative ones are preferred for
15720 complex configurations where CPU arrangement matters for performance.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015721
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015722 After the optional thread group number, the "thread-set" specification must
15723 use the following format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015724
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015725 "all" | "odd" | "even" | [number][-[number]]
15726
15727 As their names imply, "all" validates all threads within the set (either all
15728 of the group's when a group is specified, or all of the process' threads),
15729 "odd" validates all odd-numberred threads (every other thread starting at 1)
15730 either for the process or the group, and "even" validates all even-numberred
15731 threads (every other thread starting at 2). If instead thread number ranges
15732 are used, then all threads included in the range from the first to the last
15733 thread number are validated. The numbers are either relative to the group
Willy Tarreau7fd87562023-02-28 08:19:37 +010015734 or absolute depending on the presence of a thread group number. If the first
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015735 thread number is omitted, "1" is used, representing either the first thread
15736 of the group or the first thread of the process. If the last thread number is
15737 omitted, either the last thread number of the group (32 or 64) is used, or
15738 the last thread number of the process (global.nbthread).
15739
15740 These ranges may be repeated and delimited by a comma, so that non-contiguous
15741 thread sets can be specified, and the group, if present, must be specified
15742 again for each new range. Note that it is not permitted to mix group-relative
15743 and absolute specifications because the whole "bind" line must use either
15744 an absolute notation or a relative one, as those not set will be resolved at
15745 the end of the parsing.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015746
Willy Tarreau09b52d12023-02-27 16:42:32 +010015747 It is important to know that each listener described by a "bind" line creates
15748 at least one socket represented by at least one file descriptor. Since file
15749 descriptors cannot span multiple thread groups, if a "bind" line specifies a
15750 thread range that covers more than one group, several file descriptors will
15751 automatically be created so that there is at least one per group. Technically
15752 speaking they all refer to the same socket in the kernel, but they will get a
15753 distinct identifier in haproxy and will even have a dedicated stats entry if
15754 "option socket-stats" is used.
15755
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015756 The main purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but
15757 not the same thread in a listener, so that the system can distribute the
15758 incoming connections into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue
15759 load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau09b52d12023-02-27 16:42:32 +010015760 See also the "shards" keyword above that automates duplication of "bind"
15761 lines and their assignment to multiple groups of threads.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015762
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015763tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
15764 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010015765 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
15766 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
15767 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
15768 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
15769 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
15770 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
15771 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
15772 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
15773 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
15774 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015775 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
15776 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
15777
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015778transparent
15779 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
15780 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
15781 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
15782 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
15783 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
15784 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
15785 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
15786 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
15787 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
15788 so check for support with your vendor.
15789
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015790v4v6
15791 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15792 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
15793 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
15794 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015795 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015796
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015797v6only
15798 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15799 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
15800 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015801 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
15802 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015803
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015804uid <uid>
15805 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
15806 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15807 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
15808 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
15809 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15810
15811user <user>
15812 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
15813 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15814 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
15815 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
15816 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15817
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015818verify [none|optional|required]
15819 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
15820 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
15821 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
15822 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
15823 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020015824 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
15825 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
15826 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
15827 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020015828
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200158295.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010015830------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015831
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015832The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
15833which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
15834arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
15835settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
15836after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
15837Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
15838address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015839
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015840 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015841 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015842
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015843Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
15844keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
15845
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015846The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015847
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015848addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015849 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010015850 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15851 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
15852 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
15853 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
15854 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015855
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015856agent-check
15857 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015858 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010015859 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
15860 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
15861 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015862
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015863 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015864 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015865 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020015866 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
15867 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015868
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015869 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
15870 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
15871 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
15872 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
15873 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020015874
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015875 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015876 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015877
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015878 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15879 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
15880 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015881
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015882 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15883 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
15884 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015885
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020015886 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015887 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
15888 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
15889 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
15890 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015891 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015892 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015893
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015894 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
15895 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015896
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015897 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
15898 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
15899 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
15900 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
15901 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
15902 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
15903 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
15904 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
15905 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015906
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015907 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
15908 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015909 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
15910 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
15911 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010015912 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015913
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015914 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015915 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015916
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015917agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015918 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015919 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
15920 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
15921 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
15922 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
15923
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015924agent-inter <delay>
15925 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
15926 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15927
15928 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
15929 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
15930 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
15931 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
15932 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15933 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15934 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15935 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15936 of backends use the same servers.
15937
15938 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
15939
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015940agent-addr <addr>
15941 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
15942
15943 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015944 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015945 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
15946 hostname, it will be resolved.
15947
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015948agent-port <port>
15949 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
15950
15951 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
15952
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015953allow-0rtt
15954 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020015955 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
15956 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015957
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015958alpn <protocols>
15959 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
15960 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
15961 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015962 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015963 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
15964 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
15965 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
15966 now obsolete NPN extension.
15967 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
15968 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
15969
15970 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
15971
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015972 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
15973
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015974backup
15975 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
15976 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
15977 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
15978 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015979 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
15980 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015981
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015982ca-file <cafile>
15983 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15984 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015985 server's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
15986 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020015987 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015988
15989 In order to use the trusted CAs of your system, the "@system-ca" parameter
15990 could be used in place of the cafile. The location of this directory could be
15991 overwritten by setting the SSL_CERT_DIR environment variable.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015993check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015994 This option enables health checks on a server:
15995 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
15996 considered available.
15997 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
15998 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
15999 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
16000 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
16001 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010016002 set. This behavior is slightly different for dynamic servers, read the
16003 following paragraphs for more details.
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020016004 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
16005 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
16006 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
16007 exchanges succeed.
16008
16009 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
16010 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
16011 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
16012 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
16013 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050016014 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020016015 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
16016
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010016017 Note that the implicit configuration of ssl and PROXY protocol is not
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +020016018 performed for dynamic servers. In this case, it is required to explicitly
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010016019 use "check-ssl" and "check-send-proxy" when wanted, even if the check port is
16020 not overridden.
16021
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020016022 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
16023 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
16024
16025 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
16026 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
16027
16028 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
16029 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
16030 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
16031 available.
16032
16033 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
16034 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
16035 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
16036
16037 Example:
16038 # simple tcp check
16039 backend foo
16040 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
16041 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
16042 backend foo
16043 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
16044 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
16045 backend foo
16046 option tcp-check
16047 tcp-check connect
16048 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016049
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020016050check-send-proxy
16051 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
16052 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
16053 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
16054 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
16055 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
16056 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
16057 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
16058
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010016059check-alpn <protocols>
16060 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
16061 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
16062 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
16063
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020016064check-proto <name>
16065 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
16066 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
16067 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016068 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
16069 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
16070
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016071 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
16072 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
16073 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016074
16075 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
16076 directive on a server line:
16077
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016078 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016079 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
16080 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
16081 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
16082
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016083 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020016084 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
16085 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
16086
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010016087check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020016088 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010016089 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
16090 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020016091
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016092check-ssl
16093 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
16094 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
16095 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
16096 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016097 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016098 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
16099 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016100 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016101 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
16102 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016103
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016104check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016105 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016106 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
16107 for normal traffic.
16108
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016109ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020016110 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
16111 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
16112 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000016113 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
16114 information and recommendations see e.g.
16115 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
16116 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
16117 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016118
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020016119ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
16120 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
16121 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
William Lallemandee8a65a2024-03-11 15:48:14 +010016122 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
16123 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
16124 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
16125 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
16126 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020016127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016128cookie <value>
16129 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
16130 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
16131 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
16132 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
16133 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
16134 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
16135 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
16136
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016137crl-file <crlfile>
16138 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
16139 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
16140 to verify server's certificate.
16141
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020016142crt <cert>
16143 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
16144 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
16145 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
16146 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
16147 certificate request.
16148
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020016149 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
16150 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
16151 option is set accordingly).
16152
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020016153disabled
16154 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
16155 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
16156 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
16157 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
16158 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016159 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020016160
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016161enabled
16162 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
16163 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
16164 default value.
16165 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
16166 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020016167
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016168error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010016169 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
16170 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
16171 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016172
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016173 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016174
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016175fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016176 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
16177 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
16178 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
16179
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016180force-sslv3
16181 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
16182 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016183 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016184 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016185
16186force-tlsv10
16187 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016188 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016189 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016190
16191force-tlsv11
16192 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016193 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016194 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016195
16196force-tlsv12
16197 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016198 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016199 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016200
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020016201force-tlsv13
16202 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
16203 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016204 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020016205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016206id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020016207 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
16208 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
16209 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016210
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016211init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
16212 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
16213 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016214 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016215 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
16216 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
16217 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
16218 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
16219 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
16220 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
16221 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
16222 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
16223 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016224 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016225 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
16226 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
16227 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
16228 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
16229 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
16230 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016231 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016232
16233 Example:
16234 defaults
16235 # never fail on address resolution
16236 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
16237
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016238inter <delay>
16239fastinter <delay>
16240downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016241 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
16242 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
16243 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
16244 between checks depending on the server state :
16245
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020016246 Server state | Interval used
16247 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
16248 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
16249 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
16250 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
16251 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
16252 or yet unchecked. |
16253 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
16254 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
16255 | "inter" otherwise.
16256 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016258 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
16259 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
16260 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
16261 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090016262 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
16263 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
16264 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
16265 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
16266 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016267
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020016268log-proto <logproto>
16269 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
16270 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
16271 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
16272 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
16273
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016274maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016275 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
16276 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010016277 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
16278 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016279 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
16280 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
16281 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
16282 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
16283
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010016284 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
16285 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
16286 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
16287 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
16288 than 50 concurrent requests.
16289
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016290maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016291 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
16292 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
16293 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
16294 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020016295 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
16296 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
16297 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
16298 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
16299 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
16300 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
16301 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016302
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010016303max-reuse <count>
16304 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
16305 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
16306 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
16307 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
16308 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
16309 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
16310 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
16311 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
16312
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016313minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016314 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
16315 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
16316 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
16317 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
16318 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
16319 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016320 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016321 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016322
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020016323namespace <name>
16324 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
16325 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
16326 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
16327 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
16328
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016329no-agent-check
16330 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
16331 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16332 default value.
16333 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16334 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
16335
16336no-backup
16337 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
16338 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16339 default value.
16340 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16341 "default-server" "backup" setting.
16342
16343no-check
16344 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
16345 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16346 default value.
16347 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16348 "default-server" "check" setting.
16349
16350no-check-ssl
16351 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
16352 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16353 default value.
16354 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16355 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
16356
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016357no-send-proxy
16358 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
16359 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16360 default value.
16361 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16362 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
16363
16364no-send-proxy-v2
16365 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
16366 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16367 default value.
16368 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16369 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
16370
16371no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
16372 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
16373 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16374 default value.
16375 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16376 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
16377
16378no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
16379 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
16380 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16381 default value.
16382 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16383 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
16384
16385no-ssl
16386 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
16387 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16388 default value.
16389 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16390 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
16391
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010016392 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
16393 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
16394 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
16395
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010016396no-ssl-reuse
16397 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
16398 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
16399 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
16400 and for paranoid users.
16401
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016402no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016403 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
16404 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016405 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016406
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016407 Supported in default-server: No
16408
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020016409no-tls-tickets
16410 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
16411 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
16412 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016413 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
16414 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010016415 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
16416 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
16417 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016418 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020016419
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016420no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016421 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020016422 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16423 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016424 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16425 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016426 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016427
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016428 Supported in default-server: No
16429
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016430no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016431 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020016432 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16433 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016434 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16435 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016436 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016437
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016438 Supported in default-server: No
16439
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016440no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016441 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016442 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16443 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016444 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16445 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016446 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020016447
16448 Supported in default-server: No
16449
16450no-tlsv13
16451 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
16452 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16453 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
16454 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16455 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016456 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016457
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016458 Supported in default-server: No
16459
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016460no-verifyhost
16461 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
16462 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16463 default value.
16464 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16465 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016466
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020016467no-tfo
16468 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
16469 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16470 default value.
16471 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16472 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
16473
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090016474non-stick
16475 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
16476 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
16477 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
16478
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010016479npn <protocols>
16480 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
16481 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
16482 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016483 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010016484 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
16485 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
16486 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
16487
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016488observe <mode>
16489 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
16490 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
16491 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
16492 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
16493 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
16494 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010016495 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016496
16497 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
16498
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016499on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016500 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
16501 Currently, four modes are available:
16502 - fastinter: force fastinter
16503 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
16504 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
16505 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
16506 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
16507
16508 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
16509
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090016510on-marked-down <action>
16511 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
16512 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016513 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
16514 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
16515 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
16516 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
16517 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
16518 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
16519 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
16520 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090016521
16522 Actions are disabled by default
16523
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016524on-marked-up <action>
16525 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
16526 Currently one action is available:
16527 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
16528 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
16529 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
16530 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016531 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
16532 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016533 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
16534 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
16535
16536 Actions are disabled by default
16537
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020016538pool-low-conn <max>
16539 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
16540 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
16541 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
16542 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
16543 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
16544 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
16545 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
16546 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
16547 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
16548 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010016549 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
16550 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
16551 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
16552 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020016553
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010016554pool-max-conn <max>
16555 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
16556 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
16557 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
16558 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
16559 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
16560 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
16561
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010016562pool-purge-delay <delay>
16563 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010016564 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020016565 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010016566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016567port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016568 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010016569 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
16570 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
16571 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
16572 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
16573 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016574
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016575proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016576 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
16577 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
16578 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016579 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
16580 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
16581
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016582 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
16583 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
16584 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016585
16586 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
16587 a server line :
16588
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016589 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016590 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
16591 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
16592 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
16593
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016594 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016595 protocol for all connections established to this server.
16596
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016597 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
16598
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016599redir <prefix>
16600 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
16601 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
16602 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
16603 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
16604 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
16605 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
16606 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
16607 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016608 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016609 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016610 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
16611 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
16612 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
16613 loop between the client and HAProxy!
16614
16615 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
16616
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016617rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016618 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
16619 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
16620 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
16621
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020016622resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
16623 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
16624 server.
16625
16626 Available options:
16627
16628 * allow-dup-ip
16629 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
16630 resolution at runtime is in operation.
16631 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
16632 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
16633 For such case, simply enable this option.
16634 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
16635
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050016636 * ignore-weight
16637 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
16638 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
16639 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
16640
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020016641 * prevent-dup-ip
16642 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
16643 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
16644 same fqdn.
16645 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
16646
16647 Example:
16648 backend b_myapp
16649 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
16650 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
16651 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
16652
16653 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
16654 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
16655 it
16656 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
16657 different address
16658
16659 Default value: not set
16660
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016661resolve-prefer <family>
16662 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
16663 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
16664 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
16665 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
16666
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020016667 Default value: ipv6
16668
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016669 Example:
16670
16671 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016672
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016673resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016674 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016675 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016676 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016677 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
16678 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016679 configured network, another address is selected.
16680
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016681 Example:
16682
16683 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016684
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016685resolvers <id>
16686 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
16687 hostname.
16688
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016689 Example:
16690
16691 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016692
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016693 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016694
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016695send-proxy
16696 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
16697 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
16698 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
16699 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016700 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
16701 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
16702 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
16703 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016704 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016705 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
16706 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
16707 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
16708 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
16709 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016710 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
16711 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016712
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016713send-proxy-v2
16714 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
16715 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16716 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16717 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020016718 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
16719 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
16720 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
16721 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016722
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016723proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010016724 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
16725 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
16726
16727 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
16728 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
16729 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
16730 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
16731 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
16732 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
16733 connection is supported).
16734 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
16735 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
16736 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
16737 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
16738 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
16739 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
16740 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016741
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016742send-proxy-v2-ssl
16743 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16744 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16745 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16746 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16747 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16748 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
16749 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016750 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
16751 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016752
16753send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
16754 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16755 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16756 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16757 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16758 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16759 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
16760 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
16761 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016762 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
16763 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016764
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +020016765shard <shard>
16766 This parameter in used only in the context of stick-tables synchronisation
16767 with peers protocol. The "shard" parameter identifies the peers which will
16768 receive all the stick-table updates for keys with this shard as distribution
16769 hash. The accepted values are 0 up to "shards" parameter value specified in
16770 the "peers" section. 0 value is the default value meaning that the peer will
16771 receive all the key updates. Greater values than "shards" will be ignored.
16772 This is also the case for any value provided to the local peer.
16773
16774 Example :
16775
16776 peers mypeers
16777 shards 3
16778 peer A 127.0.0.1:40001 # local peer without shard value (0 internally)
16779 peer B 127.0.0.1:40002 shard 1
16780 peer C 127.0.0.1:40003 shard 2
16781 peer D 127.0.0.1:40004 shard 3
16782
16783
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016784slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016785 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
16786 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
16787 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
16788 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
16789 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
16790 parameters :
16791
16792 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
16793 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
16794
16795 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
16796 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
16797 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
16798 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
16799
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016800 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016801 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
16802 seen as failed.
16803
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016804sni <expression>
16805 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
16806 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
16807 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010016808 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
16809 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
16810 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
16811 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020016812 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016813 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010016814 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
16815 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016816
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016817source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020016818source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016819source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016820 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
16821 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
16822 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
16823 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
16824
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016825 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
16826 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
16827 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
16828 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
16829 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
16830 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
16831 server.
16832
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000016833 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
16834 specifying the source address without port(s).
16835
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016836ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020016837 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
16838 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
16839 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
16840 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
16841 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
16842 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016843 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
16844 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016845
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016846ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16847 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
16848 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16849 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
16850
16851ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16852 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
16853 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16854 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
16855
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016856ssl-reuse
16857 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
16858 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16859 default value.
16860 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16861 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
16862
16863stick
16864 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
16865 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16866 default value.
16867 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16868 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016869
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016870socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016871 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016872 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
16873 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
16874
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016875tcp-ut <delay>
16876 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016877 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016878 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016879 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016880 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
16881 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
16882 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
16883 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
16884 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
16885 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
16886 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
16887 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
16888 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
16889
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016890tfo
16891 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
16892 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
16893 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
16894 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016895 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020016896 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016897
Willy Tarreaue54afdc2023-11-10 16:26:32 +010016898track [<backend>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020016899 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
16900 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
16901 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
Willy Tarreaue54afdc2023-11-10 16:26:32 +010016902 enabled. If <backend> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016903 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
16904
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016905tls-tickets
16906 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
16907 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16908 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010016909 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
16910 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
16911 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016912 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010016913 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016914
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016915verify [none|required]
16916 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010016917 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016918 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
16919 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016920 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016921 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
16922 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
16923 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
16924 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
16925 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
16926 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
16927 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
16928 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016929
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016930verifyhost <hostname>
16931 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016932 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
16933 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
16934 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
16935 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
16936 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
16937 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
16938 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
16939 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016940
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016941weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016942 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
16943 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
16944 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020016945 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
16946 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
16947 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
16948 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
16949 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
16950 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016951
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016952ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
16953 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
16954 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
16955 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
16956
16957 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
16958 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
16959 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
16960 server ALPN contains it.
16961
16962 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
16963 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
16964 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
16965 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
16966
16967 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
16968 favor of the ALPN extension.
16969
16970 See also "alpn" and "proto".
16971
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016972
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200169735.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
16974-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016975
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016976HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
16977using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070016978configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016979This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
16980can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
16981workload.
16982This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
16983resolution at run time.
16984Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
16985carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
16986
16987
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200169885.3.1. Global overview
16989----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016990
16991As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
16992different steps of the process life:
16993
16994 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
16995 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
16996 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
16997
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016998 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
16999 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017000
17001A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
17002 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
17003 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
17004 resolution to know this new IP.
17005
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017006When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017007HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017008SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
17009from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017010will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017011will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020017012
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017013A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017014 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017015 first valid response.
17016
17017 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
17018 servers return an error.
17019
17020
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200170215.3.2. The resolvers section
17022----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017023
17024This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017025HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
17026contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017027
William Lallemandc33df2e2022-05-06 17:14:00 +020017028At startup, HAProxy tries to generate a resolvers section named "default", if
17029no section was named this way in the configuration. This section is used by
17030default by the httpclient and uses the parse-resolv-conf keyword. If HAProxy
17031failed to generate automatically this section, no error or warning are emitted.
17032
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017033When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
17034uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
17035is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
17036answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
17037
17038When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017039used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017040
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017041 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
17042 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
17043 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017044
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017045 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
17046 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017047
Thierry Fournier55c40ea2021-12-15 19:03:52 +010017048 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017049 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
17050 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017051
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017052For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
17053following scenarios are possible:
17054
17055 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
17056 ignored
17057
17058 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
17059 applied
17060
17061 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
17062 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
17063
17064 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
17065 retries the query with a new type
17066
17067 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
17068 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017069
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017070As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020017071a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017072<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020017073
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017074
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017075resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017076 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017077
17078A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
17079
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020017080accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017081 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017082 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020017083 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
17084 by RFC 6891)
17085
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010017086 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
17087 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
17088 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
17089 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
17090 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
17091 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020017092
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020017093nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
17094 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
17095 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
17096 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
17097 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
17098 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
17099 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
17100 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
17101 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
17102 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010017103 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
17104
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060017105parse-resolv-conf
17106 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
17107 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
17108 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
17109
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017110hold <status> <period>
Christopher Faulet24b319b2023-02-27 17:53:31 +010017111 Upon receiving the DNS response <status>, determines whether a server's state
17112 should change from UP to DOWN. To make that determination, it checks whether
17113 any valid status has been received during the past <period> in order to
17114 counteract the just received invalid status.
17115
17116 <status> : last name resolution status.
17117 nx After receiving an NXDOMAIN status, check for any valid
17118 status during the concluding period.
17119
17120 refused After receiving a REFUSED status, check for any valid
17121 status during the concluding period.
17122
17123 timeout After the "timeout retry" has struck, check for any
17124 valid status during the concluding period.
17125
17126 other After receiving any other invalid status, check for any
17127 valid status during the concluding period.
17128
17129 valid Applies only to "http-request do-resolve" and
17130 "tcp-request content do-resolve" actions. It defines the
17131 period for which the server will maintain a valid response
17132 before triggering another resolution. It does not affect
17133 dynamic resolution of servers.
17134
17135 obsolete Defines how long to wait before removing obsolete DNS
17136 records after an updated answer record is received. It
17137 applies to SRV records.
17138
17139 <period> : Amount of time into the past during which a valid response must
17140 have been received. It follows the HAProxy time format and is in
17141 milliseconds by default.
17142
17143 For a server that relies on dynamic DNS resolution to determine its IP
17144 address, receiving an invalid DNS response, such as NXDOMAIN, will lead to
17145 changing the server's state from UP to DOWN. The hold directives define how
17146 far into the past to look for a valid response. If a valid response has been
17147 received within <period>, the just received invalid status will be ignored.
17148
17149 Unless a valid response has been receiving during the concluding period, the
17150 server will be marked as DOWN. For example, if "hold nx 30s" is set and the
17151 last received DNS response was NXDOMAIN, the server will be marked DOWN
17152 unless a valid response has been received during the last 30 seconds.
17153
17154 A server in the DOWN state will be marked UP immediately upon receiving a
17155 valid status from the DNS server.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017156
Christopher Faulet24b319b2023-02-27 17:53:31 +010017157 A separate behavior exists for "hold valid" and "hold obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017158
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017159resolve_retries <nb>
17160 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
17161 giving up.
17162 Default value: 3
17163
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017164 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
17165 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
17166 type.
17167
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017168timeout <event> <time>
17169 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
17170 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
17171 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017172 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
17173 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017174 Default value: 1s
17175 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017176 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017177 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017178 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
17179 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
17180
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020017181 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017182
17183 resolvers mydns
17184 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
17185 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020017186 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060017187 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017188 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017189 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017190 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010017191 hold other 30s
17192 hold refused 30s
17193 hold nx 30s
17194 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017195 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020017196 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017197
17198
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200171996. Cache
17200---------
17201
17202HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17203(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17204RAM.
17205
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020017206The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
17207blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017208
17209If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17210independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17211when we try to allocate a new one.
17212
17213The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
17214
17215It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17216"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17217for more details.
17218
17219When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17220replaced by "<CACHE>".
17221
17222
172236.1. Limitation
17224----------------
17225
17226The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17227
17228- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010017229- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
17230 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
17231 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017232- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
17233- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010017234- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
17235 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
17236 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010017237- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
17238 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010017239- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
17240 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
17241 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017242
17243- If the request is not a GET
17244- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
17245- If the request contains an Authorization header
17246
17247
172486.2. Setup
17249-----------
17250
17251To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17252the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17253
17254
172556.2.1. Cache section
17256---------------------
17257
17258cache <name>
17259 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17260 size of cache is mandatory.
17261
17262total-max-size <megabytes>
17263 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
17264 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
17265
17266max-object-size <bytes>
17267 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
17268 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
17269 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
17270
17271max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010017272 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017273 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17274 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17275 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17276 default.
17277
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010017278process-vary <on/off>
17279 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010017280 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
17281 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
17282 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010017283 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010017284
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010017285max-secondary-entries <number>
17286 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
17287 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
17288 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
17289
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017290
172916.2.2. Proxy section
17292---------------------
17293
17294http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
17295 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17296 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17297 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17298 after this one.
17299
17300http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
17301 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17302 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17303 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17304 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17305
17306
17307Example:
17308
17309 backend bck1
17310 mode http
17311
17312 http-request cache-use foobar
17313 http-response cache-store foobar
17314 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17315
17316 cache foobar
17317 total-max-size 4
17318 max-age 240
17319
17320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200173217. Using ACLs and fetching samples
17322----------------------------------
17323
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017324HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017325client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
17326The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
17327these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
17328but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
17329data called patterns.
17330
17331
173327.1. ACL basics
17333---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017334
17335The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
17336content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
17337from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
17338simple :
17339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017340 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017341 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017342 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
17343 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017345The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
17346adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017347
17348In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
17349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017350 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017351
17352This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
17353Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
17354and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017355an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
17356conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
17357as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
17358are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017359
17360ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
17361'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
17362which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
17363
17364There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
17365performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
17366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017367The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
17368specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
17369this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017370methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
17371ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017372
17373Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
17374 - boolean
17375 - integer (signed or unsigned)
17376 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
17377 - string
17378 - data block
17379
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017380Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
17381converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
17382would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
17383The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
17384which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
17385
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017386Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
17387keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
17388fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
17389which are summarized in the table below :
17390
17391 +---------------------+-----------------+
17392 | Sample or converter | Default |
17393 | output type | matching method |
17394 +---------------------+-----------------+
17395 | boolean | bool |
17396 +---------------------+-----------------+
17397 | integer | int |
17398 +---------------------+-----------------+
17399 | ip | ip |
17400 +---------------------+-----------------+
17401 | string | str |
17402 +---------------------+-----------------+
17403 | binary | none, use "-m" |
17404 +---------------------+-----------------+
17405
17406Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
17407matching method, see below.
17408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017409The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
17410 - boolean
17411 - integer or integer range
17412 - IP address / network
17413 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
17414 - regular expression
17415 - hex block
17416
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017417The following ACL flags are currently supported :
17418
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017419 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
17420 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017421 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010017422 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010017423 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010017424 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017425 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
17426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017427The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
17428read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
17429if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
17430lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
17431will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
17432beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017433a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017434lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
17435exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
17436
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010017437The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
17438parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
17439ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
17440a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
17441check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
17442
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010017443The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
17444socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
17445file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
17446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017447Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
17448loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
17449
17450 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
17451
17452In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
17453the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
17454case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
17455as well.
17456
17457The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
17458sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
17459do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
17460methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
17461is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017462obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017463followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
17464default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
17465that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
17466string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
17467
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010017468The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
17469By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
17470string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
17471resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017472server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017473waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010017474flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
17475function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
17476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017477There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
17478sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
17479be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017480
17481 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
17482 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017483 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
17484 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
17485 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
17486 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017487
17488 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
17489 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017490 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017491
17492 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017493 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017494
17495 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017496 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017497
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017498 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017499 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
17500
17501 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
17502 binary or string samples.
17503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017504 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
17505 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017507 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
17508 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
17509 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017511 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
17512 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017514 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
17515 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017517 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
17518 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017520 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
17521 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017522 This may be used with binary or string samples.
17523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017524 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
17525 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
17526 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017527
17528For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
17529request, it is possible to do :
17530
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017531 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017532
17533In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
17534buffer, one would use the following acl :
17535
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017536 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017537
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017538On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
17539possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
17540
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017541 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017543All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
17544criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
17545method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreau4f4fea42022-11-25 10:49:41 +010017546to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
17547usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
17548converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
17549method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
17550matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017551criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
17552the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017554If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017555the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
17556For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017558 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
17559 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
17560 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
17561 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017562
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017563
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017564The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
17565types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
17566combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
17567brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
17568default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017570 +-------------------------------------------------+
17571 | Input sample type |
17572 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017573 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017574 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
17575 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
17576 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017577 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017578 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017579 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017580 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017581 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017582 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017583 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017584 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017585 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017586 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017587 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017588 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017589 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017590 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017591 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017592 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017593 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017594 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017595 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017596 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017597 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017598 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
17599 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
17600 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017601
17602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200176037.1.1. Matching booleans
17604------------------------
17605
17606In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
17607Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
17608When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
17609that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
17610
17611Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
17612return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
17613"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
17614
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200176167.1.2. Matching integers
17617------------------------
17618
17619Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
17620enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
17621to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
17622
17623Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
17624matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
17625lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017626
17627For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
17628unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
17629representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
17630
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017631As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
17632two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
17633instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
17634ranges and operators.
17635
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017636For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017637operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
17638Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
17639of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017640
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017641Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017642
17643 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
17644 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
17645 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
17646 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
17647 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
17648
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017649For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017650
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017651 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017652
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017653This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
17654
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017655 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017656
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200176587.1.3. Matching strings
17659-----------------------
17660
17661String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
17662different forms :
17663
17664 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017665 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017666
17667 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017668 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017669
17670 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
17671 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
17672
17673 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
17674 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
17675
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010017676 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
17677 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
17678 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
17679 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
17680 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
17681 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017682
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010017683 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
17684 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
17685 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
17686 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
17687 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
17688 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
17689 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
17690 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
17691 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
17692 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
17693 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017694
17695String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
17696exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
17697characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
17698string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
17699to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017700before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017701
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010017702Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
17703(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
17704Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
17705
17706Example:
17707 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
17708 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
17709
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200177117.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
17712---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017713
17714Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
17715they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
17716possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
17717passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
17718the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017719the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
17720match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017721
17722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200177237.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
17724-------------------------------------
17725
17726It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
17727not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
17728a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
17729to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
17730digits may be used upper or lower case.
17731
17732Example :
17733 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017734 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017735
17736
177377.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
17738---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017739
17740IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
17741netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
17742within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010017743host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017744difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
17745at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
17746does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
17747parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017748
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020017749The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
17750abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
17751
17752 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17753 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
17754 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17755 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
17756 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
17757 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
17758 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
17759 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17760
17761Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
17762192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
17763
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020017764IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
17765Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
17766trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
17767IPv6 patterns.
17768
17769HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
17770following situations :
17771 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
17772 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
17773 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
17774 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
17775 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
17776 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
17777 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
17778 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
17779 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
17780 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
17781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017782
177837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
17784----------------------------------
17785
17786Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
17787combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
17788
17789 - AND (implicit)
17790 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
17791 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017793A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017795 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017797Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
17798indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017800For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
17801"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
17802requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
17803is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
17804
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017805 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017806 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
17807 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
17808 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017809
17810To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
17811and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
17812
17813 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
17814 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
17815 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
17816 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
17817
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017818 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017819 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
17820 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
17821 use_backend www if host_www
17822
17823It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
17824expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
17825be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
17826the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
17827
17828 The following rule :
17829
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017830 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017831 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017832
17833 Can also be written that way :
17834
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017835 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017836
17837It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
17838to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
17839simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
17840sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
17841good use is the following :
17842
17843 With named ACLs :
17844
17845 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
17846 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
17847 monitor fail if site_dead
17848
17849 With anonymous ACLs :
17850
17851 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
17852
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017853See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
17854keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017855
17856
178577.3. Fetching samples
17858---------------------
17859
17860Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
17861against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
17862sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
17863ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
17864of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
17865available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
17866
17867This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
17868Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
17869compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
17870deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
17871
17872The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
17873matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
17874method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
17875indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
17876
17877As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
17878when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
17879mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
17880the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
17881ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
17882
17883Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
17884multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
17885when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017886incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
17887are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017888is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
17889all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
17890
17891Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
17892 - name
17893 - name(arg1)
17894 - name(arg1,arg2)
17895
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017896
178977.3.1. Converters
17898-----------------
17899
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017900Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
17901of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
17902is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
17903was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017904has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017905unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
17906
17907These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
17908sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
17909the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017910support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017911
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017912A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
17913support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
17914supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
17915(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
17916bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
17917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017918The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017919
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001792051d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
17921 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17922 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17923 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
17924 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17925 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17926
17927 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017928 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
17929 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000017930 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
17931 frontend http-in
17932 bind *:8081
17933 default_backend servers
17934 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17935 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17936
Aurelien DARRAGON5c6f86f2022-12-30 16:23:08 +010017937rfc7239_is_valid
17938 Returns true if input header is RFC 7239 compliant header value and false
17939 otherwise.
17940
17941 Example:
17942 acl valid req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_is_valid
17943 #input: "for=127.0.0.1;proto=http"
17944 # output: TRUE
17945 #input: "proto=custom"
17946 # output: FALSE
17947
Aurelien DARRAGON6fb58b82022-12-30 16:37:03 +010017948rfc7239_field(<field>)
17949 Extracts a single field/parameter from RFC 7239 compliant header value input.
17950
17951 Supported fields are:
17952 - proto: either 'http' or 'https'
17953 - host: http compliant host
17954 - for: RFC7239 node
17955 - by: RFC7239 node
17956
17957 More info here:
17958 https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html#section-6
17959
17960 Example:
17961 # extract host field from forwarded header and store it in req.fhost var
17962 http-request set-var(req.fhost) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(host)
17963 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\""
17964 # output: "haproxy.org:80"
17965
17966 # extract for field from forwarded header and store it in req.ffor var
17967 http-request set-var(req.ffor) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for)
17968 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\";for=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
17969 # output: "127.0.0.1:9999"
17970
Aurelien DARRAGON07d67532022-12-30 16:45:42 +010017971rfc7239_n2nn
17972 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17973 into its corresponding nodename final form:
17974 - ipv4 address
17975 - ipv6 address
17976 - 'unknown'
17977 - '_obfs' identifier
17978
17979 Example:
17980 # extract 'for' field from forwarded header, extract nodename from
17981 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnn
17982 http-request set-var(req.fnn) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for),rfc7239_n2nn
Aurelien DARRAGONac456ab2023-05-30 09:47:53 +020017983 #input: "127.0.0.1:9999"
17984 # output: 127.0.0.1 (ipv4)
17985 #input: "[ab:cd:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff]:9998"
17986 # output: ab:cd:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff (ipv6)
17987 #input: "_name:_port"
17988 # output: "_name" (string)
Aurelien DARRAGON07d67532022-12-30 16:45:42 +010017989
Aurelien DARRAGON9a273b42022-12-30 16:56:08 +010017990rfc7239_n2np
17991 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17992 into its corresponding nodeport final form:
17993 - unsigned integer
17994 - '_obfs' identifier
17995
17996 Example:
17997 # extract 'by' field from forwarded header, extract node port from
17998 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnp
17999 http-request set-var(req.fnp) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(by),rfc7239_n2np
Aurelien DARRAGON06d8aad2023-06-02 15:29:17 +020018000 #input: "127.0.0.1:9999"
Aurelien DARRAGONac456ab2023-05-30 09:47:53 +020018001 # output: 9999 (integer)
18002 #input: "[ab:cd:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff]:9998"
18003 # output: 9998 (integer)
18004 #input: "_name:_port"
18005 # output: "_port" (string)
Aurelien DARRAGON9a273b42022-12-30 16:56:08 +010018006
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018007add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018008 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018009 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018010 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
18011 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018012 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018013 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18014 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18015 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18016 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018017 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018018 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018019
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020018020add_item(<delim>,[<var>][,<suff>]])
18021 Concatenates a minimum of 2 and up to 3 fields after the current sample which
18022 is then turned into a string. The first one, <delim>, is a constant string,
18023 that will be appended immediately after the existing sample if an existing
18024 sample is not empty and either the <var> or the <suff> is not empty. The
18025 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
18026 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after
18027 the <delim> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It is
18028 optional and may optionally be followed by a constant string <suff>, however
18029 if <var> is omitted, then <suff> is mandatory. This converter is similar to
18030 the concat converter and can be used to build new variables made of a
18031 succession of other variables but the main difference is that it does the
18032 checks if adding a delimiter makes sense as wouldn't be the case if e.g. the
18033 current sample is empty. That situation would require 2 separate rules using
18034 concat converter where the first rule would have to check if the current
18035 sample string is empty before adding a delimiter. If commas or closing
18036 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
18037 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreaub143d112022-11-25 09:27:15 +010018038 level parser (please see section 2.2 for quoting and escaping). See examples
18039 below.
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020018040
18041 Example:
18042 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1,"(site1)") if src,in_table(site1)'
18043 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score2,"(site2)") if src,in_table(site2)'
18044 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score3,"(site3)") if src,in_table(site3)'
18045 http-request set-header x-tagged %[var(req.tagged)]
18046
18047 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1),add_item(",",req.score2)'
18048 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",,(site1))' if src,in_table(site1)
18049
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010018050aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
18051 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
18052 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
18053 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
18054 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
18055 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
18056 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
18057
18058 Example:
18059 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
18060 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
18061
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018062and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018063 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018064 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018065 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
18066 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018067 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018068 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18069 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18070 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18071 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018072 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018073 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018074
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020018075b64dec
18076 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
18077 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020018078 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
18079 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020018080
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020018081base64
18082 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018083 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020018084 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
18085 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020018086
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020018087be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
18088 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
18089 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
18090 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
18091 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
18092 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
18093
18094 Example:
18095 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
18096 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
18097 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
18098 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
18099
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020018100be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
18101 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
18102 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
18103 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
18104 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
18105 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
18106 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
18107
18108 Example:
18109 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
18110 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
18111 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
18112 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
18113
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018114bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018115 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018116 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018117 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018118 presence of a flag).
18119
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010018120bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
18121 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
18122 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018123 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010018124
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010018125concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
18126 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
18127 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
18128 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
18129 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
18130 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
18131 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
18132 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
18133 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
18134 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
18135 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018136 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040018137 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018138 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020018139 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
18140 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
18141 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010018142
18143 Example:
18144 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
18145 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
18146 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018147 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020018148 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010018149 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
18150
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018151cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018152 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
18153 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018154
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010018155crc32([<avalanche>])
18156 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
18157 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18158 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18159 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18160 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18161 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
18162 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
18163 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
18164 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
18165 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018166 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
18167
18168crc32c([<avalanche>])
18169 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
18170 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18171 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18172 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
18173 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
18174 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
18175 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
18176 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010018177
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020018178cut_crlf
18179 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
18180 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
18181 updated.
18182
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010018183da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020018184 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
18185 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
18186 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
18187 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018188 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020018189 configuration language.
18190
18191 Example:
18192 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018193 bind *:8881
18194 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000018195 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020018196
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010018197debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
18198 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
18199 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
18200 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
18201 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
18202 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
18203 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
18204 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
18205 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
18206 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
18207 printable sample types.
18208
18209 Example:
18210 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020018211
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018212digest(<algorithm>)
18213 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
18214 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
18215
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018216 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018217 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18218
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018219div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018220 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
18221 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018222 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018223 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
18224 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018225 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018226 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18227 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18228 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18229 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018230 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018231 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018232
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018233djb2([<avalanche>])
18234 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
18235 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18236 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18237 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18238 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18239 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18240 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018241 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
18242 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018243
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018244even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018245 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018246 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
18247
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018248field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
18249 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
18250 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
18251 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
18252 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
18253 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
18254 fields.
18255
18256 Example :
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010018257 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(4,_) # <empty>
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018258 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
18259 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
18260 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
18261 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
18262 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010018263
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018264fix_is_valid
18265 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
18266 Information eXchange):
18267
18268 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
18269 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018270 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018271 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010018272 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018273 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
18274 checksum
18275
18276 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18277 the server can be parsed.
18278
18279 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
18280 message, false if not.
18281
18282 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
18283
18284 Example:
18285 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18286 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
18287
18288fix_tag_value(<tag>)
18289 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
18290 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
18291 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
18292 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050018293 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018294 added.
18295
18296 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18297 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
18298 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
18299 fix_is_valid converter.
18300
18301 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
18302
18303 Example:
18304 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18305 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
18306 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
18307 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
18308 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
18309
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018310hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018311 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018312 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018313 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018314 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010018315
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020018316hex2i
18317 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018318 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020018319
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020018320htonl
18321 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
18322 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
18323 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
18324 unsigned 32-bit integer.
18325
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010018326hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018327 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
18328 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
18329 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
18330 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
18331
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018332 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018333 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18334
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020018335host_only
18336 Converts a string which contains a Host header value and removes its port.
18337 The input must respect the format of the host header value
18338 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
18339 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
18340
18341 This converter also sets the string in lowercase.
18342
18343 See also: "port_only" converter which will return the port.
18344
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010018345http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018346 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18347 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018348 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
18349 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
18350 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
18351 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
18352 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
18353 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
18354 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
18355 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018356
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020018357iif(<true>,<false>)
18358 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
18359 string otherwise.
18360
18361 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020018362 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020018363
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018364in_table(<table>)
18365 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18366 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
18367 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018368 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018369 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
18370
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010018371ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010018372 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018373 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010018374 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
18375 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
18376 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
18377 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
18378 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018379
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018380json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018381 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018382 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020018383 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018384 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
18385 of errors:
18386 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
18387 bytes, ...)
18388 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
18389 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
18390
18391 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
18392 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
18393 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
18394 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
18395 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
18396 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018397 - "ascii" : never fails;
18398 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
18399 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018400 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018401 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018402 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
18403 characters corresponding to the other errors.
18404
18405 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018406 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018407
18408 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018409 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020018410 capture request header user-agent len 150
18411 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018412
18413 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
18414 GET / HTTP/1.0
18415 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
18416
18417 Output log:
18418 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
18419
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020018420json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
18421 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
18422 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
18423 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
18424 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
18425
18426 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
18427 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
18428
18429 Example:
18430 # get a integer value from the request body
18431 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
18432 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
18433
18434 # get a key with '.' in the name
18435 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
18436 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
18437
18438 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
18439 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
18440
18441 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
18442 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
18443
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020018444jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
18445 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
18446 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
18447 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
18448 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
18449 json_path and output_type parameters.
18450
18451 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
18452 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18453
18454jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
18455 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
18456 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
18457 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
18458 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
18459 json_path and output_type parameters.
18460
18461 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
18462 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18463
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018464jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
18465 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
18466 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018467 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018468 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
18469 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
18470 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
18471 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018472
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018473 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
Remi Tricot-Le Breton447a38f2023-03-07 17:43:57 +010018474 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). All the
Remi Tricot-Le Bretoncca939e2023-08-10 16:11:27 +020018475 algorithms mentioned in section 3.1 of RFC7518 are managed (HS, ES, RS and PS
18476 with the 256, 384 or 512 key sizes, as well as the special "none" case).
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018477
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018478 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
18479 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
18480 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
18481 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
18482 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
18483 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050018484 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018485 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
18486
18487 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
18488 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
18489 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
18490 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
18491 contents.
18492
18493 The possible return values are the following :
18494
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018495 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
18496 | ID | message |
18497 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018498 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050018499 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018500 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton447a38f2023-03-07 17:43:57 +010018501 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018502 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
18503 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
18504 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018505 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018506
18507 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
18508 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18509
18510 Example:
18511 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
18512 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
18513 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
18514 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
Aurelien DARRAGON4761b0d2023-05-26 14:29:58 +020018515 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) -m str "RS256" }
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018516 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
18517
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018518language(<value>[,<default>])
18519 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
18520 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
18521 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
18522 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
18523 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
18524 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
18525 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
18526 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
18527 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018528 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018529 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
18530 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018531
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018532 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018533
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018534 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
18535 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018536
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018537 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
18538 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
18539 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
18540 use_backend spanish if es
18541 use_backend french if fr
18542 use_backend english if en
18543 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018544
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010018545length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010018546 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
18547 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18548 type. The result is of type integer.
18549
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018550lower
18551 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
18552 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18553 type. The result is of type string.
18554
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018555ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
18556 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18557 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
18558 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
18559 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
18560 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
18561 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
18562
18563 Example :
18564
18565 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018566 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018567 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
18568
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020018569ltrim(<chars>)
18570 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
18571 representation of the input sample.
18572
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018573map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18574map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18575map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18576 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
18577 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
18578 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
18579 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
18580 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
18581 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
18582 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
18583 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018584
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018585 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
18586 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
18587 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018588
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018589 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018590 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018591
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018592 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
18593 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18594 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
18595 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020018596 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
18597 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018598 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
18599 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18600 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
18601 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18602 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
18603 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18604 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
18605 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080018606 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
18607 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18608 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018609 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18610 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
18611 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18612 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
18613 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018614
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010018615 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
18616 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
18617 the corresponding match text.
18618
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018619 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
18620 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
18621 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
18622 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
18623 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018624
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018625 Example :
18626
18627 # this is a comment and is ignored
18628 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
18629 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
18630 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
18631 | | | `---------- value
18632 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
18633 | `---------------------------- key
18634 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
18635
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018636mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018637 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
18638 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018639 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018640 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018641 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018642 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18643 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18644 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18645 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018646 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018647 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018648
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018649mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018650 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
18651 <packettype>.
18652 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
18653 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
18654 from.
18655 Supported string and integers can be found here:
18656 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
18657 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
18658
18659 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
18660 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
18661 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
18662 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
18663
18664 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
18665 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
18666 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
18667 packets only):
18668 17: Session Expiry Interval
18669 33: Receive Maximum
18670 39: Maximum Packet Size
18671 34: Topic Alias Maximum
18672 25: Request Response Information
18673 23: Request Problem Information
18674 21: Authentication Method
18675 22: Authentication Data
18676 18: Will Delay Interval
18677 1: Payload Format Indicator
18678 2: Message Expiry Interval
18679 3: Content Type
18680 8: Response Topic
18681 9: Correlation Data
18682 Not supported yet:
18683 38: User Property
18684
18685 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
18686 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
18687 packets only):
18688 17: Session Expiry Interval
18689 33: Receive Maximum
18690 36: Maximum QoS
18691 37: Retain Available
18692 39: Maximum Packet Size
18693 18: Assigned Client Identifier
18694 34: Topic Alias Maximum
18695 31: Reason String
18696 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
18697 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
18698 42: Shared Subscription Available
18699 19: Server Keep Alive
18700 26: Response Information
18701 28: Server Reference
18702 21: Authentication Method
18703 22: Authentication Data
18704 Not supported yet:
18705 38: User Property
18706
18707 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18708 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18709 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18710 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18711
18712 Example:
18713
18714 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
18715 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18716 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
18717 if data_in_buffer
18718 # do the same as above
18719 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18720 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
18721 if data_in_buffer
18722
18723mqtt_is_valid
18724 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
18725
18726 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18727 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18728 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18729 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18730
Christopher Faulet140a3572022-03-22 09:41:11 +010018731 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
18732
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018733 Example:
18734
18735 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040018736 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018737
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018738mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018739 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020018740 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
18741 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018742 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018743 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018744 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018745 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18746 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18747 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18748 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018749 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018750 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018751
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010018752nbsrv
18753 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
18754 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
18755 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
18756 map lookup.
18757
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018758neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018759 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
18760 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
18761 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
18762 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018763
18764not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018765 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018766 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018767 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018768 absence of a flag).
18769
18770odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018771 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018772 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
18773
18774or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018775 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018776 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018777 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
18778 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018779 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018780 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18781 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18782 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18783 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018784 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018785 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018786
Thayne McCombs02cf4ec2022-12-14 00:19:59 -070018787param(<name>,[<delim>])
18788 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the input string
18789 where parameters are delimited by <delim>, which defaults to "&", and the name
18790 and value of the parameter are separated by a "=". If there is no "=" and
18791 value before the end of the parameter segment, it is treated as equivalent to
18792 a value of an empty string.
18793
18794 This can be useful for extracting parameters from a query string, or possibly
18795 a x-www-form-urlencoded body. In particular, `query,param(<name>)` can be used
18796 as an alternative to `urlp(<name>)` which only uses "&" as a delimiter,
18797 whereas "urlp" also uses "?" and ";".
18798
18799 Note that this converter doesn't do anything special with url encoded
18800 characters. If you want to decode the value, you can use the url_dec converter
18801 on the output. If the name of the parameter in the input might contain encoded
18802 characters, you'll probably want do normalize the input before calling
18803 "param". This can be done using "http-request normalize-uri", in particular
18804 the percent-decode-unreserved and percent-to-uppercase options.
18805
18806 Example :
18807 str(a=b&c=d&a=r),param(a) # b
18808 str(a&b=c),param(a) # ""
18809 str(a=&b&c=a),param(b) # ""
18810 str(a=1;b=2;c=4),param(b,;) # 2
18811 query,param(redirect_uri),urldec()
18812
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020018813port_only
18814 Converts a string which contains a Host header value into an integer by
18815 returning its port.
18816 The input must respect the format of the host header value
18817 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
18818 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
18819
18820 If no port were provided in the input, it will return 0.
18821
18822 See also: "host_only" converter which will return the host.
18823
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018824protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
18825 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
18826 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
18827 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
18828 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
18829 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
18830 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
18831 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
18832 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
18833 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
18834 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
18835 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
18836
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010018837regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018838 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
18839 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
18840 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
18841 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
18842 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
18843 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
18844 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
18845 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
18846 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018847 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
18848 of characters with other ones.
18849
18850 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
18851 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
18852 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
18853 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
18854 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
18855 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018856
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018857 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018858
18859 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
18860 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
18861 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018862 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018863
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018864 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
18865 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
18866
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018867 # capture groups and backreferences
18868 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020018869 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018870 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
18871
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018872capture-req(<id>)
18873 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
18874 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18875
18876 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018877 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18878 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018879
18880capture-res(<id>)
18881 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
18882 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18883
18884 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018885 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18886 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018887
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020018888rtrim(<chars>)
18889 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
18890 of the input sample.
18891
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018892sdbm([<avalanche>])
18893 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
18894 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18895 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18896 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18897 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18898 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18899 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018900 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
18901 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018902
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018903secure_memcmp(<var>)
18904 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
18905 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
18906 match.
18907
18908 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
18909 performed in constant time.
18910
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018911 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018912 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18913
18914 Example :
18915
18916 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
18917 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
18918 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
18919 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
18920
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010018921set-var(<var>[,<cond>...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018922 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018923 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
18924 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
18925 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
18926 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018927 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018928 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18929 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018930 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018931 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18932 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018933 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018934 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018935
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018936 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
18937 possible conditions :
18938 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
18939 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
18940 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
18941 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
18942 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
18943 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
18944 Checks if the input is empty or not.
18945 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
18946 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
18947 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
18948 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
18949 called on the variable.
18950 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
18951 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
18952 configuration parsing.
18953 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
18954 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
18955 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
18956 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
18957 true by default.
18958
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018959sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018960 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018961 sample with length of 20 bytes.
18962
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018963sha2([<bits>])
18964 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
18965 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
18966
18967 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
18968 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
18969
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018970 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018971 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18972
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020018973srv_queue
18974 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
18975 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
18976 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
18977 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
18978 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
18979
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018980strcmp(<var>)
18981 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
18982 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
18983 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
18984 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
18985 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
18986 shorter).
18987
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018988 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
18989 strings in constant time.
18990
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018991 Example :
18992
18993 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
18994 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
18995 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
18996
18997
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018998sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018999 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
19000 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019001 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019002 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
19003 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019004 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019005 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19006 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019007 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019008 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19009 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019010 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019011 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010019012
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019013table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
19014 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19015 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19016 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
19017 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
19018 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
19019 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
19020
19021
19022table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
19023 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19024 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19025 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
19026 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
19027 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
19028 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
19029
19030table_conn_cnt(<table>)
19031 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19032 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019033 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019034 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
19035 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19036
19037table_conn_cur(<table>)
19038 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19039 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19040 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
19041 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
19042 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
19043
19044table_conn_rate(<table>)
19045 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19046 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19047 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
19048 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
19049 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
19050
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020019051table_expire(<table>[,<default_value>])
19052 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
19053 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
19054 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
19055 is found the converter returns the key expiration delay associated with the
19056 input sample in the designated table.
19057 See also the table_idle sample fetch keyword.
19058
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020019059table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
19060 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
19061 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
19062 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
19063 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
19064 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19065 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
19066 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
19067 data-type).
19068 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
19069
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020019070table_gpt0(<table>)
19071 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19072 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
19073 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
19074 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
19075 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
19076
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019077table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
19078 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
19079 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19080 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
19081 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
19082 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
19083 between 0 and 99.
19084 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
19085 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19086 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19087 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
19088
19089table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
19090 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
19091 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19092 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
19093 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
19094 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
19095 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19096 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
19097 value 0.
19098 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
19099 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
19100 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
19101
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019102table_gpc0(<table>)
19103 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19104 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19105 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
19106 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
19107 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
19108
19109table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
19110 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19111 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19112 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
19113 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
19114 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
19115 sample fetch keyword.
19116
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019117table_gpc1(<table>)
19118 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19119 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19120 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
19121 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
19122 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
19123
19124table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
19125 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19126 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19127 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
19128 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
19129 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
19130 sample fetch keyword.
19131
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019132table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
19133 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19134 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019135 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019136 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
19137 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19138
19139table_http_err_rate(<table>)
19140 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19141 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19142 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
19143 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
19144 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
19145 keyword.
19146
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019147table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
19148 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19149 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19150 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
19151 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
19152 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19153
19154table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
19155 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19156 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19157 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
19158 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
19159 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
19160 keyword.
19161
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019162table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
19163 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19164 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019165 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019166 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
19167 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19168
19169table_http_req_rate(<table>)
19170 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19171 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19172 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
19173 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
19174 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
19175 keyword.
19176
Aurelien DARRAGONfd766dd2022-11-23 14:35:06 +010019177table_idle(<table>[,<default_value>])
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020019178 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
19179 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
19180 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
19181 is found the converter returns the time the key entry associated with the
19182 input sample in the designated table remained idle since the last time it was
19183 updated.
19184 See also the table_expire sample fetch keyword.
19185
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019186table_kbytes_in(<table>)
19187 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19188 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019189 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019190 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
19191 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
19192 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
19193 keyword.
19194
19195table_kbytes_out(<table>)
19196 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19197 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019198 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019199 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
19200 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
19201 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
19202 keyword.
19203
19204table_server_id(<table>)
19205 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19206 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19207 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
19208 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
19209 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
19210 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
19211
19212table_sess_cnt(<table>)
19213 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19214 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019215 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019216 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
19217 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
19218 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
19219 keyword.
19220
19221table_sess_rate(<table>)
19222 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19223 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19224 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
19225 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
19226 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
19227 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
19228 keyword.
19229
19230table_trackers(<table>)
19231 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19232 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19233 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
19234 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
19235 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
19236 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
19237 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
19238 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
19239 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
19240 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
19241
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020019242ub64dec
19243 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
19244 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
19245 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
19246
19247 Example:
19248 # Decoding a JWT payload:
19249 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
19250
19251ub64enc
19252 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
19253
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020019254upper
19255 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
19256 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
19257 type. The result is of type string.
19258
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020019259url_dec([<in_form>])
19260 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
19261 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
19262 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
19263 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
19264 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
19265 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020019266
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010019267url_enc([<enc_type>])
19268 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
19269 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
19270 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
19271 optional argument is here for future changes.
19272
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019273ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019274 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010019275 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
19276 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
19277 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019278 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
19279 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
19280 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
19281 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010019282 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019283 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
19284 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019285
19286 Example:
19287 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
19288 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
19289
19290 message Point {
19291 int32 latitude = 1;
19292 int32 longitude = 2;
19293 }
19294
19295 message PPoint {
19296 Point point = 59;
19297 }
19298
19299 message Rectangle {
19300 // One corner of the rectangle.
19301 PPoint lo = 48;
19302 // The other corner of the rectangle.
19303 PPoint hi = 49;
19304 }
19305
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019306 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
19307 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
19308 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019309
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019310 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
19311 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019312 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019313 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
19314
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019315 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019316
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010019317 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019318
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019319 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
19320 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
19321 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010019322
19323 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
19324 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
19325 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
19326
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019327 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
19328 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
19329 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010019330
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019331
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010019332unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010019333 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
19334 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
19335 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
19336 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19337 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
19338 response),
19339 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19340 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
19341 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
19342 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
19343
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020019344utime(<format>[,<offset>])
19345 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
19346 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
19347 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
19348 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
19349 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
19350 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
19351
19352 Example :
19353
19354 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019355 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020019356 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
19357
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020019358word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
19359 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
19360 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
19361 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010019362 Empty words are skipped. This means that delimiters at the start or end of
19363 the input string are ignored and consecutive delimiters within the input
19364 string are considered to be a single delimiter.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020019365 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
19366 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
19367
19368 Example :
19369 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010019370 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(5,_) # <not found>
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020019371 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
19372 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
19373 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
19374 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010019375 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010019376 str(/f1////f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010019377
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019378wt6([<avalanche>])
19379 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
19380 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
19381 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
19382 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
19383 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
19384 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
19385 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010019386 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
19387 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019388
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010019389xor(<value>)
19390 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020019391 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019392 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019393 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019394 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019395 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19396 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019397 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019398 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19399 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019400 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019401 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010019402
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010019403xxh3([<seed>])
19404 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
19405 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
19406 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
19407 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
19408 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
19409 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
19410 considered as cryptographically secure.
19411
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010019412xxh32([<seed>])
19413 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
19414 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
19415 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
19416 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
19417 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
19418 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
19419 as cryptographically secure.
19420
19421xxh64([<seed>])
19422 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
19423 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
19424 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
19425 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
19426 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
19427 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
19428 as cryptographically secure.
19429
William Lallemand9fbc84e2022-11-03 18:56:37 +010019430x509_v_err_str
19431 Convert a numerical value to its corresponding X509_V_ERR constant name. It
19432 is useful in ACL in order to have a configuration which works with multiple
19433 version of OpenSSL since some codes might change when changing version.
19434
William Lallemand117c7fd2023-05-03 15:13:10 +020019435 When the corresponding constant name was not found, outputs the numerical
19436 value as a string.
19437
William Lallemand9fbc84e2022-11-03 18:56:37 +010019438 The list of constant provided by OpenSSL can be found at
19439 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
19440 Be careful to read the page for the right version of OpenSSL.
19441
19442 Example:
19443
19444 bind :443 ssl crt common.pem ca-file ca-auth.crt verify optional crt-ignore-err X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED,X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
19445
19446 acl cert_expired ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
19447 acl cert_revoked ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED
19448 acl cert_ok ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_OK
19449
19450 http-response add-header X-SSL Ok if cert_ok
19451 http-response add-header X-SSL Expired if cert_expired
19452 http-response add-header X-SSL Revoked if cert_revoked
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010019453
William Lallemand117c7fd2023-05-03 15:13:10 +020019454 http-response add-header X-SSL-verify %[ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str]
19455
19456
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200194577.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019458--------------------------------------------
19459
19460A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
19461not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
Aurelien DARRAGON4bd597b2023-11-30 11:11:43 +010019462"monitor fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019463The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
19464
19465always_false : boolean
19466 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
19467 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
19468
19469always_true : boolean
19470 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
19471 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
19472
19473avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019474 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019475 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
19476 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
19477 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
19478 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
19479 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
19480 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
19481 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
19482 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
19483 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
19484 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
19485 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
19486 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
19487 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010019488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019489be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019490 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
19491 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
19492 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
19493 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040019494 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
19495
19496be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
19497 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
19498 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
19499 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
19500 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
19501 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040019502 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
19503 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040019504
19505 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
19506 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
19507 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019509be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
19510 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19511 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
19512 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019513 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019514 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
19515 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019516
19517 Example :
19518 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
19519 backend dynamic
19520 mode http
19521 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
19522 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019523
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019524bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019525 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
19526 of the string.
19527
19528bool(<bool>) : bool
19529 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
19530 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
19531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019532connslots([<backend>]) : integer
19533 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019534 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019535 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
19536 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050019537
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019538 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019539 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019540 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
19541
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019542 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
19543 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019544
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019545 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019546 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019547 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019548 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019549 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019550 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019551 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019552
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019553 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
19554 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019555 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019556 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019557
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019558cpu_calls : integer
19559 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
19560 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
19561 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
19562 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
19563 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
19564 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
19565
19566cpu_ns_avg : integer
19567 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
19568 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
19569 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
19570 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
19571 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
19572 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
19573 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
19574 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
19575 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
19576 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
19577 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
19578
19579cpu_ns_tot : integer
19580 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
19581 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
19582 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
19583 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
19584 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
19585 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
19586 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
19587 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
19588 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
19589 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
19590 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
19591 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
19592 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
19593
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010019594date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020019595 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019596
19597 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
19598 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
19599 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020019600 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
19601
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019602 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
19603 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
19604 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
19605 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
19606 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
19607
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020019608 Example :
19609
19610 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
19611 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020019612
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019613 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
19614 # millisecond granularity
19615 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
19616
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010019617date_us : integer
19618 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
19619 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
19620 from the same timeval structure.
19621
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020019622env(<name>) : string
19623 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
19624 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
19625 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
19626 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
19627 certain way.
19628
19629 Examples :
19630 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
19631 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
19632
19633 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019634 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020019635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019636fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
19637 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019638 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
19639 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019640 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
19641 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019642 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019643 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
19644 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019645
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020019646fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
19647 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
19648 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
19649 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
19650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019651fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
19652 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19653 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
19654 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
19655 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
19656 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
19657 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
19658 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
19659 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019660
19661 Example :
19662 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
19663 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
19664 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
19665 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
19666 frontend mail
19667 bind :25
19668 mode tcp
19669 maxconn 100
19670 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
19671 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
19672 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
19673 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019674
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010019675hostname : string
19676 Returns the system hostname.
19677
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020019678int(<integer>) : signed integer
19679 Returns a signed integer.
19680
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019681ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
19682 Returns an ipv4.
19683
19684ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
19685 Returns an ipv6.
19686
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020019687last_rule_file : string
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010019688 This returns the name of the configuration file containing the last final
19689 rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one that
19690 terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
19691 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
19692 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19693 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19694 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19695 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19696 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19697 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19698 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19699 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_line".
19700
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020019701last_rule_line : integer
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010019702 This returns the line number in the configuration file where is located the
19703 last final rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one
19704 that terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
19705 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
19706 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19707 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19708 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19709 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19710 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19711 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19712 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19713 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_file".
19714
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019715lat_ns_avg : integer
19716 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19717 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19718 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19719 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19720 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19721 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19722 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19723 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19724 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019725 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19726 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19727 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19728 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19729 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
19730 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019731
19732lat_ns_tot : integer
19733 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19734 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19735 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19736 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19737 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19738 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19739 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19740 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19741 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019742 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19743 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19744 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19745 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19746 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019747 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
19748 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
19749 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
19750 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
19751 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
19752 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
19753
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019754meth(<method>) : method
19755 Returns a method.
19756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019757nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
19758 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
19759 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
19760 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019761 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
19762 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
19763 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019764
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040019765prio_class : integer
19766 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
19767 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
19768 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
19769
19770prio_offset : integer
19771 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
19772 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
19773 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
19774 set-priority-offset".
19775
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019776proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020019777 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
19778 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019780queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019781 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
19782 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
19783 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019784 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
19785 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
19786 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
19787 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
19788 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
19789
Frédéric Lécaille33d11c42023-01-12 17:55:45 +010019790quic_enabled : boolean
Frédéric Lécaille33d11c42023-01-12 17:55:45 +010019791 Return true when the support for QUIC transport protocol was compiled and
19792 if this procotol was not disabled by "no-quic" global option. See also "no-quic"
19793 global option.
19794
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010019795rand([<range>]) : integer
19796 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
19797 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
19798 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
19799 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
19800 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
19801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019802srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19803 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19804 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
19805 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
19806 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
19807 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040019808 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
19809 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
19810
19811srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19812 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
19813 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
19814 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19815 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
19816 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
19817 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
19818 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
19819
19820 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
19821 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019822
19823srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
19824 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
19825 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
19826 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019827 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019828 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
19829 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
19830 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
19831
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020019832srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19833 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
19834 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19835 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
19836 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
19837 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
19838 fetch methods.
19839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019840srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19841 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19842 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019843 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019844 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
19845 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019846 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019847 overloading servers).
19848
19849 Example :
19850 # Redirect to a separate back
19851 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
19852 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
19853 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
19854
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019855srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019856 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
19857 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
19858 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
19859
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019860srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019861 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
19862 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19863 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
19864
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019865srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019866 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
19867 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19868 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
19869
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019870stopping : boolean
19871 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
19872 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
19873 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
19874
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019875str(<string>) : string
19876 Returns a string.
19877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019878table_avl([<table>]) : integer
19879 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
19880 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
19881
19882table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19883 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
19884 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
19885 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
19886
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010019887thread : integer
19888 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
19889 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
19890 and debugging purposes.
19891
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020019892uuid([<version>]) : string
19893 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
19894 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
19895 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
19896
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019897var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019898 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019899 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
19900 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
19901 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019902 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019903 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19904 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019905 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019906 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19907 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019908 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019909 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019910
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200199117.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019912----------------------------------
19913
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019914The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019915closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
19916methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
19917sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
19918TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019919the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
19920counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020019921"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +010019922used if the global "tune.stick-counters" value does not exceed 3, otherwise the
19923counter number can be specified as the first integer argument when using the
19924"sc_" prefix starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (tune.stick-counters-1).
19925An optional table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the
19926currently tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of
19927the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019928
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019929bc_dst : ip
19930 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
19931 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
19932 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
19933 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19934
19935bc_dst_port : integer
19936 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019937 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019938
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019939bc_err : integer
19940 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
19941 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
19942 and their corresponding error message.
19943
19944bc_err_str : string
19945 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
19946 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
19947 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
19948 corresponding error message.
19949
Willy Tarreau0d953302024-01-17 18:00:21 +010019950bc_glitches : integer
19951 Returns the number of protocol glitches counted on the backend connection.
19952 These generally cover protocol violations as well as small anomalies that
19953 generally indicate a bogus or misbehaving server that may cause trouble in
19954 the infrastructure (e.g. cause connections to be aborted early, inducing
19955 frequent TLS renegotiations). These may also be caused by too large responses
19956 that cannot fit into a single buffer, explaining HTTP 502 errors. Ideally
19957 this number should remain zero, though it's generally fine if it remains very
19958 low compared to the total number of requests. These values should normally
19959 not be considered as alarming (especially small ones), though a sudden jump
19960 may indicate an anomaly somewhere. Not all protocol multiplexers measure this
19961 metric and the only way to get more details about the events is to enable
19962 traces to capture all exchanges.
19963
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010019964bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010019965 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
19966 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
19967 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
19968
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019969bc_src : ip
19970 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019971 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019972 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
19973 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19974
19975bc_src_port : integer
19976 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019977 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019979be_id : integer
19980 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019981 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19982 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019983
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019984be_name : string
19985 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019986 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19987 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019988
Aleksandar Lazic5529c992023-04-28 11:39:12 +020019989bc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
19990 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the backend
19991 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
19992 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
19993 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19994 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19995 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19996
19997bc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
19998 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
19999 backend connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
20000 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
20001 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
20002 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
20003 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20004
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010020005be_server_timeout : integer
20006 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
20007 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
20008 also the "cur_server_timeout".
20009
20010be_tunnel_timeout : integer
20011 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
20012 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
20013 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
20014
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010020015cur_server_timeout : integer
20016 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
20017 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
20018 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
20019
20020cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
20021 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
20022 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
20023 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
20024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020025dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020026 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
20027 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
20028 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
20029 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
20030 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
20031 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
20032 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
20033 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
20034 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
20035 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
20036 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020037
20038dst_conn : integer
20039 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
20040 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
20041 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
20042 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
20043 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
20044 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
20045 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
20046 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020047
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020048dst_is_local : boolean
20049 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
20050 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
20051 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
20052 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020053 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020054 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
20055 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
20056 it only once per connection.
20057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020058dst_port : integer
20059 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
20060 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020061 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
20062 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
20063 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
20064 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020065
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010020066fc_dst : ip
20067 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
20068 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
20069 for details.
20070
20071fc_dst_is_local : boolean
20072 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
20073 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
20074 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
20075
20076fc_dst_port : integer
20077 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
20078 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
20079 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
20080
20081fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020082 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
20083 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
20084 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +020020085 described in section 8.2.5). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020086 error codes and their corresponding error message.
20087
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010020088fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050020089 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020090 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +020020091 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.5). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020092 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
20093
20094 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
20095 | ID | message |
20096 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
20097 | 0 | "Success" |
20098 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
20099 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
20100 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
20101 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
20102 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
20103 | 6 | "General socket error" |
20104 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
20105 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
20106 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
20107 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
20108 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
20109 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
20110 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
20111 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
20112 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
20113 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
20114 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
20115 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
20116 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
20117 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
20118 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
20119 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
20120 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
20121 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
20122 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
20123 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
20124 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
20125 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
20126 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
20127 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
20128 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
20129 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
20130 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
20131 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
20132 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
20133 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
20134 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
20135 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
20136 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
20137 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
20138 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
20139 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020020140 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020141 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
20142
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020143fc_fackets : integer
20144 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
20145 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20146 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20147 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20148
Willy Tarreau0d953302024-01-17 18:00:21 +010020149fc_glitches : integer
20150 Returns the number of protocol glitches counted on the frontend connection.
20151 These generally cover protocol violations as well as small anomalies that
20152 generally indicate a bogus or misbehaving client that may cause trouble in
20153 the infrastructure, such as excess of errors in the logs, or many connections
20154 being aborted early, inducing frequent TLS renegotiations. These may also be
20155 caused by too large requests that cannot fit into a single buffer, explaining
20156 HTTP 400 errors. Ideally this number should remain zero, though it may be
20157 possible that some browsers playing with the protocol boundaries trigger it
20158 once in a while. These values should normally not be considered as alarming
20159 (especially small ones), though a sudden jump may indicate an anomaly
20160 somewhere. Large values (i.e. hundreds to thousands per connection, or as
20161 many as the requests) may indicate a purposely built client that is trying to
20162 fingerprint or attack the protocol stack. Not all protocol multiplexers
20163 measure this metric, and the only way to get more details about the events is
20164 to enable traces to capture all exchanges.
20165
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020020166fc_http_major : integer
20167 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
20168 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
20169 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
20170
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020171fc_lost : integer
20172 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
20173 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20174 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20175 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20176
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020020177fc_pp_authority : string
20178 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
20179 if any.
20180
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010020181fc_pp_unique_id : string
20182 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
20183 if any.
20184
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010020185fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
20186 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
20187 header.
20188
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020189fc_reordering : integer
20190 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
20191 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20192 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20193 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20194
20195fc_retrans : integer
20196 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
20197 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20198 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20199 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20200
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020020201fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
20202 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
20203 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
20204 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
20205 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
20206 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
20207 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20208
20209fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
20210 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
20211 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
20212 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
20213 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
20214 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
20215 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20216
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020020217fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070020218 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
20219 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
20220 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
20221 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20222
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020223fc_src : ip
Christopher Faulet18b63f42023-07-17 07:56:55 +020020224 This is the original source IP address of the connection on the client side
20225 Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src" for
20226 details.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020227
20228fc_src_is_local : boolean
20229 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
20230 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
20231 "src_is_local" for details.
20232
20233fc_src_port : integer
20234
20235 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
20236 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
20237 this address. See "src-port" for details.
20238
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070020239
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020240fc_unacked : integer
20241 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
20242 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
20243 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
20244 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070020245
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020020246fe_defbe : string
20247 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
20248 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
20249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020250fe_id : integer
20251 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010020252 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020253 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
20254
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010020255fe_name : string
20256 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
20257 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
20258 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
20259
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010020260fe_client_timeout : integer
20261 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
20262 current frontend.
20263
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020264sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020265sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20266sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20267sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020268 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
20269 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
20270 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
20271
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020272sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020273sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20274sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20275sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020276 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
20277 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
20278 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
20279
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020280sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20281 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20282 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
20283 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
20284 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
20285 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
20286 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
20287 will always return zero.
20288 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20289 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20290
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020291sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020292sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20293sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20294sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020295 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
20296 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020297 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
20298 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
20299 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020300
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020301 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020302 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
20303 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020304 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
20305 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
20306 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020307 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
20308 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20309
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020310sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20311sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20312sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20313sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20314 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
20315 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
20316 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
20317 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
20318 when a first ACL was verified.
20319
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020320sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020321sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20322sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20323sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020324 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020325 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
20326
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020327sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020328sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
20329sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
20330sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020331 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
20332 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
20333 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
20334
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020335sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020336sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20337sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20338sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020339 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
20340 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
20341 See also src_conn_rate.
20342
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020343sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20344 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
20345 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
20346 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
20347 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
20348 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
20349 index, zero is returned.
20350 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20351 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
20352
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020353sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020354sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20355sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20356sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020357 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020358 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020359
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020360sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20361sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20362sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20363sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20364 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
20365 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
20366
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020020367sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20368 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
20369 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
20370 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
20371 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
20372 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
20373 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
20374 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
20375
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020020376sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20377sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20378sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20379sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20380 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
20381 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
20382
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020383sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20384 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
20385 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
20386 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
20387 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
20388 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
20389 between 0 and 2.
20390 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
20391 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
20392 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
20393 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
20394 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
20395
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020396sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020397sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
20398sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
20399sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020400 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
20401 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
20402 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020403 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
20404 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20405 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020406
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020407sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20408sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20409sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20410sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20411 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
20412 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
20413 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
20414 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
20415 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20416 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
20417
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020418sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020419sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20420sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20421sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020422 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020423 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
20424 See also src_http_err_cnt.
20425
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020426sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020427sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20428sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20429sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020430 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
20431 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
20432 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
20433 src_http_err_rate.
20434
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020435sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20436sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20437sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20438sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20439 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
20440 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
20441 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
20442
20443sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20444sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20445sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20446sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20447 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
20448 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
20449 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
20450 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
20451
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020452sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020453sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20454sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20455sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020456 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020457 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
20458 src_http_req_cnt.
20459
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020460sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020461sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20462sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20463sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020464 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
20465 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
20466 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
20467 src_http_req_rate.
20468
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020469sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20470 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20471 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
20472 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
20473 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
20474 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
20475 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
20476 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
20477 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20478 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20479
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020480sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020481sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20482sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20483sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020484 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020485 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
20486 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
20487 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
20488 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020489
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020490 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020491 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
20492 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020493 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20494
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020495sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20496sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20497sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20498sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20499 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
20500 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
20501 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
20502 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
20503 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
20504
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020505sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020506sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
20507sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
20508sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020509 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
20510 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
20511 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020512
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020513sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020514sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
20515sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
20516sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020517 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
20518 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
20519 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020520
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020521sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020522sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20523sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20524sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020525 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020526 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
20527 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
20528 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020529 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020530 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
20531
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020532sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020533sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20534sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20535sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020536 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
20537 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
20538 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
20539 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
20540 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020541 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020542
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020543sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020544sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
20545sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
20546sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020020547 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
20548 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
20549 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
20550
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020551sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020552sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
20553sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
20554sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010020555 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
20556 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020557 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010020558 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
20559 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020560 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
20561 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
20562 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010020563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020564so_id : integer
20565 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
20566 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
20567 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020568
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010020569so_name : string
20570 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
20571 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
20572 strings instead of integers.
20573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020574src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020575 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
20576 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
20577 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
20578 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
20579 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
20580 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
20581 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
20582 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
20583 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
20584 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
20585 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
20586 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
20587 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
20588 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
20589 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020590
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010020591 Example:
20592 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
20593 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
20594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020595src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20596 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
20597 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
20598 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020599 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020601src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20602 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
20603 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020604 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020605 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020606
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020607src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20608 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20609 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20610 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
20611 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20612 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
20613 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20614 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20615 See also sc_clr_gpc.
20616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020617src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20618 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20619 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20620 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
20621 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
20622 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
20623 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020624
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020625 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020626 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
20627 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
20628 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
20629 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020630 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020631 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
20632 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20633
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020634src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20635 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20636 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20637 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
20638 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
20639 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
20640 was verified.
20641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020642src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020643 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020644 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020645 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020646 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020648src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020649 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020650 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20651 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020652 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020654src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20655 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
20656 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20657 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020658 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020659
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020660src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20661 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
20662 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
20663 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
20664 is an integer between 0 and 99.
20665 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
20666 is returned.
20667 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
20668 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20669 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
20670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020671src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020672 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020673 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020674 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020675 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020676
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020677src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20678 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
20679 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
20680 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20681 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
20682
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020020683src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
20684 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
20685 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
20686 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
20687 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20688 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
20689 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
20690
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020020691src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20692 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
20693 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
20694 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20695 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
20696
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020697src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
20698 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
20699 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
20700 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
20701 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
20702 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20703 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
20704 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
20705 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
20706 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
20707 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
20708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020709src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020710 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020711 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020712 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
20713 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020714 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
20715 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20716 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020717
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020718src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20719 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
20720 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20721 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
20722 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
20723 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
20724 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20725 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
20726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020727src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020728 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020729 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020730 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020731 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020732 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020734src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20735 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
20736 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20737 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
20738 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020739 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020740
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020741src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20742 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
20743 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050020744 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020745 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
20746 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20747
20748src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20749 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
20750 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20751 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
20752 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
20753 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
20754 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
20755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020756src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020757 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020758 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20759 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020760 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020762src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20763 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
20764 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20765 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020766 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020767 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020768
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020769src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20770 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
20771 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20772 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
20773 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20774 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
20775 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20776 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20777 See also sc_inc_gpc.
20778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020779src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20780 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20781 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20782 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020783 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020784 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20785 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020786
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020787 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020788 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020789 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020790 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020791
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020792src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20793 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20794 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20795 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
20796 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
20797 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20798 connection when a first ACL was verified.
20799
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020800src_is_local : boolean
20801 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
20802 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
20803 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
20804 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020805 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020806 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
20807 once per connection.
20808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020809src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020810 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
20811 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
20812 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
20813 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
20814 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020816src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020817 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
20818 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20819 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
20820 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
20821 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020823src_port : integer
20824 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020825 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
20826 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
20827 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
20828 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010020829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020830src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020831 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020832 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20833 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
20834 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020835 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020837src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20838 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
20839 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20840 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
20841 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020842 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020844src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20845 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
20846 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
20847 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
20848 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
20849 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
20850 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
20851 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
20852 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020853
20854 Example :
20855 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
20856 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
20857 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
20858 listen ssh
20859 bind :22
20860 mode tcp
20861 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020862 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020863 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020864 server local 127.0.0.1:22
20865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020866srv_id : integer
20867 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
20868 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020869 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020020870
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020871srv_name : string
20872 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
20873 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020874 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020875
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200208767.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020877----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020020878
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020879The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020880closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
20881when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
20882usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020883future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020884
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00002088551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
20886 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
20887 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
20888 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
20889 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
20890 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
20891
20892 Example :
20893 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
20894 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
20895 # the request.
20896 frontend http-in
20897 bind *:8081
20898 default_backend servers
20899 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
20900 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
20901
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020902ssl_bc : boolean
20903 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
20904 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Mariam John6ff043d2023-05-22 13:11:13 -050020905 to a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020906 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020907
20908ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
20909 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020910 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20911 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020912
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020913ssl_bc_alpn : string
20914 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
20915 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020916 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020917 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
20918 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
20919 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
20920 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
20921 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020922 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
20923 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020924
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020925ssl_bc_cipher : string
20926 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020927 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20928 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020929
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020930ssl_bc_client_random : binary
20931 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20932 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20933 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020934 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020935
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020936ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020937 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020938 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
20939 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
20940 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
20941 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020942 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
20943 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
20944 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
20945
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020946ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020947 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020948 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
20949 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
20950 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020951
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020952ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
20953 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20954 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020955 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20956 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020957
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020958ssl_bc_npn : string
20959 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
20960 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020961 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020962 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
20963 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
20964 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
20965 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020966 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
20967 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020968
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020969ssl_bc_protocol : string
20970 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020971 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20972 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020973
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020974ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020975 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020976 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020977 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
20978 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020979
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020980ssl_bc_server_random : binary
20981 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20982 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20983 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020984 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020985
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020986ssl_bc_session_id : binary
20987 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
20988 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020989 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20990 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020991
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020992ssl_bc_session_key : binary
20993 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
20994 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
20995 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020996 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020997
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020998ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
20999 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020021000 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
21001 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020021002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021003ssl_c_ca_err : integer
21004 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21005 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
21006 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
21007 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
21008 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020021009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021010ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
21011 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21012 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
21013 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
21014 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021015
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010021016ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020021017 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
21018 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21019 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050021020 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020021021 does not support resumed sessions.
21022
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010021023ssl_c_der : binary
21024 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
21025 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21026 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
21027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021028ssl_c_err : integer
21029 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21030 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
21031 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
21032 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
21033 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021034
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021035ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021036 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21037 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
21038 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21039 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21040 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21041 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
21042 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21043 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021044 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21045 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21046 LDAP v3.
21047 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21048 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021050ssl_c_key_alg : string
21051 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
21052 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21053 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021055ssl_c_notafter : string
21056 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
21057 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21058 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020021059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021060ssl_c_notbefore : string
21061 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
21062 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21063 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010021064
Abhijeet Rastogidf97f472023-05-13 20:04:45 -070021065ssl_c_r_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
21066 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and is
21067 successfully validated with the configured ca-file, returns the full
21068 distinguished name of the root CA of the certificate presented by the client
21069 when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the first given entry found from
21070 the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative occurrence number is specified
21071 as the optional second argument, it returns the value of the nth given entry
21072 value from the beginning/end of the DN. For instance, "ssl_c_r_dn(OU,2)" the
21073 second organization unit, and "ssl_c_r_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name. The
21074 <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for consumption by
21075 different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for LDAP v3. If you'd like
21076 to modify the format only you can specify an empty string and zero for the
21077 first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_r_dn(,0,rfc2253)
21078
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021079ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021080 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21081 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
21082 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21083 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21084 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21085 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
21086 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21087 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021088 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21089 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21090 LDAP v3.
21091 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21092 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010021093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021094ssl_c_serial : binary
21095 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
21096 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21097 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021099ssl_c_sha1 : binary
21100 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
21101 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
21102 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020021103 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
21104 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
21105
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030021106 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020021107 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021109ssl_c_sig_alg : string
21110 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
21111 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
21112 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021114ssl_c_used : boolean
21115 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
21116 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020021117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021118ssl_c_verify : integer
21119 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
21120 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
21121 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
21122 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020021123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021124ssl_c_version : integer
21125 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
21126 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020021127
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010021128ssl_f_der : binary
21129 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
21130 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21131 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
21132
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021133ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021134 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21135 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
21136 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21137 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021138 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021139 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
21140 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21141 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021142 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21143 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21144 LDAP v3.
21145 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21146 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021148ssl_f_key_alg : string
21149 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
21150 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
21151 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020021152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021153ssl_f_notafter : string
21154 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
21155 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21156 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021158ssl_f_notbefore : string
21159 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
21160 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21161 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021162
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021163ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021164 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21165 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
21166 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21167 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21168 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21169 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
21170 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21171 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021172 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21173 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21174 LDAP v3.
21175 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21176 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020021177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021178ssl_f_serial : binary
21179 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
21180 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21181 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021182
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020021183ssl_f_sha1 : binary
21184 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
21185 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
21186 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
21187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021188ssl_f_sig_alg : string
21189 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
21190 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
21191 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020021192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021193ssl_f_version : integer
21194 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
21195 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
21196
21197ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021198 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
21199 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
21200 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
21201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021202 Example :
21203 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
21204 listen http-https
21205 bind :80
21206 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
21207 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
21208
21209ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
21210 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
21211 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
21212
21213ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021214 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021215 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021216 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021217 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
21218 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
21219 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
21220 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
21221 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
21222 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
21223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021224ssl_fc_cipher : string
21225 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
21226 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020021227
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021228ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
21229 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
21230 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021231 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021232 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21233 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
21234 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021235
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021236 Example:
21237 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21238 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21239 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21240 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21241 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21242 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21243 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21244 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21245 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21246
21247ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021248 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021249 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021250 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
21251 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021252 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
21253 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021254
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021255ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021256 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021257 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021258 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021259 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21260 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
21261 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
21262 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
21263 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
21264 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021265
21266ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021267 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021268 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
21269 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021270
21271ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
21272 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
21273 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021274 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021275
21276 Example:
21277 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21278 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21279 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21280 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21281 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21282 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21283 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21284 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21285 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21286
21287ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
21288 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
21289 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021290 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021291 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21292 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
21293 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
21294
21295 Example:
21296 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21297 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21298 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21299 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21300 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21301 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21302 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21303 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21304 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21305
21306ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
21307 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
21308 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021309 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021310 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21311 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
21312 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
21313
21314 Example:
21315 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21316 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21317 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21318 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21319 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21320 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21321 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21322 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21323 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021324
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040021325ssl_fc_client_random : binary
21326 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
21327 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
21328 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
21329
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020021330ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
21331 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21332 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21333 transport layer.
21334 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21335 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21336 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21337 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21338
21339ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
21340 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21341 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21342 transport layer.
21343 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21344 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21345 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21346 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21347
21348ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
21349 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
21350 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21351 transport layer.
21352 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21353 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21354 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21355 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21356
21357ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
21358 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21359 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21360 transport layer.
21361 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21362 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21363 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21364 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21365
21366ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
21367 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21368 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
21369 transport layer.
21370 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21371 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21372 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21373 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21374
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021375ssl_fc_err : integer
21376 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21377 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
21378 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
21379 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
21380 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
21381 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
21382 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
21383 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
21384 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
21385 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
21386 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
21387 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
21388 codes.
21389
21390ssl_fc_err_str : string
21391 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21392 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
21393 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
21394 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
21395 also "ssl_fc_err".
21396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021397ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021398 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
21399 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010021400 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
21401 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
21402 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
21403 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021404
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020021405ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
21406 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
21407 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
21408 wait until the handshake happened.
21409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021410ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
21411 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020021412 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
21413 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021414 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020021415 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020021416
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020021417ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020021418 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010021419 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
21420 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020021421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021422ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021423 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021424 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021425 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
21426 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
21427 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
21428 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
21429 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
21430 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020021431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021432ssl_fc_protocol : string
21433 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
21434 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020021435
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021436ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
21437 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
21438 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021439 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
21440 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021441
21442 Example:
21443 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21444 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21445 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21446 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21447 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21448 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21449 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21450 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21451 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21452
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020021453ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040021454 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020021455 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010021456 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040021457
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020021458ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
21459 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21460 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21461 transport layer.
21462 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21463 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21464 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21465 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21466
21467ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
21468 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
21469 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
21470 transport layer.
21471 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21472 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21473 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21474 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21475
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040021476ssl_fc_server_random : binary
21477 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
21478 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
21479 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
21480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021481ssl_fc_session_id : binary
21482 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
21483 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
21484 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
21485 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020021486
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040021487ssl_fc_session_key : binary
21488 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
21489 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
21490 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
21491 BoringSSL.
21492
21493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021494ssl_fc_sni : string
21495 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
21496 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021497 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021498 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
21499 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
21500
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021501 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021502 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021503 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021504 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020021505 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021506
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010021507 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
21508 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
21509 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
21510 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
21511 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
21512 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
21513 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
21514 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
21515 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
21516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021517 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021518 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
21519 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020021520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021521ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
21522 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
21523 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021524
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021525ssl_s_der : binary
21526 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
21527 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21528 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
21529
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020021530ssl_s_chain_der : binary
21531 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
21532 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21533 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050021534 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020021535 does not support resumed sessions.
21536
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021537ssl_s_key_alg : string
21538 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
21539 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
21540 SSL/TLS transport layer.
21541
21542ssl_s_notafter : string
21543 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
21544 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21545 transport layer.
21546
21547ssl_s_notbefore : string
21548 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
21549 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21550 transport layer.
21551
21552ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
21553 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21554 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
21555 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21556 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21557 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21558 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020021559 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21560 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021561 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21562 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21563 LDAP v3.
21564 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21565 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
21566
21567ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
21568 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21569 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
21570 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21571 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21572 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21573 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020021574 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21575 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021576 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21577 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21578 LDAP v3.
21579 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21580 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
21581
21582ssl_s_serial : binary
21583 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
21584 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21585 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
21586
21587ssl_s_sha1 : binary
21588 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
21589 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
21590 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
21591
21592ssl_s_sig_alg : string
21593 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
21594 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
21595 layer.
21596
21597ssl_s_version : integer
21598 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
21599 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021600
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200216017.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021602------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021604Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
21605sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
21606only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
21607For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
21608be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
21609can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
21610sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
21611for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
21612content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021613
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010021614Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
21615 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021616 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010021617 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
21618 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
21619 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
21620 sample expression). So be careful.
21621
Willy Tarreau3ec14612022-03-10 10:39:58 +010021622distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
21623 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
21624 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
21625 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
21626 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
21627 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
21628 list of supported tokens.
21629
21630distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
21631 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
21632 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
21633 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
21634 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
21635 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
21636 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
21637 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
21638 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
21639 supported tokens.
21640
21641 Example :
21642 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
21643 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
21644 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
21645 # send large files to the big farm
21646 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
21647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021648payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021649 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021650 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
21651 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021653payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
21654 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021655 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021656 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021658req.len : integer
21659req_len : integer (deprecated)
21660 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
21661 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
21662 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
21663 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
21664 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021665 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021666 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
21667 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021669req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
21670 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021671 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
21672 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
21673 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
21674 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021675
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021676 ACL derivatives :
21677 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021679req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
21680 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
21681 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
21682 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
21683 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021684
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021685 ACL derivatives :
21686 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021688 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021690req.proto_http : boolean
21691req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
21692 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
21693 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
21694 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
21695 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
21696 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
21697 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
21698 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021700 Example:
21701 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
21702 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
21703 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020021704 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021706req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
21707rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21708 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
21709 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
21710 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
21711 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
21712 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
21713 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
21714 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021716 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
21717 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
21718 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
21719 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
21720 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
21721 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021723 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021724 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021726 Example :
21727 listen tse-farm
21728 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
21729 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
21730 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
21731 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
21732 # apply RDP cookie persistence
21733 persist rdp-cookie
21734 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
21735 # This is only useful makes sense if
21736 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
21737 stick-table type string size 204800
21738 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
21739 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
21740 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021742 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021743 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021745req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
21746rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
21747 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
21748 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
21749 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
21750 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021752 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021753 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021754
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021755req.ssl_alpn : string
21756 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
21757 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
21758 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
21759 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
21760 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
21761 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021762 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021763
21764 Examples :
21765 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21766 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021767 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021768 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021769 default_backend bk_default
21770
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021771req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
21772 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
21773 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020021774 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
21775 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
21776 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
21777 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
21778 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021780req.ssl_hello_type : integer
21781req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21782 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21783 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
21784 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21785 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21786 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
21787 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21788 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021790req.ssl_sni : string
21791req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
21792 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
21793 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
21794 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
21795 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21796 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020021797 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
21798 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
21799 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
21800 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
21801 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
21802 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
21803 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
21804 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
21805 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021807 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021808 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021810 Examples :
21811 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21812 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021813 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021814 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021815 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021816
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053021817req.ssl_st_ext : integer
21818 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
21819 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
21820 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
21821 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
21822 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
21823 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
21824 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
21825 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
21826 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
21827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021828req.ssl_ver : integer
21829req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
21830 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
21831 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
21832 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
21833 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
21834 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21835 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
21836 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021837 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021838 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021840 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021841 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021842
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021843res.len : integer
21844 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
21845 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
21846 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
21847 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
21848 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021849 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021850 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021851 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021853res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
21854 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021855 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021856 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021857 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021858 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021860res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
21861 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
21862 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
21863 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021864 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
21865 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021867 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021868
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020021869res.ssl_hello_type : integer
21870rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21871 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21872 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
21873 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21874 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21875 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
21876 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21877 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
21878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021879wait_end : boolean
21880 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
21881 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021882 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021883 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
21884 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021885 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021886 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
21887 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021889 Examples :
21890 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
21891 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
21892 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021894 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
21895 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
21896 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
21897 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
21898 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
21899 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
21900 tcp-request content reject
21901
21902
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200219037.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021904--------------------------------------
21905
21906It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
21907This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
21908data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
21909its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
21910HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
21911content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
21912to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
21913more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
21914response are indexed.
21915
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010021916Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
21917 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
21918 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
21919 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
21920 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
21921 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
21922 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
21923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021924base : string
21925 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21926 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
21927 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
21928 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
21929 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
21930 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
21931 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
21932 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
21933
21934 ACL derivatives :
21935 base : exact string match
21936 base_beg : prefix match
21937 base_dir : subdir match
21938 base_dom : domain match
21939 base_end : suffix match
21940 base_len : length match
21941 base_reg : regex match
21942 base_sub : substring match
21943
21944base32 : integer
21945 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
21946 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
21947 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020021948 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
21949 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
21950 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021951
21952base32+src : binary
21953 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
21954 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
21955 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
21956 per-URL counters.
21957
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010021958baseq : string
21959 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21960 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
21961 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
21962 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
21963
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021964capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
21965 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
21966 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21967 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
21968
21969capture.req.method : string
21970 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
21971 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
21972 because it's allocated.
21973
21974capture.req.uri : string
21975 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
21976 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
21977 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
21978 allocated.
21979
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021980capture.req.ver : string
21981 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21982 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
21983 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
21984
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021985capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
21986 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
21987 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21988 The first entry is an index of 0.
21989 See also: "capture response header"
21990
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021991capture.res.ver : string
21992 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21993 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
21994 persistent flag.
21995
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021996req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021997 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
21998 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
21999 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020022000
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022001req.body_param([<name>[,i]]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020022002 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
22003 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
22004 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
22005 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022006 case-sensitive, unless "i" is added as a second argument. If no name is
22007 given, any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The
22008 result is a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as
22009 presented in the request body (no URL decoding is performed). Note that the
22010 ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will
22011 iteratively report all parameters values if no name is given.
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020022012
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020022013req.body_len : integer
22014 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
22015 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020022016 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
22017 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020022018
22019req.body_size : integer
22020 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020022021 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
22022 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020022023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022024req.cook([<name>]) : string
22025cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
22026 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
22027 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
22028 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
22029 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
22030 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
22031 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
22032 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
22033 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
22034
22035 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022036 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
22037 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
22038 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
22039 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
22040 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
22041 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
22042 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
22043 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022045req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22046cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
22047 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
22048 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022050req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
22051cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
22052 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
22053 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
22054 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
22055 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020022056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022057cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
22058 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
22059 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
22060 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
22061 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020022062 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022063 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
22064 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
22065 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
22066 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022068hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
22069 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
22070 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
22071 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
22072 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022073 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022075req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022076 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
22077 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
22078 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
22079 with headers such as User-Agent.
22080
22081 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
22082 found.
22083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022084 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
22085 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
22086 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022087 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022089req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22090 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
22091 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022092 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
22093 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022095req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022096 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
22097 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
22098 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
22099 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
22100 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
22101 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
22102 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
22103
22104 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
22105 found.
22106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022107 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
22108 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
22109 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022110 with -1 being the last one.
22111
22112 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
22113 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022115 ACL derivatives :
22116 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
22117 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
22118 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
22119 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
22120 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
22121 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
22122 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
22123 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
22124
22125req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22126hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
22127 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
22128 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022129 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
22130 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
22131 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
22132
22133 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
22134 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
22135 which contain more than one of certain headers.
22136
22137 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022138
22139req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
22140hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
22141 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
22142 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
22143 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010022144 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
22145 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
22146 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
22147 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
22148 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022149
22150 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
22151
22152 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022153
22154req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
22155hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
22156 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
22157 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
22158 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022159
22160 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
22161
22162 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022163
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010022164req.hdrs : string
22165 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
22166 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
22167 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
22168 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
22169
22170req.hdrs_bin : binary
22171 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
22172 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
22173 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
22174 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
22175 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
22176 names and values (length of 0 for both).
22177
22178 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010022179
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010022180 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
22181 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010022182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022183http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
22184 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
22185 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
22186 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
22187 basic auth is supported.
22188
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020022189http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
22190 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
22191 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
22192 performed on the data sent by the client.
22193 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
22194 Authorization one.
22195
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010022196http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
22197 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
22198 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
22199 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
22200 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022201 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
22202 basic auth is supported.
22203
22204 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010022205 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
22206 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
22207 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
22208 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022209
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022210http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010022211 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
22212 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
22213 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022214
22215http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010022216 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
22217 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
22218 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022219
22220http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010022221 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
22222 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
22223 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022225http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020022226 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
22227 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022228 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
22229 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020022230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022231method : integer + string
22232 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
22233 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
22234 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
22235 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
22236 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
22237 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
22238 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022240 ACL derivatives :
22241 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022243 Example :
22244 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
22245 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
22246 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022248path : string
22249 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
22250 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
22251 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
22252 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
22253 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022254 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +020022255 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods. Please
22256 note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#' after the path) is strictly
22257 forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be rejected. However, if the frontend
22258 receiving the request has "option accept-invalid-http-request", then this
22259 fragment part will be accepted and will also appear in the path.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022261 ACL derivatives :
22262 path : exact string match
22263 path_beg : prefix match
22264 path_dir : subdir match
22265 path_dom : domain match
22266 path_end : suffix match
22267 path_len : length match
22268 path_reg : regex match
22269 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022270
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020022271pathq : string
22272 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
22273 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
22274 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
22275 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
22276 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +020022277 result in both cases. Please note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#'
22278 after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
22279 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
22280 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
22281 will also appear in the path.
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020022282
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010022283query : string
22284 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
22285 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
22286 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
22287 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022288 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010022289 which stops before the question mark.
22290
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010022291req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
22292 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
22293 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
22294 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
22295 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
22296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022297req.ver : string
22298req_ver : string (deprecated)
22299 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
William Lallemandbcb3d602023-09-04 16:49:59 +020022300 be useful for ACL. For logs use the "%HV" log variable. Some predefined ACL
22301 already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
22302
22303 Common values are "1.0", "1.1", "2.0" or "3.0".
22304
22305 In the case of http/2 and http/3, the value is not extracted from the HTTP
22306 version in the request line but is determined by the negociated protocol
22307 version.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022309 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022310 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020022311
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022312res.body : binary
22313 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
22314 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022315 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
22316
22317 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022318
22319res.body_len : integer
22320 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
22321 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022322 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
22323
22324 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022325
22326res.body_size : integer
22327 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
22328 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
22329 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
22330 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022331 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
22332
22333 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022334
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010022335res.cache_hit : boolean
22336 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
22337 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
22338
22339res.cache_name : string
22340 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
22341 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
22342 empty string.
22343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022344res.comp : boolean
22345 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
22346 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
22347 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022349res.comp_algo : string
22350 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
22351 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
22352 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022354res.cook([<name>]) : string
22355scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
22356 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
22357 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022358 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
22359
22360 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020022361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022362 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022363 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020022364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022365res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22366scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
22367 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
22368 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022369 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
22370
22371 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022373res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
22374scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
22375 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
22376 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022377 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
22378
22379 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022381res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022382 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
22383 on the headers within an HTTP response.
22384
22385 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
22386 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
22387
22388 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
22389
22390 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022392res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022393 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
22394 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22395
22396 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
22397 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
22398
22399 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022401res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
22402shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022403 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
22404 on the headers within an HTTP response.
22405
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050022406 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022407 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
22408
22409 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022411 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022412 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
22413 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
22414 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
22415 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
22416 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
22417 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
22418 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
22419 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022420
22421res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22422shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022423 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
22424 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22425
22426 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050022427 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022428
22429 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022431res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
22432shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022433 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
22434 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22435
22436 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
22437
22438 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022439
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010022440res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
22441 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
22442 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
22443 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022444 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
22445
22446 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010022447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022448res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
22449shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022450 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
22451 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22452
22453 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
22454
22455 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022456
22457res.hdrs : string
22458 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
22459 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
22460 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022461 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
22462
22463 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022464
22465res.hdrs_bin : binary
22466 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
22467 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
22468 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
22469 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
22470 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
22471 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
22472 (length of 0 for both).
22473
22474 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
22475
22476 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
22477 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010022478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022479res.ver : string
22480resp_ver : string (deprecated)
22481 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022482 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
22483
22484 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020022485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022486 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022487 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010022488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022489set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
22490 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
22491 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020022492 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022493 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022495 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
22496 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022498status : integer
22499 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
22500 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022501 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
22502
22503 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022504
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020022505unique-id : string
22506 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
22507 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
22508 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
22509 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
22510 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
22511 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
22512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022513url : string
22514 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
22515 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
22516 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
22517 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
22518 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
22519 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +020022520 also "path" and "base". Please note that any fragment reference in the URI
22521 ('#' after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
22522 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
22523 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
22524 will also appear in the url.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022526 ACL derivatives :
22527 url : exact string match
22528 url_beg : prefix match
22529 url_dir : subdir match
22530 url_dom : domain match
22531 url_end : suffix match
22532 url_len : length match
22533 url_reg : regex match
22534 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022536url_ip : ip
22537 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
22538 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
22539 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
22540 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020022541 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
22542 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022544url_port : integer
22545 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020022546 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022547
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022548urlp([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : string
22549url_param([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022550 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
22551 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022552 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive, unless"i" is added as a
22553 third argument. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
22554 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
22555 parameter <name> as presented in the request (no URL decoding is performed).
22556 This can be used for session stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an
22557 application cookie passed as a URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks.
22558 Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and
22559 will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022561 ACL derivatives :
22562 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
22563 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
22564 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
22565 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
22566 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
22567 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
22568 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
22569 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022570
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022572 Example :
22573 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
22574 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
22575 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
22576 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022577
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022578urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022579 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
22580 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
22581 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020022582
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020022583url32 : integer
22584 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
22585 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
22586 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
22587 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
22588 is an unsigned integer.
22589
22590url32+src : binary
22591 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
22592 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
22593 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
22594
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020022595
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200225967.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022597---------------------------------------
22598
22599This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
22600used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
22601purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
22602There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
22603or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
22604any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
22605for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
22606
22607internal.htx.data : integer
22608 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
22609 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22610
22611internal.htx.free : integer
22612 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
22613 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22614
22615internal.htx.free_data : integer
22616 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
22617 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22618
22619internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010022620 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
22621 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
22622 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022623
22624internal.htx.nbblks : integer
22625 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
22626 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22627
22628internal.htx.size : integer
22629 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
22630 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22631
22632internal.htx.used : integer
22633 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
22634 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22635 direction.
22636
22637internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
22638 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22639 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
22640 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
22641 of the special value :
22642 * head : The oldest inserted block
22643 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022644 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022645
22646internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
22647 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22648 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
22649 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
22650 integer or one of the special value :
22651 * head : The oldest inserted block
22652 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022653 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022654
22655internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
22656 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22657 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
22658 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22659 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22660
22661 * head : The oldest inserted block
22662 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022663 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022664
22665internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
22666 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
22667 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
22668 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22669 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22670
22671 * head : The oldest inserted block
22672 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022673 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022674
22675internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
22676 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
22677 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
22678 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22679 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22680
22681 * head : The oldest inserted block
22682 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022683 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022684
22685internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
22686 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
22687 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
22688 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22689 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22690
22691 * head : The oldest inserted block
22692 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022693 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022694
22695internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
22696 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
22697 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
22698 it returns false.
22699
22700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200227017.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022702---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022703
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022704Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
22705every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020022706order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022707
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022708ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022709---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
22710FALSE always_false never match
22711HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
22712HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
22713HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010022714HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022715HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
22716HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
22717HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
22718HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020022719LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022720METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
22721METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
22722METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
22723METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
22724METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
22725METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
22726METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
22727METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
22728RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
22729REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
22730TRUE always_true always match
22731WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
22732---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022733
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010022734
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227358. Logging
22736----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022737
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022738One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
22739provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
22740very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
22741provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
22742state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022743to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022744headers.
22745
22746In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
22747about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
22748send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
22749
22750 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
22751 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
22752 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
22753 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
22754 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022755 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060022756 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022757
22758The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
22759allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
22760as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
22761while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
22762real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
22763delay.
22764
22765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227668.1. Log levels
22767---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022768
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022769TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022770source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022771HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
22772in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
22773track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
22774syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
22775about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022776
22777
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227788.2. Log formats
22779----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022780
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022781HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022782and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
22783slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
22784options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022785
22786 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
22787 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
22788 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
22789 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
22790 extents.
22791
22792 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
22793 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
22794 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
22795 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
22796 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
22797
22798 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
22799 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
22800 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
22801 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
22802 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
22803
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020022804 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
22805 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
22806 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
22807 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
22808
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022809 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
22810
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022811Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
22812specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
22813field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
22814servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
22815always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
22816identifier.
22817
22818Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
22819 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
22820 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
22821 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
22822 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
22823
22824
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228258.2.1. Default log format
22826-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022827
22828This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
22829as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
22830format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
22831
22832 Example :
22833 listen www
22834 mode http
22835 log global
22836 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22837
22838 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
22839 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
22840 (www/HTTP)
22841
22842 Field Format Extract from the example above
22843 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
22844 2 'Connect from' Connect from
22845 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
22846 4 'to' to
22847 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
22848 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
22849
22850Detailed fields description :
22851 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
22852 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
22853 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
22854 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
22855 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22856 and processed the connection.
22857 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
22858
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022859In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
22860"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
22861connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
22862
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022863It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
22864will eventually disappear.
22865
22866
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228678.2.2. TCP log format
22868---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022869
22870The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
22871is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
22872information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
22873counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
22874emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
22875environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
22876the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
22877sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022878specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022879not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
22880
22881The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22882exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022883if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable can be used instead.
22884Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022885
22886 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
22887 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
22888 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022889 # or using the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable
22890 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022891
22892A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
22893are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022894
22895 Example :
22896 frontend fnt
22897 mode tcp
22898 option tcplog
22899 log global
22900 default_backend bck
22901
22902 backend bck
22903 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22904
22905 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
22906 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
22907 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
22908
22909 Field Format Extract from the example above
22910 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
22911 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
22912 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
22913 4 frontend_name fnt
22914 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
22915 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
22916 7 bytes_read* 212
22917 8 termination_state --
22918 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
22919 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22920
22921Detailed fields description :
22922 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022923 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022924 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22925 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022926 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022927 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022928 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022929
22930 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022931 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22932 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22933 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022934
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022935 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022936 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
22937 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022938 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
22939 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
22940 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
22941 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022942
22943 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22944 and processed the connection.
22945
22946 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
22947 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
22948 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
22949 applications.
22950
22951 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
22952 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
22953 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
22954 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
22955 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
22956
22957 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
22958 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
22959 See "Timers" below for more details.
22960
22961 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
22962 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
22963 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
22964 "Timers" below for more details.
22965
22966 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022967 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022968 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
22969 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
22970 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
22971 details.
22972
22973 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
22974 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
22975 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
22976 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
22977 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
22978
22979 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
22980 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
22981 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
22982 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
22983 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
22984 for more details.
22985
22986 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022987 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022988 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
22989 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
22990 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022991 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022992
22993 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
22994 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
22995 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
22996 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
22997 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
22998 caused by a denial of service attack.
22999
23000 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
23001 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
23002 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
23003 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
23004 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
23005 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
23006 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
23007 denial of service attack.
23008
23009 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
23010 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
23011 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
23012 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
23013 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
23014 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
23015 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
23016 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
23017 be processed than on other servers.
23018
23019 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
23020 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
23021 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
23022 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023023 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023024 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
23025 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
23026 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
23027 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
23028 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
23029 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
23030 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
23031 should not be attributed to the logged server.
23032
23033 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
23034 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
23035 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
23036 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
23037 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
23038 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023039 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023040 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
23041
23042 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
23043 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
23044 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
23045 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
23046 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
23047 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023048 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023049 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
23050 occurs.
23051
23052
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200230538.2.3. HTTP log format
23054----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023055
23056The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
23057is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
23058the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
23059are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
23060emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
23061generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
23062"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
23063which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023064frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
23065is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023066
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023067The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
23068exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010023069if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable can be used
23070instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023071
23072 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
23073 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
23074 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
23075
23076And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
23077this exact string:
23078
23079 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
23080 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
23081 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
23082 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010023083 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable
23084 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023085
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023086Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
23087slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
23088with a star ('*') after the field name below.
23089
23090 Example :
23091 frontend http-in
23092 mode http
23093 option httplog
23094 log global
23095 default_backend bck
23096
23097 backend static
23098 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
23099
23100 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
23101 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
23102 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023103 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023104
23105 Field Format Extract from the example above
23106 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
23107 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023108 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023109 4 frontend_name http-in
23110 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023111 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023112 7 status_code 200
23113 8 bytes_read* 2750
23114 9 captured_request_cookie -
23115 10 captured_response_cookie -
23116 11 termination_state ----
23117 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
23118 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
23119 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
23120 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
23121 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023122
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023123Detailed fields description :
23124 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023125 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010023126 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
23127 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010023128 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023129 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010023130 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023131
23132 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010023133 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
23134 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
23135 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023136
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023137 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023138 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023139
23140 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
23141 and processed the connection.
23142
23143 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
23144 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
23145 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
23146
23147 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
23148 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
23149 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
23150 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
23151 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
23152 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
23153
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023154 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
23155 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
23156 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050023157 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023158 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
23159 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023160 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023161 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023162
23163 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
23164 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023165 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023166
23167 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
23168 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023169 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
23170 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023171
23172 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
23173 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
23174 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
23175 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
23176 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023177 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
23178 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023179
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023180 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023181 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
23182 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
23183 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
23184 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
23185 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
23186 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023187 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023188
23189 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023190 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
23191 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023192
23193 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
23194 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050023195 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023196 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
23197 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
23198 overflowing.
23199
23200 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
23201 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
23202 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
23203 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
23204 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
23205 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
23206 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
23207 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
23208
23209 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
23210 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
23211 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
23212 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
23213 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
23214 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
23215 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
23216 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
23217
23218 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
23219 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
23220 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
23221 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
23222 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
23223 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
23224 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
23225
23226 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023227 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023228 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
23229 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
23230 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023231 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023232 system.
23233
23234 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
23235 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
23236 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
23237 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
23238 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
23239 caused by a denial of service attack.
23240
23241 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
23242 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
23243 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
23244 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
23245 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
23246 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
23247 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
23248 denial of service attack.
23249
23250 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
23251 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
23252 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
23253 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
23254 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
23255 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
23256 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
23257 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
23258 processed than on other servers.
23259
23260 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
23261 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
23262 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
23263 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023264 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023265 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
23266 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
23267 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
23268 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
23269 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
23270 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
23271 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
23272 should not be attributed to the logged server.
23273
23274 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
23275 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
23276 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
23277 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
23278 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
23279 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023280 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023281 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
23282
23283 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
23284 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
23285 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
23286 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
23287 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
23288 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023289 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023290 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
23291 occurs.
23292
23293 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
23294 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
23295 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
23296 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
23297 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
23298 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
23299 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
23300 cookies" below for more details.
23301
23302 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
23303 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
23304 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
23305 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
23306 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
23307 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
23308 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
23309 and cookies" below for more details.
23310
23311 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
23312 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
23313 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
23314 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
23315 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
23316 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
23317 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
23318 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
23319
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023320
233218.2.4. HTTPS log format
23322----------------------
23323
23324The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
23325extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
23326information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
23327frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
23328end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
23329matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
23330sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
23331dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
23332"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
23333
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023334The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
23335exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010023336if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable can be used
23337instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023338
23339 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
23340 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
23341 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
23342 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023343 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010023344 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable
23345 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023346
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023347This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
23348appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
23349HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023350
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023351 Example :
23352 frontend https-in
23353 mode http
23354 option httpslog
23355 log global
23356 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
23357 default_backend bck
23358
23359 backend static
23360 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
23361
23362 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
23363 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
23364 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023365 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
23366 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023367
23368 Field Format Extract from the example above
23369 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
23370 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
23371 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
23372 4 frontend_name https-in
23373 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
23374 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
23375 7 status_code 200
23376 8 bytes_read* 2750
23377 9 captured_request_cookie -
23378 10 captured_response_cookie -
23379 11 termination_state ----
23380 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
23381 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
23382 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
23383 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
23384 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010023385 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020023386 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023387 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
23388 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023389
23390Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010023391 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
23392 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
23393 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023394
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020023395 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
23396 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
23397 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050023398 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020023399 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023400
23401 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
23402 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
23403 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
23404 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
23405
23406 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
23407 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
23408 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
23409 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
23410
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020023411 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
23412 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
23413 can be shared by multiple requests.
23414
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023415 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
23416 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
23417 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
23418 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
23419 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
23420
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023421 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
23422
23423 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
23424
23425
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100234268.2.5. Error log format
23427-----------------------
23428
23429When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
23430protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
23431unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
23432line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
23433"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
23434will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
23435logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
23436
23437The default format looks like this :
23438
23439 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
23440 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
23441 Connection error during SSL handshake
23442
23443 Field Format Extract from the example above
23444 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
23445 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
23446 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
23447 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
23448 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
23449
23450These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
23451failures.
23452
23453By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
23454above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
23455defined format.
23456
23457An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
23458source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
23459number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
23460internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
23461error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
23462the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
23463certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
23464indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
23465indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
23466ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
23467are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
23468would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
23469regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
23470
23471 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010023472 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010023473 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
23474 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
23475
23476
234778.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023478------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023479
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023480When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
23481ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
23482a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
23483formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
23484looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
23485and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023486
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023487HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023488Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
23489separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
23490prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
23491
23492Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
23493variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023494("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023495
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010023496If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020023497as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010023498less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
23499the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
23500
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020023501Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
23502"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
23503delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
23504preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023505
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023506Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
23507'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
23508https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
23509such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
23510
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023511Flags are :
23512 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023513 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023514 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
23515 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023516
23517 Example:
23518
23519 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
23520 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
23521
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023522 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
23523
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023524Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
23525
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023526 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023527 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023528 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
23529 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
23530 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023531 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
23532 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
23533 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023534 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000023535 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000023536 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000023537 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000023538 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000023539 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
23540 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010023541 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020023542 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023543 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010023544 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023545 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020023546 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080023547 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023548 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
23549 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
23550 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
23551 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
23552 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023553 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023554 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023555 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023556 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023557 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023558 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
23559 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023560 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
23561 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
23562 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023563 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023564 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
23565 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023566 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023567 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
23568 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
23569 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020023570 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020023571 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020023572 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
23573 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
23574 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
23575 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020023576 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023577 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023578 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023579 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010023580 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023581 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023582 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
23583 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
23584 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023585 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023586 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
23587 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023588 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023589 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
23590 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020023591 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023592 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023593 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023594 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023595
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023596 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023597
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010023598
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200235998.3. Advanced logging options
23600-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023601
23602Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
23603just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
23604options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
23605for more information about their usage.
23606
23607
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236088.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
23609------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023610
23611It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023612HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023613commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
23614monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
23615ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
23616
23617 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
23618 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
23619 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
23620 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
23621
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020023622 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
23623 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023624
23625 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
23626 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
23627 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
23628
23629
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236308.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
23631----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023632
23633The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
23634what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
23635or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023636"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023637just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
23638log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
23639after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
23640is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
23641with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
23642with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
23643
23644
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236458.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
23646------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023647
23648Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
23649for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
23650"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
23651retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
23652raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
23653a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
23654file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
23655you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
23656"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
23657
23658
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236598.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
23660--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023661
23662Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
23663multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
23664them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
23665"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
23666logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
23667error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
23668and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
23669too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
23670useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
23671alternative.
23672
23673
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236748.4. Timing events
23675------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023676
23677Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
23678reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
23679the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
23680frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023681mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
23682addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
23683
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010023684Timings events in HTTP mode:
23685
23686 first request 2nd request
23687 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
23688 t tr t tr ...
23689 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
23690 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
23691 :<---- Tq ---->: :
23692 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023693 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010023694 :<--------- Ta --------->:
23695
23696Timings events in TCP mode:
23697
23698 TCP session
23699 |<----------------->|
23700 t t
23701 ---|----|----|----|----|---
23702 | Th Tw Tc Td |
23703 |<------ Tt ------->|
23704
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023705 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023706 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023707 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
23708 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
23709 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023710 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023711 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
23712 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
23713 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
23714 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023715
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023716 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
23717 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
23718 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023719 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
23720 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
23721 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
23722 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
23723 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
23724 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023725
23726 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
23727 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
23728 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
23729 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
23730 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
23731 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
23732 request typed by hand during a test.
23733
23734 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
23735 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023736 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023737 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
23738 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
23739 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
23740 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023741
23742 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
23743 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
23744 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
23745 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
23746 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
23747
23748 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
23749 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
23750 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
23751 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
23752 connection never established.
23753
23754 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
23755 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
23756 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
23757 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
23758 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
23759 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
23760 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
23761 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
23762 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
23763 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
23764 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
23765
William Lallemand14894192023-07-25 09:06:51 +020023766 - Td: this is the total transfer time of the response payload till the last
23767 byte sent to the client. In HTTP it starts after the last response header
23768 (after Tr).
23769
23770 The data sent are not guaranteed to be received by the client, they can be
23771 stuck in either the kernel or the network.
23772
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023773 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
23774 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
23775 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
23776 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
23777 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
23778 by subtracting other timers when valid :
23779
23780 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
23781
23782 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
23783 "Ta" can never be negative.
23784
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023785 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
23786 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023787 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
23788 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023789 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023790
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023791 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023792
23793 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023794 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
23795 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023796
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023797 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
23798 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
23799 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
23800 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
23801 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
23802 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
23803 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
23804 prefixed with a '+' sign.
23805
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023806These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
23807protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
23808that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023809due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
23810"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
23811that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023812
23813Most common cases :
23814
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023815 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
23816 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
23817 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
23818 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
23819 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023820 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023821 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
23822 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
23823 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
23824 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
23825 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020023826 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023827
23828 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
23829 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
23830 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
23831 of ms on remote networks.
23832
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020023833 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
23834 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
23835 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023836
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023837 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
23838 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023839 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023840 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
23841 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
23842 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
23843 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
23844 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
23845 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023846
23847Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
23848
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023849 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023850 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023851 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023852
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023853 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023854 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
23855 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
23856
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023857 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023858 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
23859 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
23860 flags.
23861
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023862 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
23863 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023864 Check the session termination flags, then check the
23865 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
23866 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
23867 the client connection was maintained open.
23868
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023869 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023870 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023871 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023872 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
23873
23874
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200238758.5. Session state at disconnection
23876-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023877
23878TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
23879"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
238802-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
23881each of which has a special meaning :
23882
23883 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
23884 session to terminate :
23885
23886 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
23887
23888 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
23889 server explicitly refused it.
23890
23891 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
23892 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
23893 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
23894 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023895 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023896
Christopher Faulet9183dfd2023-12-19 08:51:26 +010023897 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023898
23899 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
23900 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
23901 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
23902 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
23903 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
23904
23905 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
23906 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
23907 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
23908 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
23909 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
23910
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023911 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090023912 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
23913
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023914 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070023915 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
23916 backup connections when going up.
23917
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023918 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020023919
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023920 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
23921 send or receive data.
23922
23923 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
23924 send or receive data.
23925
23926 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
23927 with nothing left in the buffers.
23928
23929 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
23930
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010023931 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023932 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
23933
23934 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
23935 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
23936 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
23937 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
23938 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
23939
23940 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
23941 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
23942
23943 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
23944 server (HTTP only).
23945
23946 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
23947
23948 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
23949 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
23950 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
23951
23952 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
23953 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
23954 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
23955
23956 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
23957
23958 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
23959 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
23960
23961 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
23962 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
23963 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
23964
23965 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
23966 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020023967 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
23968 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023969
23970 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
23971 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
23972 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
23973 another server.
23974
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023975 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023976 server.
23977
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023978 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
23979 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
23980 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
23981 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23982
23983 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
23984 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
23985 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
23986 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23987
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020023988 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
23989 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
23990 "use-server" rule).
23991
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023992 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
23993
23994 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
23995 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
23996
23997 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
23998
23999 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
24000 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
24001 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
24002
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024003 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
24004 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030024005 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024006 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
24007 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
24008
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024009 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
24010
24011 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
24012 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
24013
24014 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
24015
24016 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
24017
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024018The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
24019was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024020helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
24021starvation, attacks, etc...
24022
24023The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
24024alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
24025easier finding and understanding.
24026
24027 Flags Reason
24028
24029 -- Normal termination.
24030
24031 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024032 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
24033 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024034 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
24035
24036 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
24037 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024038 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
24039 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024040 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
24041 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024042
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024043 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
24044 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020024045 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024046
24047 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
24048 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
24049 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
24050
24051 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
24052 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
24053 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
24054 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
24055 the server takes too long to respond.
24056
24057 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
24058 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
24059 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
24060 long a time to respond.
24061
24062 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
24063 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
24064 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024065 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020024066 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
24067 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024068
24069 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
24070 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
24071 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
24072 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
24073 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020024074 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020024075 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
24076 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
24077 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
24078 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
24079 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
24080 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
24081 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
24082 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024083 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020024084 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
24085 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
24086 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024087
24088 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
24089 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020024090 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
24091 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
24092 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
24093 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024094
Christopher Faulet9183dfd2023-12-19 08:51:26 +010024095 LC The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. The
24096 request was not sent to the server. It only happens with a redirect
24097 because of a "redir" parameter on the server line.
24098
24099 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. The
24100 request was not sent to the server. Generally it means a redirect was
24101 returned, an HTTP return statement was processed or the request was
24102 handled by an applet (stats, cache, Prometheus exported, lua applet...).
24103
24104 LH The response was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
24105 it means a redirect was returned or an HTTP return statement was
24106 processed.
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020024107
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024108 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024109 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
24110 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024111 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024112 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
24113 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
24114
24115 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
24116 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
24117 503 or 504 here.
24118
24119 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024120 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024121 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
24122 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
24123 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
24124
24125 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
24126 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024127 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024128 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024129 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024130
24131 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
24132 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
24133 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
24134 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
24135 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
24136 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024137 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024138
24139 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
24140 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
24141 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
24142 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
24143 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
24144 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
24145 solution is to fix the application.
24146
24147 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
24148 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
24149 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
24150 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
24151 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
24152 external attacks.
24153
24154 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070024155 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020024156 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024157 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
24158 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
24159
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010024160 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
24161 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
24162 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024163 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020024164 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010024165
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024166 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
24167 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
24168 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
24169 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010024170 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
24171 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
24172 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
24173 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020024174 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
24175 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
24176 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
24177 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024178
24179 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
24180 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
24181 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020024182 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
24183 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
24184 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
24185 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024186
24187 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
24188 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
24189 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
24190 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
24191
24192 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
24193 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
24194 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
24195 only be solved by proper system tuning.
24196
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024197The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024198persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024199important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
24200re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
24201
24202 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
24203
24204 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
24205 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
24206 set on a GET request.
24207
24208 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
24209 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040024210 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024211 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
24212
24213 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
24214 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
24215 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
24216
24217 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
24218 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
24219 already got a cookie.
24220
24221 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
24222 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
24223 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
24224 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
24225 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
24226
24227 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
24228 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
24229 new cookie was inserted in the response.
24230
24231 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
24232 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
24233 new cookie was inserted in the response.
24234
24235 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
24236 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
24237
24238 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
24239 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
24240 then advertised in the response.
24241
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024242
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200242438.6. Non-printable characters
24244-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024245
24246In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
24247consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
24248converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
24249prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
24250being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
24251escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
24252is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
24253'}' when logging headers.
24254
24255Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
24256issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
24257containing spaces is "User-Agent".
24258
24259Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
24260the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
24261performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
24262
24263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200242648.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
24265---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024266
24267Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
24268achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024269section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024270cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
24271the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
24272the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024273locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024274not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
24275user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
24276a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
24277wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
24278
24279 Examples :
24280 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
24281 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
24282
24283 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
24284 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
24285
24286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200242878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
24288---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024289
24290Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
24291proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
24292the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
24293server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
24294
24295Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
24296response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024297section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024298
24299It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010024300time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
24301appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024302are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
24303and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
24304follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
24305request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
24306in the logs.
24307
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020024308As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
24309frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
24310an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
24311
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024312 Example :
24313 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
24314 listen proxy-out
24315 mode http
24316 option httplog
24317 option logasap
24318 log global
24319 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
24320
24321 # log the name of the virtual server
24322 capture request header Host len 20
24323
24324 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
24325 capture request header Content-Length len 10
24326
24327 # log the beginning of the referrer
24328 capture request header Referer len 20
24329
24330 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
24331 capture response header Server len 20
24332
24333 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
24334 capture response header Content-Length len 10
24335
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024336 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024337 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
24338
24339 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
24340 capture response header Via len 20
24341
24342 # log the URL location during a redirection
24343 capture response header Location len 20
24344
24345 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
24346 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
24347 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
24348 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
24349 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
24350
24351 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
24352 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
24353 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
24354 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024355 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024356
24357 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
24358 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
24359 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
24360 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
24361 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024362 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024363
24364
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200243658.9. Examples of logs
24366---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024367
24368These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
24369them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
24370reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
24371
24372 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
24373 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
24374 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
24375
24376 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
24377 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
24378
24379 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
24380 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
24381 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
24382
24383 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
24384 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
24385
24386 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
24387 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
24388 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
24389
24390 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010024391 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024392 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
24393 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
24394
24395 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
24396 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
24397 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
24398
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020024399 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
24400 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
24401 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
24402 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024403 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020024404 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024405
24406 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024407 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024408
24409 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
24410 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
24411 Nothing was sent to any server.
24412
24413 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
24414 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
24415
24416 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
24417 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024418 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024419 send a 408 return code to the client.
24420
24421 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
24422 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
24423
24424 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
24425 5 seconds ("c----").
24426
24427 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
24428 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024429 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024430
24431 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024432 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024433 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
24434 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
24435 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
24436 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
24437 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010024438
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020024439
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200244409. Supported filters
24441--------------------
24442
24443Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
24444accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
24445unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
24446
24447See also : "filter"
24448
244499.1. Trace
24450----------
24451
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010024452filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024453
24454 Arguments:
24455 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
24456 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
24457
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010024458 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024459
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024460 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024461 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
24462 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
24463 amount of the parsed data.
24464
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024465 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010024466
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024467This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
24468callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
24469information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
24470filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
24471
24472Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
24473tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
24474a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
24475
24476
244779.2. HTTP compression
24478---------------------
24479
24480filter compression
24481
24482The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
24483keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024484when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
24485fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
24486done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
24487explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
24488filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
24489listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
24490order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024491
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024492See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
24493 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024494
24495
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200244969.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
24497--------------------------------------------
24498
24499filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
24500
24501 Arguments :
24502
24503 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
24504 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
24505 parsed.
24506
24507 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
24508 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
24509 part must be placed in its own scope.
24510
24511The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
24512external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024513streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020024514exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
24515also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
24516
24517SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
24518the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
24519
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010024520For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020024521"doc/SPOE.txt".
24522
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100245239.4. Cache
24524----------
24525
24526filter cache <name>
24527
24528 Arguments :
24529
24530 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
24531
24532The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
24533"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050024534cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024535other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
24536case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
24537is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
24538filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010024539listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
24540order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010024541
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024542See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
24543 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
24544
24545
245469.5. Fcgi-app
24547-------------
24548
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040024549filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024550
24551 Arguments :
24552
24553 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
24554
24555The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
24556request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
24557reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
24558used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
24559implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
24560used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
24561fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
24562used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
24563order.
24564
24565See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
24566 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
24567
24568
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100245699.6. OpenTracing
24570----------------
24571
24572The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
24573HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
24574of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
24575Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
24576
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024577This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024578
24579The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
24580HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
24581participates in the work of HAProxy.
24582
24583filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
24584
24585 Arguments :
24586
24587 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
24588 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
24589 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
24590 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
24591 OpenTracing filters.
24592
24593 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
24594 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
24595 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
24596 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
24597 filter must have its own scope defined.
24598
24599More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020024600of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024601
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +0200246029.7. Bandwidth limitation
24603--------------------------
24604
24605filter bwlim-in <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
24606filter bwlim-out <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
24607filter bwlim-in <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
24608filter bwlim-out <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
24609
24610 Arguments :
24611
24612 <name> is the filter name that will be used by 'set-bandwidth-limit'
24613 actions to reference a specific bandwidth limitation filter.
24614
24615 <size> is max number of bytes that can be forwarded over the period.
24616 The value must be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
24617 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
24618 expressed in bytes.
24619
24620 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
24621 describes what elements will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
24622 and used to select which table entry to update the counters. It
24623 must be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
24624
24625 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
24626 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. It can
24627 be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
24628
24629 <time> is the default time period used to evaluate the bandwidth
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050024630 limitation rate. It can be specified for per-stream bandwidth
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024631 limitation filters only. It follows the HAProxy time format and
24632 is expressed in milliseconds.
24633
24634 <min-size> is the optional minimum number of bytes forwarded at a time by
24635 a stream excluding the last packet that may be smaller. This
24636 value can be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
24637 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
24638 expressed in bytes.
24639
24640Bandwidth limitation filters should be used to restrict the data forwarding
24641speed at the stream level. By extension, such filters limit the network
24642bandwidth consumed by a resource. Several bandwidth limitation filters can be
24643used. For instance, it is possible to define a limit per source address to be
24644sure a client will never consume all the network bandwidth, thereby penalizing
24645other clients, and another one per stream to be able to fairly handle several
24646connections for a given client.
24647
24648The definition order of these filters is important. If several bandwidth
24649filters are enabled on a stream, the filtering will be applied in their
24650definition order. It is also important to understand the definition order of
24651the other filters have an influence. For instance, depending on the HTTP
24652compression filter is defined before or after a bandwidth limitation filter,
24653the limit will be applied on the compressed payload or not. The same is true
24654for the cache filter.
24655
24656There are two kinds of bandwidth limitation filters. The first one enforces a
24657default limit and is applied per stream. The second one uses a stickiness table
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050024658to enforce a limit equally divided between all streams sharing the same entry in
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024659the table.
24660
24661In addition, for a given filter, depending on the filter keyword used, the
24662limitation can be applied on incoming data, received from the client and
24663forwarded to a server, or on outgoing data, received from a server and sent to
24664the client. To apply a limit on incoming data, "bwlim-in" keyword must be
24665used. To apply it on outgoing data, "bwlim-out" keyword must be used. In both
24666cases, the bandwidth limitation is applied on forwarded data, at the stream
24667level.
24668
24669The bandwidth limitation is applied at the stream level and not at the
24670connection level. For multiplexed protocols (H2, H3 and FastCGI), the streams
24671of the same connection may have different limits.
24672
24673For a per-stream bandwidth limitation filter, default period and limit must be
24674defined. As their names suggest, they are the default values used to setup the
24675bandwidth limitation rate for a stream. However, for this kind of filter and
24676only this one, it is possible to redefine these values using sample expressions
24677when the filter is enabled with a TCP/HTTP "set-bandwidth-limit" action.
24678
24679For a shared bandwidth limitation filter, depending on whether it is applied on
24680incoming or outgoing data, the stickiness table used must store the
24681corresponding bytes rate information. "bytes_in_rate(<period>)" counter must be
24682stored to limit incoming data and "bytes_out_rate(<period>)" counter must be
24683used to limit outgoing data.
24684
24685Finally, it is possible to set the minimum number of bytes that a bandwidth
24686limitation filter can forward at a time for a given stream. It should be used
24687to not forward too small amount of data, to reduce the CPU usage. It must
24688carefully be defined. Too small, a value can increase the CPU usage. Too high,
24689it can increase the latency. It is also highly linked to the defined bandwidth
24690limit. If it is too close to the bandwidth limit, some pauses may be
24691experienced to not exceed the limit because too many bytes will be consumed at
24692a time. It is highly dependent on the filter configuration. A good idea is to
24693start with something around 2 TCP MSS, typically 2896 bytes, and tune it after
24694some experimentations.
24695
24696 Example:
24697 frontend http
24698 bind *:80
24699 mode http
24700
24701 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will share the download limit
24702 # of 10m/s with all other streams with the same source address.
24703 filter bwlim-out limit-by-src key src table limit-by-src limit 10m
24704
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050024705 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will be limited to download at 1m/s,
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024706 # independently of all other streams.
24707 filter bwlim-out limit-by-strm default-limit 1m default-period 1s
24708
24709 # Limit all streams to 1m/s (the default limit) and those accessing the
24710 # internal API to 100k/s. Limit each source address to 10m/s. The shared
24711 # limit is applied first. Both are limiting the download rate.
24712 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm
24713 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm limit 100k if { path_beg /internal }
24714 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-src
24715 ...
24716
24717 backend limit-by-src
24718 # The stickiness table used by <limit-by-src> filter
24719 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 3600s store bytes_out_rate(1s)
24720
24721See also : "tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit",
24722 "tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit",
24723 "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" and
24724 "http-response set-bandwidth-limit".
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024725
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002472610. FastCGI applications
24727-------------------------
24728
24729HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
24730feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
24731the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
24732FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
24733servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
24734FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
24735backend.
24736
24737HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
24738application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
24739connection.
24740
2474110.1. Setup
24742-----------
24743
2474410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
24745--------------------------
24746
24747fcgi-app <name>
24748 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
24749 document root must be defined.
24750
24751acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
24752 Declare or complete an access list.
24753
24754 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
24755 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
24756 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
24757 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
24758 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
24759
24760docroot <path>
24761 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
24762 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
24763 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
24764
24765index <script-name>
24766 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
24767 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
24768 is an optional setting.
24769
24770 Example :
24771 index index.php
24772
24773log-stderr global
24774log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010024775 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024776 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
24777
24778 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
24779 default STDERR messages are ignored.
24780
24781pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24782 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
24783 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
24784 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24785
24786 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
24787 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
24788 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
24789 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
24790
24791 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
24792 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
24793
24794path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024795 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024796 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
24797 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
24798 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
24799 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
24800 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
24801 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
24802 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024803
24804 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024805 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024806 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
24807 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
24808 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
24809 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024810
24811 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024812 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
24813 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024814
24815option get-values
24816no option get-values
24817 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
24818
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040024819 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024820 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
24821
24822 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
24823 application will accept.
24824
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020024825 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
24826 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024827
24828 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050024829 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024830 option is disabled.
24831
24832 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
24833 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
24834 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
24835 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
24836 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
24837 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
24838
24839option keep-conn
24840no option keep-conn
24841 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
24842 sending a response.
24843
24844 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
24845 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
24846
24847option max-reqs <reqs>
24848 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
24849 accept.
24850
24851 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
24852 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
24853 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
24854 to 1.
24855
24856option mpxs-conns
24857no option mpxs-conns
24858 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
24859
24860 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
24861 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
24862
24863set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24864 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
Willy Tarreau99521dc2024-05-24 15:10:10 +020024865 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.6
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024866 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
24867 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24868
24869 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
24870 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
24871 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
24872
24873 Example :
24874 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
24875 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
24876
24877 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
24878
24879
2488010.1.2. Proxy section
24881---------------------
24882
24883use-fcgi-app <name>
24884 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
24885
24886 Arguments :
24887 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
24888
24889 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
24890 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
24891 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
24892 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
24893 application may be defined at a time per backend.
24894
24895 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
24896 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
24897 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
24898 application are evaluated.
24899
24900
2490110.1.3. Example
24902---------------
24903
24904 frontend front-http
24905 mode http
24906 bind *:80
24907 bind *:
24908
24909 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
24910 default_backend back-static
24911
24912 backend back-static
24913 mode http
24914 server www A.B.C.D:80
24915
24916 backend back-dynamic
24917 mode http
24918 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
24919 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
24920
24921 fcgi-app php-fpm
24922 log-stderr global
24923 option keep-conn
24924
24925 docroot /var/www/my-app
24926 index index.php
24927 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
24928
24929
2493010.2. Default parameters
24931------------------------
24932
24933A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
24934the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024935script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024936applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
24937
24938 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24939 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
24940 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
24941 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
24942 | | |
24943 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24944 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
24945 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
24946 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
24947 | | application. |
24948 | | |
24949 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24950 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
24951 | | the request. It may not be set. |
24952 | | |
24953 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24954 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
24955 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
24956 | | the application's configuration. |
24957 | | |
24958 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24959 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
24960 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
24961 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
24962 | | |
24963 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24964 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
24965 | | following the part that identifies the script |
24966 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
24967 | | be defined. |
24968 | | |
24969 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24970 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
24971 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
24972 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
24973 | | is not set too. |
24974 | | |
24975 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24976 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
24977 | | set. |
24978 | | |
24979 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24980 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
24981 | | the request. |
24982 | | |
24983 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24984 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
24985 | | client as part of user authentication. |
24986 | | |
24987 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24988 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
24989 | | script to process the request. |
24990 | | |
24991 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24992 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
24993 | | |
24994 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24995 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
24996 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
24997 | | |
24998 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24999 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
25000 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
25001 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
25002 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
25003 | | |
25004 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25005 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
25006 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
25007 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
25008 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
25009 | | side. |
25010 | | |
25011 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25012 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
25013 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
25014 | | connected to. |
25015 | | |
25016 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25017 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
25018 | | |
25019 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020025020 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
25021 | | current HAProxy version. |
25022 | | |
25023 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020025024 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
25025 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
25026 | | |
25027 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
25028
25029
2503010.3. Limitations
25031------------------
25032
25033The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
25034way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
25035during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
25036establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
25037application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
25038or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
25039message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
25040these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
25041and HTTP servers under the same backend.
25042
25043Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
25044request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
25045requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
25046
25047About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
25048into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
25049fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
25050"http-request" ones.
25051
25052Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
25053FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
25054processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
25055must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
25056here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010025057
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025058
2505911. Address formats
25060-------------------
25061
25062Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
25063address.
25064
25065This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
25066The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
25067of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
25068equivalent is '::'.
25069
25070Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
25071is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
25072
25073This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
25074family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
25075
25076Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
25077configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
25078use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
25079'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
25080
25081Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
25082socket type and the transport method.
25083
25084
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002508511.1. Address family prefixes
25086-----------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025087
25088'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
25089
25090'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
25091 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
25092 listening.
25093
25094'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
25095 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
25096 on the statement using this address, a port or
25097 a port range may or must be specified.
25098
25099'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25100 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
25101 using this address, a port or a port range
25102 may or must be specified.
25103
25104'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25105 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
25106 using this address, a port or a port range
25107 may or must be specified.
25108
25109'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
25110 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
25111 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
25112 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
25113 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
25114 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
25115
25116'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
25117 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
25118 start by slash '/'.
25119
25120
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002512111.2. Socket type prefixes
25122--------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025123
25124Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
25125type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
25126this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
25127This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
25128but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
25129
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025130Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should instead use
25131use aliases of the next section "11.3 Protocol prefixes". However these can
25132sometimes be convenient, for example in combination with inherited sockets
25133known by their file descriptor number, in which case the address family is "fd"
25134and the socket type must be declared.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025135
25136If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
25137they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
25138report this to the maintainers.
25139
25140'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
25141 to "stream"
25142
25143'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
25144 to "datagram".
25145
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025146'quic+<family>@<address>' forces socket type to "datagram" and transport
25147 method to "stream".
25148
25149
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025150
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002515111.3. Protocol prefixes
25152-----------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025153
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010025154'quic4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25155 an IPv4 address but socket type is forced to
25156 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
25157 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
25158 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025159 must be specified. It is equivalent to
25160 "quic+ipv4@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010025161
25162'quic6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25163 an IPv6 address but socket type is forced to
25164 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
25165 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
25166 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025167 must be specified. It is equivalent to
25168 "quic+ipv6@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010025169
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025170'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
25171 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
25172 socket type and transport method is forced to
25173 "stream". Depending on the statement using
25174 this address, a port or a port range can or
25175 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
25176 of 'stream+ip@'.
25177
25178'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25179 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
25180 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
25181 statement using this address, a port or port
25182 range can or must be specified.
25183 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
25184
25185'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25186 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
25187 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
25188 statement using this address, a port or port
25189 range can or must be specified.
25190 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
25191
25192'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
25193 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
25194 socket type and transport method is forced to
25195 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
25196 this address, a port or a port range can or
25197 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
25198 of 'dgram+ip@'.
25199
25200'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25201 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
25202 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
25203 the statement using this address, a port or
25204 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010025205 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025206
25207'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25208 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
25209 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
25210 the statement using this address, a port or
25211 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010025212 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025213
25214'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
25215 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
25216 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
25217
25218'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
25219 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
25220 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
25221
25222In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
25223QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
25224
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010025225/*
25226 * Local variables:
25227 * fill-column: 79
25228 * End:
25229 */